UCM6300 Usermanual
UCM6300 Usermanual
UCM6300 Usermanual
UCM630X Series
Enterprise-Grade Unified Communication Solutions
User Manual
COPYRIGHT
CAUTION
Changes or modifications to this product not expressly approved by Grandstream, or operation of this product
in any way other than as detailed by this User Manual, could void your manufacturer warranty.
WARNING
Please do not use a different power adaptor with your devices as it may cause damage to the products and
void the manufacturer warranty.
Page | 2
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
GNU GPL INFORMATION
UCM630X firmware contains third-party software licensed under the GNU General Public License (GPL).
Grandstream uses software under the specific terms of the GPL. Please see the GNU General Public License
(GPL) for the exact terms and conditions of the license.
Grandstream GNU GPL related source code can be downloaded from Grandstream web site from:
http://www.grandstream.com/support/faq/gnu-general-public-license/gnu-gpl-information-download
Page | 3
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table of Content
WELCOME .................................................................................................. 31
INSTALLATION ........................................................................................... 36
Equipment Packaging.................................................................................................................... 36
Connect Your UCM630X (UCM6301 as example) .......................................................................... 36
UCM6302 front and back view................................................................................................ 38
UCM6304 front and back view................................................................................................ 38
UCM6308 front and back view................................................................................................ 39
SYSTEM SETTINGS................................................................................... 47
General Settings ........................................................................................................................... 47
HTTP Server ................................................................................................................................. 48
Network Settings ........................................................................................................................... 49
Basic Settings ........................................................................................................................ 49
802.1X ................................................................................................................................... 55
Page | 4
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Static Routes ......................................................................................................................... 56
Port Forwarding ..................................................................................................................... 59
ARP Settings.......................................................................................................................... 61
OpenVPN® ................................................................................................................................... 62
DDNS Settings .............................................................................................................................. 64
Security Settings ........................................................................................................................... 66
Static Defense ....................................................................................................................... 66
Dynamic Defense................................................................................................................... 70
Fail2ban ................................................................................................................................. 71
SSH Access ........................................................................................................................... 73
LDAP Server ................................................................................................................................. 74
LDAP Server Configurations................................................................................................... 75
LDAP Phonebook................................................................................................................... 77
LDAP Client Configurations .................................................................................................... 80
Time Settings ................................................................................................................................ 82
Automatic Date and Time ....................................................................................................... 82
Set Date and Time ................................................................................................................. 83
NTP Server ............................................................................................................................ 84
Office Time ............................................................................................................................ 84
Holiday .................................................................................................................................. 85
Email Settings ............................................................................................................................... 87
Email settings ........................................................................................................................ 87
Email Templates..................................................................................................................... 89
Email Send Log...................................................................................................................... 90
TR-069 .......................................................................................................................................... 93
PROVISIONING .......................................................................................... 94
Overview ....................................................................................................................................... 94
Configuration Architecture for End Point Device............................................................................. 94
Auto Provisioning Settings ............................................................................................................. 95
Discovery ...................................................................................................................................... 98
Uploading Devices List ................................................................................................................ 100
Managing Discovered Devices .................................................................................................... 100
Global Configuration.................................................................................................................... 101
Global Policy ........................................................................................................................ 101
Global Templates .................................................................................................................. 111
Model configuration ......................................................................................................................113
Model templates................................................................................................................... 113
Model Update ...................................................................................................................... 115
Device Configuration ....................................................................................................................116
Page | 5
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Create New Device .............................................................................................................. 117
Manage Devices .................................................................................................................. 117
Sample Application ...................................................................................................................... 122
Page | 6
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configuring Outbound Routes .............................................................................................. 204
Outbound Blacklist ............................................................................................................... 207
Scheduled Sync ................................................................................................................... 209
PIN Groups .......................................................................................................................... 209
Inbound Routes ........................................................................................................................... 212
Inbound Rule Configurations ................................................................................................ 213
Inbound Route: Prepend Example ........................................................................................ 217
Inbound Route: Multiple Mode .............................................................................................. 218
Inbound Route: Route-Level Mode ....................................................................................... 220
Inbound Route: Inbound Mode BLF Monitoring ..................................................................... 221
Inbound Route: Import/Export Inbound Route ....................................................................... 222
FAX with Two Media ............................................................................................................. 223
Blacklist Configurations ........................................................................................................ 223
Page | 7
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Black/White List in IVR ................................................................................................................ 257
Create Custom Prompt ................................................................................................................ 259
VOICEMAIL............................................................................................... 265
Configure Voicemail .................................................................................................................... 265
Access Voicemail ........................................................................................................................ 267
Leaving Voicemail ....................................................................................................................... 268
Voicemail Email Settings ............................................................................................................. 269
Configure Voicemail Group .......................................................................................................... 270
Page | 8
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
MUSIC ON HOLD ..................................................................................... 303
CALLBACK............................................................................................... 320
Page | 9
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ANNOUNCEMENT ................................................................................... 345
P a g e | 10
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
API CONFIGURATION ............................................................................. 375
API Configuration Parameters ..................................................................................................... 375
API Queries Supported ........................................................................................................ 375
Upload Voice Prompt via API ....................................................................................................... 377
P a g e | 11
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Trunks.................................................................................................................................. 406
Extensions ........................................................................................................................... 407
Interfaces Status .................................................................................................................. 408
System Status ............................................................................................................................. 409
General ................................................................................................................................ 409
Network ............................................................................................................................... 410
Storage Usage ..................................................................................................................... 411
Resource Usage .................................................................................................................. 412
System Events ............................................................................................................................ 413
Alert Events List ................................................................................................................... 413
Alert Log .............................................................................................................................. 419
Alert Contact ........................................................................................................................ 420
CDR ............................................................................................................................................ 421
Downloaded CDR File .......................................................................................................... 428
CDR Export Customization................................................................................................... 429
CDR in GDMS Cloud ........................................................................................................... 430
Statistics .............................................................................................................................. 430
Recording Files .................................................................................................................... 432
P a g e | 12
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Reset and Reboot ................................................................................................................ 453
Cleaner ................................................................................................................................ 453
USB/SD Card Files Cleanup ................................................................................................ 458
System Recovery ........................................................................................................................ 458
Syslog ......................................................................................................................................... 460
Network Troubleshooting ............................................................................................................. 461
Ethernet Capture.................................................................................................................. 461
IP Ping ................................................................................................................................. 463
Traceroute............................................................................................................................ 464
Signaling Troubleshooting ........................................................................................................... 464
Analog Record Trace ........................................................................................................... 464
Service Check ............................................................................................................................. 466
Network Status ............................................................................................................................ 467
Table of Tables
P a g e | 13
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 20: Create New Office Time.................................................................................................................. 84
Table 21: Create New Holiday........................................................................................................................ 86
Table 22: Email Settings ................................................................................................................................ 87
Table 23: Email Log – Display Filter ............................................................................................................... 91
Table 24: Email Codes ................................................................................................................................... 92
Table 25: Auto Provision Settings ................................................................................................................... 97
Table 26: Global Policy Parameters – Localization ....................................................................................... 102
Table 27: Global Policy Parameters – Phone Settings .................................................................................. 103
Table 28: Global Policy Parameters – Contact List ....................................................................................... 104
Table 29: Global Policy Parameters – Maintenance...................................................................................... 105
Table 30: Global Policy Parameters – Network Settings ............................................................................... 107
Table 31: Global Policy Parameters – Customization ................................................................................... 109
Table 32: Global Policy Parameters – Communication Settings .................................................................... 110
Table 33: Create New Template ................................................................................................................... 111
Table 34: Create New Model Template ......................................................................................................... 113
Table 35: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersBasic Settings ............................................................. 127
Table 36: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersMedia ......................................................................... 129
Table 37: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersFeatures ..................................................................... 130
Table 38: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersSpecific Time .............................................................. 136
Table 39: Table 34: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersFollow Me .................................................... 136
Table 40: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersBasic Settings ............................................................. 137
Table 41: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersMedia ......................................................................... 138
Table 42: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersFeatures ..................................................................... 139
Table 43: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersSpecific Time .............................................................. 142
Table 44: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersFollow Me ................................................................... 142
Table 45: FXS Extension Configuration ParametersBasic Settings............................................................ 143
Table 46: FXS Extension Configuration ParametersMedia ........................................................................ 144
Table 47: FXS Extension Configuration ParametersFeatures .................................................................... 145
Table 48: FXS Extension Configuration ParametersSpecific Time ............................................................. 149
Table 49: FXS Extension Configuration ParametersFollow Me .................................................................. 149
Table 50: Batch Add SIP Extension Parameters ........................................................................................... 150
able 51: Batch Add IAX Extension Parameters ............................................................................................. 157
Table 52: SIP extensions Imported File Example .......................................................................................... 165
Table 53: IAX extensions Imported File Example.......................................................................................... 167
Table 54: FXS Extensions Imported File Example ........................................................................................ 169
Table 55: Analog Trunk Configuration Parameters ........................................................................................ 178
Table 56: PSTN Detection for Analog Trunk ................................................................................................. 185
Table 57: Create New SIP Trunk .................................................................................................................. 186
Table 58: SIP Register Trunk Configuration Parameters ............................................................................... 188
Table 59: SIP Peer Trunk Configuration Parameters .................................................................................... 192
P a g e | 14
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 60: Create New IAX Trunk .................................................................................................................. 195
Table 61: IAX Register Trunk Configuration Parameters ............................................................................... 196
Table 62: IAX Peer Trunk Configuration Parameters .................................................................................... 197
Table 63: SLA Station Configuration Parameters .......................................................................................... 201
Table 64: Outbound Route Configuration Parameters .................................................................................. 204
Table 65: Outbound Routes/Scheduled Sync ............................................................................................... 209
Table 66: Outbound Routes/PIN Group ........................................................................................................ 209
Table 67: Inbound Rule Configuration Parameters ....................................................................................... 213
Table 68: FAX/T.38 Settings ......................................................................................................................... 226
Table 69: Conference Room Configuration Parameters ................................................................................ 233
Table 70: Conference Settings ..................................................................................................................... 235
Table 71: Conference Caller IVR Menu ........................................................................................................ 237
Table 72: Conference Schedule Parameters ................................................................................................ 241
Table 73: Video Conference room Configuration Parameters ....................................................................... 247
Table 74: Conference Settings ..................................................................................................................... 248
Table 75: Video Conference Schedule Parameters ...................................................................................... 249
Table 76: IVR Configuration Parameters ...................................................................................................... 255
Table 77: Voicemail Settings ........................................................................................................................ 266
Table 78: Voicemail IVR Menu ..................................................................................................................... 267
Table 79: Voicemail Email Settings .............................................................................................................. 269
Table 80: Voicemail Group Settings.............................................................................................................. 271
Table 81: Ring Group Parameters ................................................................................................................ 272
Table 82: Multicast Paging Configuration Parameters .................................................................................. 279
Table 83: 2-way Intercom Configuration Parameters .................................................................................... 280
Table 84: 1-way Paging Configuration Parameters ....................................................................................... 282
Table 85: Announcement Paging Configuration Parameters ......................................................................... 283
Table 86: Schedule Paging / Intercom Settings ............................................................................................ 285
Table 87: Call Queue Configuration Parameters........................................................................................... 286
Table 88: Static Agent Limitation .................................................................................................................. 290
Table 89: Call Center Parameters ................................................................................................................ 291
Table 90: Switchboard Parameters .............................................................................................................. 297
Table 91: Global Queue Settings.................................................................................................................. 300
Table 92: SIP Presence Status..................................................................................................................... 308
Table 93: Follow Me Settings ....................................................................................................................... 311
Table 94: Follow Me Options ........................................................................................................................ 312
Table 95: DISA Settings ............................................................................................................................... 315
Table 96: Emergency Numbers Parameters ................................................................................................. 318
Table 97: Callback Configuration Parameters............................................................................................... 320
Table 98: Event List Settings ........................................................................................................................ 321
Table 99: UCM630X Feature Codes............................................................................................................. 332
P a g e | 15
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 100 : Parking Lot ................................................................................................................................ 338
Table 101: Add SCA Private Number............................................................................................................ 343
Table 102: Editing the SCA Number ............................................................................................................. 344
Table 103: Announcement Parameters ........................................................................................................ 345
Table 104: Internal Options/General ............................................................................................................. 346
Table 105: Internal Options/RTP Settings ..................................................................................................... 349
Table 106: Internal Options/Payload............................................................................................................. 350
Table 107: NAS Settings .............................................................................................................................. 356
Table 108: SIP Settings/General .................................................................................................................. 358
Table 109: SIP Settings/Misc ....................................................................................................................... 358
Table 110: SIP Settings/Session Timer ......................................................................................................... 359
Table 111: SIP Settings/TCP and TLS .......................................................................................................... 360
Table 112: SIP Settings/NAT ........................................................................................................................ 361
Table 113: SIP Settings/ToS ......................................................................................................................... 361
Table 114: SIP Settings/STIR/SHAKEN - Add Authentication Number Settings ............................................. 363
Table 115: SIP Settings/STIR/SHAKEN – Certificate Settings ....................................................................... 364
Table 116: IAX Settings/General .................................................................................................................. 366
Table 117: IAX Settings/Registration ............................................................................................................ 366
Table 118: IAX Settings/Static Defense ........................................................................................................ 367
Table 119: PBX Interface Settings ................................................................................................................ 369
Table 120: Configuration Parameters (New) ................................................................................................. 375
Table 121: New API Supported Queries ....................................................................................................... 375
Table 122: API Configuration Parameters..................................................................................................... 377
Table 123: SugarCRM Settings .................................................................................................................... 381
Table 124: vTigerCRM Settings.................................................................................................................... 383
Table 125: ZohoCRM Settings ..................................................................................................................... 385
Table 126: Salesforce Settings..................................................................................................................... 386
Table 127: PMS Supported Features ........................................................................................................... 389
Table 128: PMS Basic Settings .................................................................................................................... 393
Table 129: PMS Wake up Service ................................................................................................................ 395
Table 130: Create New Mini Bar................................................................................................................... 396
Table 131: Create New Maid ........................................................................................................................ 397
Table 132: Wakeup Service ......................................................................................................................... 400
Table 133: Max Wakeup Members ............................................................................................................... 400
Table 134: Announcements Center Settings ................................................................................................. 403
Table 135: Group Settings ........................................................................................................................... 403
Table 136: Trunk Status ............................................................................................................................... 407
Table 137: Extension Status......................................................................................................................... 408
Table 138: Interface Status Indicators .......................................................................................................... 409
Table 139: System StatusGeneral ............................................................................................................ 410
P a g e | 16
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 140: System StatusNetwork ............................................................................................................ 410
Table 141: Alert Events ................................................................................................................................ 413
Table 142: Alert Contact ............................................................................................................................... 420
Table 143: CDR Filter Criteria ...................................................................................................................... 422
Table 144: CDR Statistics Filter Criteria ....................................................................................................... 431
Table 145: User ManagementCreate New User ........................................................................................ 437
Table 146: Change Binding Email option ...................................................................................................... 442
Table 147: Operation Log Column Header ................................................................................................... 445
Table 148: Data Sync Configuration ............................................................................................................. 451
Table 149: Automatic Cleaning Configuration ............................................................................................... 455
Table 150: USB/SD Card Files Cleanup ....................................................................................................... 458
Table 151: Ethernet Capture ........................................................................................................................ 462
P a g e | 17
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table of Figures
Figure 1: UCM6301 Top View ........................................................................................................................ 36
Figure 2: UCM6301 Back View ...................................................................................................................... 37
Figure 3: UCM6301 Front View ...................................................................................................................... 37
Figure 4: UCM6302 Back View ...................................................................................................................... 38
Figure 5:UCM6302 Front View....................................................................................................................... 38
Figure 6: UCM6304 Front View ...................................................................................................................... 38
Figure 7: UCM6304 Back View ...................................................................................................................... 38
Figure 8: UCM6308 Front View ...................................................................................................................... 39
Figure 9: UCM6308 Back View ...................................................................................................................... 39
Figure 10: Ports Status .................................................................................................................................. 42
Figure 11: UCM6302 Web GUI Login Page .................................................................................................... 43
Figure 12: UCM630X Setup Wizard ............................................................................................................... 44
Figure 13: UCM630X Web GUI Language ..................................................................................................... 45
Figure 14: Web GUI Search Bar .................................................................................................................... 46
Figure 15: General Settings Interface............................................................................................................. 47
Figure 16: UCM6302 Network Interface Method: Route ................................................................................. 53
Figure 17: UCM6302 Network Interface Method: Switch ................................................................................ 54
Figure 18: UCM6302 Network Interface Method: Dual.................................................................................... 55
Figure 19: UCM630X Using 802.1X as Client................................................................................................. 55
Figure 20: UCM630X Using 802.1X EAP-MD5 ............................................................................................... 56
Figure 21: UCM6304 Static Route Sample ..................................................................................................... 58
Figure 22: UCM6304 Static Route Configuration ............................................................................................ 59
Figure 23: Create New Port Forwarding ......................................................................................................... 60
Figure 24: UCM630X Port Forwarding Configuration ...................................................................................... 61
Figure 25: GXP2160 Web Access using UCM6302 Port Forwarding .............................................................. 61
Figure 26: Open VPN® Feature on the UCM630X ......................................................................................... 63
Figure 27: Register Domain Name on noip.com ............................................................................................. 64
Figure 28: UCM630X DDNS Setting .............................................................................................................. 65
Figure 29: Using Domain Name to Connect to UCM630X .............................................................................. 65
Figure 30: Create New Firewall Rule.............................................................................................................. 68
Figure 31: Configure Dynamic Defense.......................................................................................................... 71
Figure 32: Fail2ban Settings .......................................................................................................................... 72
Figure 33: SSH Access .................................................................................................................................. 74
Figure 34: LDAP Server Configurations ......................................................................................................... 75
Figure 35: Default LDAP Phonebook DN ....................................................................................................... 76
Figure 36: Default LDAP Phonebook Attributes .............................................................................................. 76
Figure 37: LDAP ServerLDAP Phonebook .................................................................................................. 77
Figure 38: Add LDAP Phonebook .................................................................................................................. 77
P a g e | 18
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 39: Edit LDAP Phonebook .................................................................................................................. 78
Figure 40: Import Phonebook......................................................................................................................... 78
Figure 41: Phonebook CSV File Format ......................................................................................................... 78
Figure 42: LDAP Phonebook After Import....................................................................................................... 79
Figure 43: Export Selected LDAP Phonebook ................................................................................................ 80
Figure 44: LDAP Client Configurations ........................................................................................................... 80
Figure 45: GXP2170 LDAP Phonebook Configuration .................................................................................... 82
Figure 46: Set Time Manually ........................................................................................................................ 83
Figure 47: Create New Office Time ................................................................................................................ 84
Figure 48: SettingsTime SettingsOffice Time ........................................................................................... 85
Figure 49: Create New Holiday ...................................................................................................................... 86
Figure 50: SettingsTime SettingsHoliday ................................................................................................. 87
Figure 51: UCM630X Email Settings .............................................................................................................. 89
Figure 52: Email Template ............................................................................................................................. 90
Figure 53: Email Send Log ............................................................................................................................ 91
Figure 54: Email Logs .................................................................................................................................... 92
Figure 55: Zero Config Configuration Architecture for End Point Device ......................................................... 95
Figure 56: UCM630X Zero Config .................................................................................................................. 96
Figure 57: Auto Provision Settings ................................................................................................................. 97
Figure 58: Auto Discover................................................................................................................................ 99
Figure 59: Discovered Devices ...................................................................................................................... 99
Figure 60: Device List - CSV file Sample...................................................................................................... 100
Figure 61: Managing Discovered Devices .................................................................................................... 100
Figure 62: Global Policy Categories ............................................................................................................. 102
Figure 63: Edit Global Template ................................................................................................................... 112
Figure 64: Edit Model Template.................................................................................................................... 114
Figure 65: OEM Models ............................................................................................................................... 115
Figure 66: Template Management ................................................................................................................ 116
Figure 67: Upload Model Template Manually ................................................................................................ 116
Figure 68: Create New Device ..................................................................................................................... 117
Figure 69: Manage Devices ......................................................................................................................... 118
Figure 70: Edit Device ................................................................................................................................. 118
Figure 71: Edit Customize Device Settings................................................................................................... 120
Figure 72: Modify Selected Devices - Same Model ...................................................................................... 121
Figure 73: Modify Selected Devices - Different Models................................................................................. 121
Figure 74: Device List in Zero Config ........................................................................................................... 122
Figure 75: Zero Config Sample - Global Policy............................................................................................. 123
Figure 76: Zero Config Sample - Device Preview 1 ...................................................................................... 124
Figure 77: Zero Config Sample - Device Preview 2 ...................................................................................... 124
Figure 78: Zero Config Sample - Device Preview 3 ...................................................................................... 125
P a g e | 19
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 79: Create New Device ..................................................................................................................... 126
Figure 80: Manage Extensions .................................................................................................................... 162
Figure 81: Export Extensions ....................................................................................................................... 164
Figure 82: Import Extensions ....................................................................................................................... 164
Figure 83: Import File................................................................................................................................... 165
Figure 84: Import Error ................................................................................................................................ 171
Figure 85: Extension Details ........................................................................................................................ 172
Figure 86: E-mail Notification - Prompt Information ...................................................................................... 172
Figure 87: Account Registration Information ................................................................................................. 173
Figure 88: GSWave Settings and QR Code ................................................................................................. 173
Figure 89: Multiple Registrations per Extension............................................................................................ 174
Figure 90: Extension - Concurrent Registration ............................................................................................ 174
Figure 91: SMS Message Support ............................................................................................................... 175
Figure 92: Edit Extension Group .................................................................................................................. 176
Figure 93: Select Extension Group in Outbound Route ................................................................................ 177
Figure 94: UCM630X FXO Tone Settings ..................................................................................................... 182
Figure 95: UCM630X PSTN Detection ......................................................................................................... 183
Figure 96: UCM630X PSTN Detection: Auto Detect ..................................................................................... 184
Figure 97: UCM630X PSTN Detection: Semi-Auto Detect ............................................................................ 184
Figure 98: Trunk Group................................................................................................................................ 198
Figure 99: Trunk Group Configuration .......................................................................................................... 199
Figure 100: DOD extension selection ........................................................................................................... 200
Figure 101: Edit DOD .................................................................................................................................. 200
Figure 102: SLA Station ............................................................................................................................... 201
Figure 103: Enable SLA Mode for Analog Trunk ........................................................................................... 202
Figure 104: Analog Trunk with SLA Mode Enabled ....................................................................................... 202
Figure 105: SLA Example - SLA Station ....................................................................................................... 202
Figure 106: SLA Example - MPK Configuration ............................................................................................ 203
Figure 107: Country Codes .......................................................................................................................... 208
Figure 108: Blacklist Import/Export .............................................................................................................. 208
Figure 109: Create New PIN Group ............................................................................................................. 210
Figure 110: PIN Members ............................................................................................................................ 210
Figure 111: Outbound PIN............................................................................................................................ 210
Figure 112: CDR Record.............................................................................................................................. 211
Figure 113: Importing PIN Groups from CSV files......................................................................................... 211
Figure 114: Incorrect CSV File ..................................................................................................................... 211
Figure 115: CSV File Format........................................................................................................................ 212
Figure 116: CSV File Successful Upload ...................................................................................................... 212
Figure 117: Inbound Route feature: Prepend................................................................................................ 218
Figure 118: Inbound Route - Multiple Mode .................................................................................................. 219
P a g e | 20
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 119: Inbound Route - Multiple Mode Feature Codes .......................................................................... 220
Figure 120: Inbound Route - Route-Level Mode ........................................................................................... 220
Figure 121: Global Inbound Mode ................................................................................................................ 221
Figure 122: Inbound Mode - Default Mode ................................................................................................... 222
Figure 123: Inbound Mode - Mode 1 ............................................................................................................ 222
Figure 124: Import/Export Inbound Route .................................................................................................... 222
Figure 125: Blacklist Configuration Parameters ............................................................................................ 224
Figure 126: Blacklist csv File........................................................................................................................ 224
Figure 127: Fax Settings .............................................................................................................................. 225
Figure 128: Configure Analog Trunk............................................................................................................. 228
Figure 129: Configure Extension for Fax Machine: FXS Extension ............................................................... 228
Figure 130: Configure Extension for Fax Machine: Analog Settings .............................................................. 229
Figure 131: Configure Inbound Rule for Fax................................................................................................. 229
Figure 132: Create Fax Extension................................................................................................................ 230
Figure 133: Inbound Route to Fax Extension ............................................................................................... 231
Figure 134: List of Fax Files ......................................................................................................................... 231
Figure 135: Fax Sending in Web GUI ........................................................................................................... 232
Figure 136: Fax Send Progress ................................................................................................................... 232
Figure 137: Conference ............................................................................................................................... 235
Figure 138: Conference Invitation from Web GUI ......................................................................................... 236
Figure 139: Google Service SettingsOAuth2.0 Authentication ................................................................... 239
Figure 140: Google ServiceNew Project ................................................................................................... 239
Figure 141: Google ServiceCreate New Credential ................................................................................... 240
Figure 142: Google ServiceOAuth2.0 Login .............................................................................................. 240
Figure 143: Conference Schedule................................................................................................................ 243
Figure 144: Conference Scheduled-Ongoing ............................................................................................... 243
Figure 145: Conference Schedule-Completed.............................................................................................. 244
Figure 146: Contact Group .......................................................................................................................... 244
Figure 147: Conference Recordings............................................................................................................. 245
Figure 148: Conference Call Statistics ......................................................................................................... 245
Figure 149: Conference Report on Web ....................................................................................................... 246
Figure 150: Conference Report on CSV ....................................................................................................... 246
Figure 151: Video Conference Schedule ...................................................................................................... 250
Figure 152: Video Conference Scheduled-Ongoing...................................................................................... 250
Figure 153: Video Conference Scheduled-Completed .................................................................................. 251
Figure 154: Enabling WebRTC Feature ....................................................................................................... 251
Figure 155: Enabling WebRTC on Extensions .............................................................................................. 252
Figure 156: Grandstream Wave Interface..................................................................................................... 252
Figure 157: Download Wave Client .............................................................................................................. 253
Figure 158: Create New IVR ........................................................................................................................ 254
P a g e | 21
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 159: Key Pressing Events ................................................................................................................. 257
Figure 160: Black/Whitelist .......................................................................................................................... 259
Figure 161: Click on Prompt to Create IVR Prompt ...................................................................................... 260
Figure 162: Language Settings for Voice Prompt ......................................................................................... 261
Figure 163: Voice Prompt Package List........................................................................................................ 262
Figure 164: New Voice Prompt Language Added ......................................................................................... 262
Figure 165: Upload Single Voice Prompt for Entire Language Pack .............................................................. 263
Figure 166: Voicemail Settings..................................................................................................................... 265
Figure 167: Voicemail Email Settings ........................................................................................................... 270
Figure 168: Voicemail Group........................................................................................................................ 270
Figure 169: Ring Group ............................................................................................................................... 272
Figure 170: Ring Group Configuration.......................................................................................................... 275
Figure 171: Sync LDAP Server option.......................................................................................................... 276
Figure 172: Manually Sync LDAP Server ..................................................................................................... 276
Figure 173: Ring Group Remote Extension .................................................................................................. 277
Figure 174: Multicast Paging........................................................................................................................ 278
Figure 175: 2-way Intercom ......................................................................................................................... 280
Figure 176: 1-way Paging ............................................................................................................................ 281
Figure 177: Announcement Paging .............................................................................................................. 283
Figure 178: Page/Intercom Group Settings .................................................................................................. 284
Figure 179: Schedule Paging/Intercom page................................................................................................ 284
Figure 180: Creating a scheduled paging/intercom call ................................................................................ 285
Figure 181: Call Queue................................................................................................................................ 286
Figure 182: Agent Login Settings ................................................................................................................. 290
Figure 183: Call Queue Statistics ................................................................................................................. 293
Figure 184: Queue’s call log details ............................................................................................................. 293
Figure 185: Automatic Download Settings - Queue Statistics........................................................................ 294
Figure 186: Agent details ............................................................................................................................. 295
Figure 187: Login Record ............................................................................................................................ 295
Figure 188: Pause Log ................................................................................................................................ 296
Figure 189: Switchboard Summary .............................................................................................................. 296
Figure 190: Call Queue Switchboard............................................................................................................ 297
Figure 191: Queue Chairman....................................................................................................................... 298
Figure 192: Queue Agent ............................................................................................................................. 299
Figure 193: Global Queue Settings .............................................................................................................. 299
Figure 194: Edit Pickup Group ..................................................................................................................... 301
Figure 195: Edit Pickup Feature Code ......................................................................................................... 302
Figure 196: Music On Hold Default Class ..................................................................................................... 303
Figure 197: Play Custom Prompt ................................................................................................................. 304
Figure 198: Information Prompt ................................................................................................................... 305
P a g e | 22
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 199: Record Custom Prompt ............................................................................................................. 305
Figure 200: SIP Presence Configuration ...................................................................................................... 307
Figure 201: SIP Presence Feature Code...................................................................................................... 308
Figure 202: Presence Status CDR ............................................................................................................... 309
Figure 203: Edit Follow Me .......................................................................................................................... 310
Figure 204: Speed Dial Destinations ............................................................................................................ 313
Figure 205: List of Speed Dial ...................................................................................................................... 313
Figure 206: Create New DISA...................................................................................................................... 314
Figure 207: Emergency Number Configuration............................................................................................. 317
Figure 208: 911 Emergency Sample ............................................................................................................ 319
Figure 209: Create New Event List .............................................................................................................. 322
Figure 210: Create Dial by Name Group ...................................................................................................... 324
Figure 211: Configure Extension First Name and Last Name........................................................................ 325
Figure 212: Dial By Name Group In IVR Key Pressing Events...................................................................... 326
Figure 213: Dial By Name Group In Inbound Rule ........................................................................................ 327
Figure 214: StatusPBX StatusActive Calls - Ringing.............................................................................. 328
Figure 215: StatusPBX StatusActive Calls – Call Established ................................................................ 328
Figure 216: Call Connection less than half hour ........................................................................................... 329
Figure 217: Call Connection between half an hour and one hour .................................................................. 329
Figure 218: Call Connection more than one hour ......................................................................................... 330
Figure 219: Configure to Monitor an Active Call............................................................................................ 330
Figure 220: Enable/Disable Feature codes................................................................................................... 337
Figure 221: Parking Lot ............................................................................................................................... 337
Figure 222: New Parking Lot........................................................................................................................ 338
Figure 223: Monitored Call Park CID name .................................................................................................. 339
Figure 224: Download Recording File from CDR Page ................................................................................. 340
Figure 225: Download Recording File from Recording Files Page ................................................................ 340
Figure 226: Enabling SCA option under Extension’s Settings ....................................................................... 341
Figure 227: SCA Number Configuration ....................................................................................................... 342
Figure 228: SCA Private Number Configuration ........................................................................................... 342
Figure 229: SCA Options ............................................................................................................................. 343
Figure 230: Announcement settings ............................................................................................................. 345
Figure 231: Record New Custom Prompt ..................................................................................................... 351
Figure 232: Upload Custom Prompt ............................................................................................................. 352
Figure 233: Download All Custom Prompt .................................................................................................... 352
Figure 234: SIP Trunk Prompt Tone ............................................................................................................. 353
Figure 235: General call Failure Prompts ..................................................................................................... 354
Figure 236: SettingsRecordings Storage .................................................................................................. 354
Figure 237: Recordings Storage Prompt Information .................................................................................... 355
Figure 238: Recording Storage Category ..................................................................................................... 356
P a g e | 23
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 239:SIP Settings/STIR/SHAKEN - Add Authentication Number .......................................................... 363
Figure 240: SIP Settings/STIR/SHAKEN – Certificate Settings ..................................................................... 364
Figure 241: Transparent Call-Info................................................................................................................. 365
Figure 242: FXS Ports Signaling Preference ................................................................................................ 368
Figure 243: FXO Ports ACIM Settings .......................................................................................................... 368
Figure 244: DAHDI Settings ......................................................................................................................... 370
Figure 245: RemoteConnect ........................................................................................................................ 371
Figure 246: UCM RemoteConnect - Effective Plan ....................................................................................... 372
Figure 247: UCM RemoteConnect Plan Settings.......................................................................................... 373
Figure 248: Custom Logo ............................................................................................................................ 373
Figure 249: Concurrent Remote Calls .......................................................................................................... 374
Figure 250: Upload Prompt User Configuration ............................................................................................ 378
Figure 251: CTI Server Listening port .......................................................................................................... 379
Figure 252: SugarCRM Basic Settings ......................................................................................................... 381
Figure 253: CRM User Settings ................................................................................................................... 382
Figure 254: vTigerCRM Basic Settings......................................................................................................... 383
Figure 255: CRM User Settings ................................................................................................................... 384
Figure 256: ZohoCRM Basic Settings .......................................................................................................... 384
Figure 257: CRM User Settings ................................................................................................................... 385
Figure 258: Salesforce Basic Settings.......................................................................................................... 386
Figure 259: Salesforce User Settings ........................................................................................................... 387
Figure 260: Enabling ACT! CRM .................................................................................................................. 387
Figure 261: Enabling CRM on the User Portal .............................................................................................. 388
Figure 262: UCM & PMS interaction ............................................................................................................ 390
Figure 263: UCM & HSC PMS interaction .................................................................................................... 391
Figure 264: UCM & Mitel PMS interaction .................................................................................................... 392
Figure 265: UCM & IDS PMS interaction...................................................................................................... 392
Figure 266: Create New Room .................................................................................................................... 394
Figure 267: Room Status ............................................................................................................................. 394
Figure 268: Add batch rooms ....................................................................................................................... 395
Figure 269: Create New Wake Up Service ................................................................................................... 395
Figure 270: Wakeup Call executed .............................................................................................................. 396
Figure 271: Create New Mini Bar ................................................................................................................. 396
Figure 272: Create New Maid ...................................................................................................................... 397
Figure 273: Create New Consumer Goods................................................................................................... 397
Figure 274: Mini Bar .................................................................................................................................... 398
Figure 275: Create New Wakeup Service..................................................................................................... 399
Figure 276: Announcements Center ............................................................................................................. 402
Figure 277: Announcements Center Group Configuration............................................................................. 404
Figure 278: Announcements Center Code Configuration .............................................................................. 405
P a g e | 24
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 279: Announcements Center Example .............................................................................................. 405
Figure 280: StatusPBX Status .................................................................................................................. 406
Figure 281: Trunk Status.............................................................................................................................. 406
Figure 282: Extension Status ....................................................................................................................... 407
Figure 283: UCM6304 Interfaces Status ...................................................................................................... 408
Figure 284: System StatusStorage Usage ................................................................................................ 412
Figure 285: System StatusResource Usage ............................................................................................. 413
Figure 286: Alert Event List .......................................................................................................................... 414
Figure 287: System EventsAlert Events Lists: Disk Usage ........................................................................ 415
Figure 288: System EventsAlert Events Lists: External Disk Usage .......................................................... 415
Figure 289: System EventsAlert Events Lists: Memory Usage .................................................................. 416
Figure 290: System EventsAlert Events Lists: System Crash .................................................................... 416
Figure 291:System EventsAlert Events Lists: Register SIP Failed ............................................................. 417
Figure 292: System EventsAlert Events Lists: Register SIP Trunk Failed .................................................. 417
Figure 293: System EventsAlert Log......................................................................................................... 419
Figure 294: Filter for Alert Log...................................................................................................................... 420
Figure 295: CDR Filter ................................................................................................................................. 422
Figure 296: Call Report................................................................................................................................ 425
Figure 297: Call Report Entry with Audio Recording File .............................................................................. 426
Figure 298: Automatic Download Settings .................................................................................................... 427
Figure 299: CDR Report .............................................................................................................................. 427
Figure 300: Detailed CDR Information ......................................................................................................... 428
Figure 301: Downloaded CDR File Sample .................................................................................................. 428
Figure 302: Downloaded CDR File Sample - Source Channel and Dest Channel 1 ...................................... 428
Figure 303: Downloaded CDR File Sample - Source Channel and Dest Channel 2 ...................................... 429
Figure 304: CDR Export File data ................................................................................................................ 430
Figure 305: CDR in GDMS Cloud ................................................................................................................ 430
Figure 306: CDR Statistics........................................................................................................................... 431
Figure 307: CDRRecording Files .............................................................................................................. 432
Figure 308: Edit User Information by Super Admin ....................................................................................... 433
Figure 309: User Portal Login ...................................................................................................................... 434
Figure 310: User Portal Layout .................................................................................................................... 434
Figure 311: User Management Page Display ............................................................................................... 436
Figure 312: Create New User ...................................................................................................................... 436
Figure 313: User Management – New Users................................................................................................ 437
Figure 314: Assign Backup permission to "Admin" users .............................................................................. 438
Figure 315: General User ............................................................................................................................ 439
Figure 316: Create New Custom Privilege ................................................................................................... 440
Figure 317: Multiple User Operation Error Prompt ........................................................................................ 441
Figure 318: Change Password ..................................................................................................................... 441
P a g e | 25
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 319: Change Username .................................................................................................................... 442
Figure 320: Change Binding Email............................................................................................................... 442
Figure 321: Login Timeout Settings .............................................................................................................. 444
Figure 322: Operation Logs ......................................................................................................................... 445
Figure 323: Operation Logs Filter................................................................................................................. 446
Figure 324: Local Upgrade .......................................................................................................................... 446
Figure 325: Upgrading Firmware Files ......................................................................................................... 446
Figure 326: Reboot UCM630X ..................................................................................................................... 447
Figure 327: Create New Backup .................................................................................................................. 448
Figure 328: Restore Warning ....................................................................................................................... 449
Figure 329: Backup / Restore ...................................................................................................................... 449
Figure 330: Local Backup ............................................................................................................................ 450
Figure 331: Data Sync ................................................................................................................................. 451
Figure 332: Restore UCM630X from Backup File ......................................................................................... 452
Figure 333: Reset and Reboot ..................................................................................................................... 453
Figure 334: Manual Cleaning ....................................................................................................................... 454
Figure 335: Automatic Cleaning ................................................................................................................... 455
Figure 336: USB/SD Card Files Cleanup ..................................................................................................... 458
Figure 337: UCM6302 Recovery Web Page................................................................................................. 459
Figure 338: Recovery Mode......................................................................................................................... 460
Figure 339: Ethernet Capture....................................................................................................................... 462
Figure 340: Ping .......................................................................................................................................... 463
Figure 341: Traceroute ................................................................................................................................ 464
Figure 342: Troubleshooting Analog Trunks ................................................................................................. 465
Figure 343: A Key Dial-up FXO .................................................................................................................... 466
Figure 344: Service Check........................................................................................................................... 466
Figure 345: Network Status ......................................................................................................................... 467
P a g e | 26
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
DOCUMENT PURPOSE
The intent of this document is to provide device administrators an overview of the specifications and features of
the Grandstream UCM630X IPPBX system. To learn more about the UCM630X, please visit
http://www.grandstream.com/support to download additional guides.
P a g e | 27
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CHANGE LOG
This section documents significant changes from previous versions of the UCM630X user manuals. Only major
new features or major document updates are listed here. Minor updates for corrections or editing are not
documented here.
P a g e | 28
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Cloud Storage for CDR Backup and Record. [CDR in GDMS Cloud]
Add support for IDS PMS interface. [IDS PMS]
Add ability to enable PMS Wakeup call from remote extensions. [PMS Remote Wakeup Service]
Add ability to configure local country code for outbound route. [Local Country Code]
Add support for Pattern and Leading digit filtering options in Callee Number. [Callee Number]
Added description of SSH switch options in LCD menu. [Use the LCD Menu]
Add the ability to import/export DOD. [Direct Outward Dialing (DOD)]
Add the ability to enable auto record per inbound/outbound route. [Auto Record] [Auto Record]
Add the ability to Enable Recording Whitelist. [Enable Recording Whitelist]
Add the ability to select missed call type to be sent via email. [Missed Call Type]
The Filter action is now supported in AMI sessions. [ASTERISK MANAGER INTERFACE]
Added command to delete call recordings after downloading them. [recapi]
Added commands to add, edit, and delete PIN groups. [addPinSets] [getPinSets] [updatePinSets]
[deletePinSets]
Added External Disk Status alert event for monitoring external storage connection status. [Alert Events
List]
The language of column titles in exported CDR reports and statistics reports will now be based on the
UCM’s display language. [Downloaded CDR File]
Added Parking Lot Timeout Alert-Info option. This will add the specified alert-info header value to parking
timeout callbacks. [Parking Lot Timeout Alert-Info]
Updated HMobile check-in request format. [HMobile PMS Connector]
Updated HMobile Mini Bar request. [HMobile PMS Connector]
Added several updates to HSC PMS. [HSC PMS]
Added the ability to specify the reason for agent pause (*83 by default). [Agent Pause]
Added CDR Stored in GDMS Cloud option for RemoteConnect Plan Settings. [UCM RemoteConnect]
GDMS Cloud Storage has been added as a recording storage location in the PBX. [PBX
Settings/Recordings Storage]
After adding a UCM to GDMS, its RemoteConnect address will automatically be added as a SIP server
to the GDMS account. [UCM RemoteConnect]
Added the Ringback Tone option. Users can now select a custom prompt to play as ringback tone for
callers dialing in via the selected inbound route. [Ringback tone]
Ring Group Voicemail can now be set as a routing destination and an IVR key press destination. [Default
Destination]
Added the following custom privileges: LDAP Server, UCM RemoteConnect, and Announcement.
[Custom Privilege]
Added a Forgot Password option to the Wave Web login page. [Wave WebRTC Video Calling &
Conferencing]
Added a new command to set same-day wakeup service by dialing *36. [Wakeup Service]
P a g e | 29
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Firmware Version 1.0.2.25
P a g e | 30
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
WELCOME
Thank you for purchasing Grandstream UCM630X series IP PBX appliance. The UCM6300 series allows
businesses to build powerful and scalable unified communication and collaboration solutions. This series of IP
PBXs provide a platform that unifies all business communication on one centralized network, including voice,
video calling, video conferencing, video surveillance, web meetings, data, analytics, mobility, facility access,
intercoms and more. The UCM6300 series supports up to 3000 users and includes a built-in web meetings and
video conferencing solution that allows employees to connect from the desktop, mobile, GVC series devices and
IP phones. It can be paired with the UCM6300 ecosystem to offer a hybrid platform that combines the control of
an on-premises IP PBX with the remote access of a cloud solution. The UCM6300 ecosystem consists of the
Wave app for desktop and mobile, which provides a hub for collaborating remotely, and UCM RemoteConnect,
a cloud NAT traversal service for ensuring secure remote connections. The UCM6300 series also offers cloud
setup and management through GDMS and an API for integration with third-party platforms. By offering a high-
end unified communications and collaboration solution packed with a suite of mobility, security, meeting and
collaboration tools, the UCM6300 series provides a powerful platform for any organization. The UCM6301/6302
support 1 x ARM Cortex-A53 Quad-Core CPU and 2GB of memory while UCM6304/6308 support 2 x ARM
Cortex-A53 Quad-Core CPU and 2GB for master and 1GB slave memory.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Caution:
Changes or modifications to this product not expressly approved by Grandstream, or operation of this product in
any way other than as detailed by this User Manual, could void your manufacturer warranty.
Warning:
Please do not use a different power adaptor with the UCM630X as it may cause damage to the product and void
the manufacturer warranty.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
This document is subject to change without notice. The latest electronic version of this user manual is available
for download here:
http://www.grandstream.com/support
Reproduction or transmittal of the entire or any part, in any form or by any means, electronic or print, for any
purpose without the express written permission of Grandstream Networks, Inc. is not permitted.
P a g e | 31
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PRODUCT OVERVIEW
Technical Specifications
The following table resumes all the technical specifications including the protocols / standards supported, voice
codecs, telephony features, languages, and upgrade/provisioning settings for UCM630X series.
Interfaces
UCM6301: 1 port with lifeline support
UCM6302: 2 ports with lifeline support
Analog Telephone FXS
UCM6304: 4 ports with lifeline support
Ports
UCM6308: 8 ports with lifeline support
Each port supports 3 REN
UCM6301: 1 port
UCM6302: 2 ports
PSTN Line FXO Ports UCM6304: 4 ports
UCM6308: 8 ports
All ports have lifeline capability in case of power outage
Network Interfaces Three self-adaptive Gigabit ports (switched , routed or dual card mode) with PoE+
NAT Router Yes (supports router mode and switch mode)
UCM6301: USB 3.0, and SD card interface
Peripheral Ports UCM6302: USB 2.0, USB 3.0, and SD card interface
UCM6304/6308: 2x USB 3.0 and SD card interface
UCM6301/UCM6302: None
LED Indicators
UCM6304/6308: Power 1/2, FXS, FXO, LAN, WAN, Heartbeat
UCM6301/UCM6302: 320*240 LCD with touch screen for Shortcut Keys and
LCD Display Scroll Bar
UCM6304/6308: 128x32 dot matrix graphic LCD with DOWN and OK buttons
Reset Switch Yes, long press for factory reset and short press for reboot
Voice/Video Capabilities
LEC with NLP Packetized Voice Protocol Unit, 128ms-tail-length carrier grade Line
Voice-over-Packet
Echo Cancellation, Dynamic Jitter Buffer, Modem detection & auto-switch to
Capabilities
G.711, NetEQ, FEC 2.0, jitter resilience up to 50% audio packet loss
Opus, G.711 A-law/U-law, G.722, G722.1 G722.1C, G.723.1 5.3K/6.3K, G.726-32,
Voice and Fax Codecs
G.729A/B, iLBC, GSM; T.38
P a g e | 32
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Video Codecs H.264, H.263, H263+, H.265, VP8
QoS Layer 2 QoS (802.1Q, 802.1p) and Layer 3 (ToS, DiffServ, MPLS) QoS
Signaling and Control
DTMF Methods Inband, RFC4733, and SIP INFO
Mass provisioning using AES encrypted XML configuration file, auto-discovery &
Provisioning Protocol and
auto-provisioning of Grandstream IP endpoints via ZeroConfig (DHCP Option 66
Plug-and-Play
multicast SIP SUBSCRIBE mDNS), eventlist between local and remote trunk
TCP/UDP/IP, RTP/RTCP, ICMP, ARP, DNS, DDNS, DHCP, NTP, TFTP, SSH,
Network Protocols HTTP/HTTPS, PPPoE, STUN, SRTP, TLS, LDAP, HDLC, HDLC-ETH, PPP,
Frame Relay (pending), IPv6, OpenVPN®
API Full API available for third-party platform and application integration
Busy/Congestion/Howl Tone, Polarity Reversal, Hook Flash Timing, Loop Current
Disconnect Methods
Disconnect
Security
Media Encryption SRTP, TLS1.2, HTTPS, SSH, 802.1x
Physical
UCM6301/6302: Input: 100 ~ 240VAC, 50/60Hz; Output: DC+12V, 1.5A
Universal Power Supply
UCM6304/6308: Input: 100~240VAC,50/60Hz; Output: DC+12V, 2A
UCM6301/6302: 270mm(L) x 175mm(W) x 36mm(H)
Dimensions
UCM6304/6308: 485mm(L) x 187.2mm(W) x 46.2mm(H)
Operating: 32 - 113ºF / 0 ~ 45ºC, Humidity 10 - 90% (non-condensing)
Environmental
Storage: 14 - 140ºF / -10 ~ 60ºC, Humidity 10 - 90% (non-condensing)
Wall mount (sold separately) & Desktop for UCM6301/6302 and Desktop & Rack
Mounting
mount for UCM6304/6308.
UCM6301: Unit weight 715g, Package weight 1211g
UCM6302: Unit weight 725g, Package weight 1221g
Weight
UCM6304: Unit weight 2490g, Package weight 3260g
UCM6308: Unit weight 2550g, Package weight 3320g
Additional Features
Web UI: English, Simplified Chinese, Traditional Chinese, Spanish, French,
Portuguese, German, Russian, Italian, Polish, Czech, Turkish
Customizable IVR/voice prompts: English, Chinese, British English,
Multi-language Support
German, Spanish, Greek, French, Italian, Dutch, Polish, Portuguese,
Russian, Swedish, Turkish, Hebrew, Arabic, Netherlands
Customizable language pack to support any other languages
Caller ID Bellcore/Telcordia, ETSI-FSK, ETSI-DTMF, SIN 227 – BT, NTT
P a g e | 33
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Polarity Reversal/ Wink Yes, with enable/disable option upon call establishment and termination
Multiple configurable call queues, automatic call distribution (ACD) based on
Call Center
agent skills/availability/workload, in-queue announcement
Customizable Auto
Up to 5 layers of IVR (Interactive Voice Response) in multiple languages
Attendant
Telephony Operating
Based on Asterisk version 16
System
P a g e | 34
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Call park, call forward, call transfer, call waiting, caller ID, call record, call history,
ringtone, IVR, music on hold, call routes, DID, DOD, DND, DISA, ring group, ring
simultaneously, time schedule, PIN groups, call queue, pickup group,
Call Features paging/intercom, voicemail, call wakeup, SCA, BLF, voicemail to email, speed dial,
call back, dial by name, emergency call, call follow me, blacklist/whitelist, voice
conference, video conference, eventlist, feature codes, busy camp-on/ call
completion, voice control
Allows Android & iOS users to join UCM-hosted meetings & communicate with
Wave Mobile App
other users/solutions registered to the UCM6300
Supported by Grandstream Device Management System (GDMS), a zero-touch
Firmware Upgrade cloud provisioning and management system, It provides a centralized interface to
provision, manage, monitor, and troubleshoot Grandstream products
FCC: Part 15 (CFR 47) Class B, Part 68
CE: EN 55032, EN 55035, EN61000-3-2, EN61000-3-3, EN 62368.1, ES 203
021, ITU K.21
Compliance
IC: ICES-003, CS-03 Part I Issue 9
RCM: AS/NZS CISPR 32, AS/NZS 62368.1, AS/CA S002, AS/CA S003.1/.2
Power adapter: UL 60950-1 or UL 62368-1
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
UCM630X FXS ports lifeline functionality:
The UCM630X FXS interfaces are metallic through to the FXO interfaces. If there is power outage, FXS1 port
will fail over to FXO 1 port, FXS 2 port will fail over to FXO 2 port. The user can still access the PSTN connected
with the FXO interfaces from FXS interfaces.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 35
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
INSTALLATION
Before deploying and configuring the UCM630X series, the device needs to be properly powered up and
connected to a network. This section describes detailed information on installation, connection, and warranty
policy of the UCM630X series.
Equipment Packaging
Main Case 1
Power Adaptor 1
Ethernet Cable 1
Quick Installation Guide 1
Interface status
Navigation Keys
Information
Settings
OK
Back Home
P a g e | 36
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
WAN port Heartbeat port
FXO port
1. Connect one end of an RJ-45 Ethernet cable into the WAN port of the UCM6301.
2. Connect the other end of the Ethernet cable into the uplink port of an Ethernet switch/hub.
3. Connect the 12V DC power adapter into the 12V DC power jack on the back of the UCM6301. Insert the
main plug of the power adapter into a surge-protected power outlet.
4. Wait for the UCM6301 to boot up. The LCD in the front will show the device hardware information when the
boot process is done.
5. Once the UCM6301 is successfully connected to network, press the Home button to display the IP address.
6. (Optional) Connect PSTN lines from the wall jack to the FXO ports; connect analog lines (phone and Fax)
to the FXS ports.
Note:
P a g e | 37
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
UCM6302 front and back view
WAN port
Heartbeat port 2x FXO ports
Power LED
Navigation keys 4x FXS LEDs LAN LED 2x USB ports
WAN LED
OK button 4x FXO LEDs SD card slot
Heartbeat LED
Power
WAN port 4x FXO ports
Heartbeat port
P a g e | 38
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
UCM6308 front and back view
Power LED
Navigation keys 8x FXS LEDs LAN LED 2x USB ports
WAN LED
OK button 8x FXO LEDs SD card slot
Heartbeat LED
Power
WAN port 8x FXO ports
Heartbeat port
Safety Compliances
The UCM630X series IP PBX complies with FCC/CE and various safety standards. The UCM630X power
adapter is compliant with the UL standard. Use the universal power adapter provided with the UCM630X package
only. The manufacturer’s warranty does not cover damages to the device caused by unsupported power
adapters.
Warranty
If the UCM630X series IP PBX was purchased from a reseller, please contact the company where the device
was purchased for replacement, repair, or refund. If the device was purchased directly from Grandstream,
contact our Technical Support Team for an RMA (Return Materials Authorization) number before the product is
returned. Grandstream reserves the right to remedy warranty policy without prior notification.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Warning:
Use the power adapter provided with the UCM630X series IP PBX. Do not use a different power adapter as this
may damage the device. This type of damage is not covered under warranty.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 39
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
GETTING STARTED
To get started with the UCM630X setup process, use the following available interfaces: LCD display, and web
portal.
The LCD display shows hardware, software, interface status and network information and can be navigated
via the Slide control and Touch keys. From here, users can configure basic network settings, run diagnostic
tests, and factory reset.
The web portal (may also be referred to as web UI in this guide) is the primary method of configuring the
UCM.
This section will provide step-by-step instructions on how to use these interfaces to quickly set up the UCM and
start making and receiving calls with it.
Idle Screen
Once the device has booted up completely, the LCD will show the UCM model, hardware version and IP
address. Upon menu key press timeout (30 seconds), the screen will default back to this information.
Menu
Pressing the Home button will show the main menu. All available menu options are found in [Table 3: LCD
Menu Options].
Menu Navigation
Scrolling sown using slide control through the menu options. Press the OK button to select an option.
Exit
Selecting the Back option will return to the previous menu. For the Device Info, Network Info, and Web Info
screens that have no Back option, pressing the OK button will return to the previous menu.
LCD Backlight
The LCD backlight will turn on upon button press and will go off when idle for 30 seconds.
The following table summarizes the layout of the LCD menu of UCM630x.
P a g e | 40
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 3: LCD Menu Options
Critical Events
View Events
Other Events
Reboot
Factory Reset
Fan Mode
P a g e | 41
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Hardware Testing
Select Test SVIP to verify hardware connections within the device. The result
will display on the LCD when the test is complete.
Enable SSH
SSH Switch Disable SSH
SSH access is disabled by default
The UCM6301/6302 has LED indicators on the network port to display connection status and the following picture
shows the other ports status.
The UCM6304/6308 has LED indicators in the front to display connection status. The following table shows the
status definitions.
Table 4: UCM6304/6308 LED Indicators
P a g e | 42
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Using the Web UI
The UCM's web server responds to HTTP/HTTPS GET/POST requests. Embedded HTML pages allow users to
configure the device through a web browser such Microsoft IE (version 8+), Mozilla Firefox, Google Chrome,
etc. To access the UCM's web portal, follow the steps below:
3. Enter the UCM's IP address into a web browsers' address bar. The login page should appear (please
see the above image).
4. Enter default administrator username “admin” and password can be found on the sticker at the back of
the UCM.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
By default, the UCM630X has Redirect From Port 80 enabled. As such, if users type in the UCM630X IP
address in the web browser, the web page will be automatically redirected to the page using HTTPS and port
8089. For example, if the LCD shows 192.168.40.167, and 192.168.40.167 is entered into the web browser, the
web page will be redirected to: https://192.168.40.167:8089
The option Redirect From Port 80 can be found under the UCM630X Web GUISystem SettingsHTTP
Server.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 43
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Setup Wizard
After logging into the UCM web portal for the first time, the setup wizard will guide the user through basic
configurations such as time zone, network settings, trunks, and routing rules.
The setup wizard can be closed and reopened at any time. At the end of the wizard, a summary of the pending
configuration changes can be reviewed before applying them.
Main Settings
There are 8 main sections in the web portal to manage various features of the UCM.
System Status: Displays the dashboard, system information, current active calls, and network status.
Extensions/Trunks: Manages extensions, trunks, and routing rules.
Call Features: Manages various features of the UCM such as the IVR and voicemail.
PBX Settings: Manages the settings related to PBX functionality such as SIP settings and interface
settings.
System Settings: Manages the settings related to the UCM system itself such as network and security
settings.
CDR: Contains the call detail records, statistics, and audio recordings of calls processed by the UCM.
Value-Added Features: Manages the settings of features unrelated to core PBX functionality such as Zero
Config provisioning and CRM/PMS integrations.
Maintenance: Manages settings and logs related to system management and maintenance such as
user management, activity logs, backup settings, upgrade settings and troubleshooting tools.
P a g e | 44
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Web GUI Languages
Currently the UCM630X series Web GUI supports English, Simplified Chinese, Traditional Chinese,
Spanish, French, Portuguese, Russian, Italian, Polish, German etc.
Users can select the UCM's web UI display language in the top-right corner of the page.
Users can search for options in the web portal with the search bar on the top right of the page.
P a g e | 45
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 14: Web GUI Search Bar
After making changes to a page, click on the "Save" button to save them and then the "Apply Changes" button
that finalizes the changes. If a modification requires a reboot, a prompt will appear asking to reboot the device.
Setting Up an Extension
Power on the UCM630X and your SIP endpoint. Connect both devices to the same network and follow the steps
below to set up an extension.
1. Log into the UCM web portal and navigate to Extension/TrunkExtensions
2. Click on the "Add" button to start creating a new extension. The Extension and SIP/IAX Password
information will be used to register to this extension. To set up voicemail, the Voicemail Password will
be required.
3. To register an endpoint to this extension, go into your endpoint's web UI and edit the desired account.
Enter the newly created extension's number, SIP user ID, and password into their corresponding fields
on the endpoint. Enter the UCM's IP address into the SIP server field. If setting up voicemail, enter *97
into the Voice Mail Access Number field. This field may be named differently on other devices.
4. To access the extension's voicemail, use the newly registered extension to dial *97 and access the
personal voicemail system. Once prompted, enter the voicemail password. If successful, you will now
be prompted with various voicemail options.
5. You have now set up an extension on an endpoint.
P a g e | 46
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SYSTEM SETTINGS
This section will explain the available system-wide parameters and configuration options on the UCM630X
series. This includes settings for the following items: General Settings, HTTP server, network Settings,
OpenVPN, DDNS Settings, Security Settings, LDAP server, Time settings, Email settings and TR-069.
General Settings
System administrators can prevent the UCM from making calls and/or writing to the data partition (e.g., CDR,
recordings, etc.) once the system reaches a specified threshold of storage usage and CPU usage respectively.
These options are located in the System Settings General Settings page.
General Settings
Device Name Configure the name of the UCM.
Enable CPU Flow Control Enables the CPU flow control.
Used to set the threshold generated by the CPU Flow Control. When the
CPU Flow Control Threshold system CPU reaches the threshold, it will prohibit the new calls.
Default value is 90%.
Used to set a threshold to stop writing data partition. When the disk data
Data Partition Write
partition reaches the threshold configured, the data partition writing will be
Threshold
stopped. Default value is 90%.
P a g e | 47
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
HTTP Server
The UCM630X's embedded web server responds to HTTPS GET/POST requests and allows users to configure
the UCM via web browsers such as Microsoft IE, Mozilla Firefox, and Google Chrome. By default, users can
access the UCM by just typing its IP address into a browser address bar. The browser will automatically be
redirected to HTTPS using port 8089. For example, typing in "192.168.40.50" into the address bar will redirect
the browser to "https://192.168.40.50:8089". This behavior can be changed in the System SettingsHTTP
Server page.
Table 6: HTTP Server Settings
P a g e | 48
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Uploads the private key for the HTTP server.
TLS Private Key Note: Key file must be under 2MB in file size and in *.pem format. File
name will automatically be changed to "private.pem".
Uploads the certificate for the HTTP server.
Note: Certificate must be under 2MB in file size and in *.pem format. This
TLS Cert
will be used for TLS connections and contains private key for the client
and signed certificate for the server.
Enter the domain to request the certificate for and click on
Domain
to request the certificate.
If the protocol or port has been changed, the user will be logged out and redirected to the new URL.
Network Settings
After successfully connecting the UCM630X to the network for the first time, users could login the Web GUI and
go to System SettingsNetwork Settings to configure the network parameters for the device.
In this section, all the available network setting options are listed for all models. Select each tab in Web
GUISystem SettingsNetwork Settings page to configure LAN settings, WAN settings, 802.1X and Port
Forwarding.
Basic Settings
Please refer to the following tables for basic network configuration parameters on UCM6301, UCM6302,
UCM6304 and UCM6308, respectively.
Select "Route", "Switch" or "Dual" mode on the network interface of UCM630X. The default
setting is "Route".
Route
WAN port will be used for uplink connection. LAN port will function similarly to a regular
router port.
Method
Switch
WAN port will be used for uplink connection. LAN port will be used as a bridge for
connections.
Dual
Both WAN and LAN ports will be used for uplink connections labeled as LAN2 and
P a g e | 49
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
LAN1, respectively. The port selected as the Default Interface will need to have a
gateway IP address configured if it is using a static IP.
MTU Specifies the maximum transmission unit value. Default is 1492.
IPv4 Address
Preferred DNS
If configured, this will be used as the Primary DNS server.
Server
WAN (when "Method" is set to "Route")
IP Method Select DHCP, Static IP, or PPPoE. The default setting is DHCP.
IP Address Enter the IP address for static IP settings. The default setting is 192.168.0.160.
Subnet Mask Enter the subnet mask address for static IP settings. The default setting is 255.255.0.0.
Gateway IP Enter the gateway IP address for static IP settings. The default setting is 0.0.0.0.
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static IP settings.
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static IP settings.
Username Enter the username to connect via PPPoE.
Password Enter the password to connect via PPPoE.
Layer 2 QoS
802.1Q/VLAN Assign the VLAN tag of the layer 2 QoS packets for WAN port. The default value is 0.
Tag
Layer 2 QoS
802.1p Priority Assign the priority value of the layer 2 QoS packets for WAN port. The default value is 0.
Value
LAN (when Method is set to "Route")
IP Address Enter the IP address assigned to LAN port. The default setting is 192.168.2.1.
Subnet Mask Enter the subnet mask. The default setting is 255.255.255.0.
DHCP Server
Enable or disable DHCP server capability. The default setting is "Yes".
Enable
DNS Server 1 Enter DNS server address 1. The default setting is 8.8.8.8.
DNS Server 2 Enter DNS server address 2. The default setting is 208.67.222.222.
Allow IP
Enter the DHCP IP Pool starting address. The default setting is 192.168.2.100.
Address From
Allow IP Enter the DHCP IP Pool ending address.
Address To The default setting is 192.168.2.254.
Default IP
Enter the IP lease time (in seconds). The default setting is 43200.
Lease Time
P a g e | 50
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
LAN (when Method is set to "Switch")
IP Method Select DHCP, Static IP, or PPPoE. The default setting is DHCP.
IP Address Enter the IP address for static IP settings. The default setting is 192.168.0.160.
Subnet Mask Enter the subnet mask address for static IP settings. The default setting is 255.255.0.0.
Gateway IP Enter the gateway IP address for static IP settings. The default setting is 0.0.0.0.
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static IP settings.
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static IP settings.
Username Enter the username to connect via PPPoE.
Password Enter the password to connect via PPPoE.
Layer 2 QoS
802.1Q/VLAN Assign the VLAN tag of the layer 2 QoS packets for LAN port. The default value is 0.
Tag
Layer 2 QoS
802.1p Priority Assign the priority value of the layer 2 QoS packets for LAN port. The default value is 0.
Value
LAN 1 / LAN 2 (when Method is set to "Dual")
If "Dual" is selected as "Method", users will need assign the default interface to be LAN 1
Default
(mapped to UCM6302 WAN port) or LAN 2 (mapped to UCM6302 LAN port) and then
Interface
configure network settings for LAN 1/LAN 2. The default interface is LAN 2.
IP Method Select DHCP, Static IP, or PPPoE. The default setting is DHCP.
IP Address Enter the IP address for static IP settings. The default setting is 192.168.0.160.
Subnet Mask Enter the subnet mask address for static IP settings. The default setting is 255.255.0.0.
Enter the gateway IP address for static IP settings when the port is assigned as default
Gateway IP
interface. The default setting is 0.0.0.0.
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static IP settings.
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static IP settings.
P a g e | 51
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
IPv6 Address
WAN (when "Method" is set to "Route")
IP Method Select Auto or Static. The default setting is Auto
IP Address Enter the IP address for static IP settings.
IP Prefixlen Enter the Prefix length for static settings. Default is 64
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static settings.
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static settings.
LAN (when Method is set to "Route")
Select Disable, Auto or DHCPv6.
Disable: the DHCPv6 server is disabled.
DHCP Server Auto: Stateless address auto configuration using NDP protocol.
DHCPv6: Stateful address auto configuration using DHCPv6 protocol.
The default setting is Disabled.
DHCP Prefix Enter DHCP prefix. (Default is 2001:db8:2:2::)
DHCP
Enter the Prefix length for static settings. Default is 64
prefixlen
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static settings. Default is (2001:4860:4860::8888 )
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static settings. Default is (2001:4860:4860::8844 )
Allow IP
Configure starting IP address assigned by the DHCP prefix and DHCP prefixlen.
Address From
Allow IP
Configure the ending IP address assigned by the DHCP Prefix and DHCP prefixlen.
Address To
Default IP
Configure the lease time (in second) of the IP address.
Lease Time
LAN (when Method is set to "Switch")
IP Method Select Auto or Static. The default setting is Auto
IP Address Enter the IP address for static IP settings.
IP Prefixlen Enter the Prefix length for static settings. Default is 64
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static settings.
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static settings.
LAN 1 / LAN 2 (when Method is set to "Dual")
Users will need assign the default interface to be LAN 1 (mapped to UCM630X WAN port)
Default
or LAN 2 (mapped to UCM630X LAN port) and then configure network settings for LAN
Interface
1/LAN 2. The default interface is LAN 1.
IP Method Select Auto or Static. The default setting is Auto
IP Address Enter the IP address for static IP settings.
P a g e | 52
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
IP Prefixlen Enter the Prefix length for static settings. Default is 64
DNS Server 1 Enter the DNS server 1 address for static settings.
DNS Server 2 Enter the DNS server 2 address for static settings.
Method: Route
When the UCM630X has, method set to Route in network settings, WAN port interface is used for uplink
connection and LAN port interface is used as a router. Please see a sample diagram below.
Method: Switch
WAN port interface is used for uplink connection; LAN port interface is used as room for PC connection.
P a g e | 53
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 17: UCM6302 Network Interface Method: Switch
Method: Dual
Both WAN port and LAN port are used for uplink connection. Users will need assign LAN 1 or LAN 2 as the
default interface in option "Default Interface" and configure "Gateway IP" if static IP is used for this interface.
P a g e | 54
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 18: UCM6302 Network Interface Method: Dual
802.1X
IEEE 802.1X is an IEEE standard for port-based network access control. It provides an authentication
mechanism to device before the device can access Internet or other LAN resources. The UCM630X supports
802.1X as a supplicant/client to be authenticated. The following diagram and figure show UCM630X use 802.1X
mode “EAP-MD5” on WAN port as client in the network to access Internet.
P a g e | 55
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 20: UCM630X Using 802.1X EAP-MD5
The following table shows the configuration parameters for 802.1X on UCM630X. Identity and MD5 password
are required for authentication, which should be provided by the network administrator obtained from the
RADIUS server. If “EAP-TLS” or “EAP-PEAPv0/MSCHAPv2” is used, users will also need to upload 802.1X CA
Certificate and 802.1X Client Certificate, which should be also generated from the RADIUS server.
Select 802.1X mode. The default setting is "Disable". The supported 802.1X mode
are:
802.1X Mode EAP-MD5
EAP-TLS
EAP-PEAPv0/MSCHAPv2
Identity Enter 802.1X mode Identity information.
MD5 Password Enter 802.1X mode MD5 password information.
802.1X CA Certificate Select 802.1X certificate from local PC and then upload.
802.1X Client
Select 802.1X client certificate from local PC and then upload.
Certificate
Static Routes
The UCM630X provides users static routing capability that allows the device to use manually configured routes,
rather than information only from dynamic routing or gateway configured in the UCM630X Web GUISystem
SettingsNetwork SettingsBasic Settings to forward traffic. It can be used to define a route when no other
routes are available or necessary, or used in complementary with existing routing on the UCM630X as a failover
backup, etc.
P a g e | 56
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Click on “Add IPv4 Static Route” to create a new IPv4 static route or click on ”Add IPv6 Static Route” to
create a new IPv6 static route. The configuration parameters are listed in the table below.
Configure the destination IPv4 address or the destination IPv6 subnet for the
UCM630X to reach using the static route.
Destination Example:
IPv4 address - 192.168.66.4
IPv6 subnet - 2001:740:D::1/64
Configure the subnet mask for the above destination address. If left blank, the
default value is 255.255.255.255.
Subnet Mask
Example:
255.255.255.0
Configure the IPv4 or IPv6 gateway address so that the UCM630X can reach the
destination via this gateway. Gateway address is optional.
Gateway
Example:
192.168.40.5 or 2001:740:D::1
Specify the network interface on the UCM630X to reach the destination using the
Interface static route.
LAN interface is eth0; WAN interface is eth1.
The following diagram shows a sample application of static route usage on UCM6304.
P a g e | 57
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
UCM6304
In this network, by default the IP phones in network 192.168.69.0 are unable to call IP phones in network
192.168.66.0 when registered on different interfaces on the UCM6304. Therefore, we need configure a static
route on the UCM6304 so that the phones in isolated networks can make calls between each other.
P a g e | 58
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 22: UCM6304 Static Route Configuration
Port Forwarding
The UCM network interface supports router function which provides users the ability to do port forwarding. If
LAN mode is set to "Route" under Web GUISystem SettingsNetwork SettingsBasic Settings page,
port forwarding is available for configuration.
The port forwarding configuration is under Web GUISystem SettingsNetwork SettingsPort Forwarding
page. Please see related settings in the table below.
Specify the WAN port number or a range of WAN ports. Unlimited number of
ports can be configured.
Note:
WAN Port When it is set to a range, WAN port and LAN port must be configured with the
same range, such as WAN port: 1000-1005 and LAN port: 1000-1005, and
access from WAN port will be forwarded to the LAN port with the same port
number, for example, WAN port 1000 will be port forwarding to LAN port 1000.
LAN IP Specify the LAN IP address.
P a g e | 59
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
from WAN port will be forwarded to the LAN port with the same port number, for
example, WAN port 1000 will be port forwarding to LAN port 1000.
Select protocol type "UDP Only", "TCP Only" or "TCP/UDP" for the forwarding in
Protocol Type
the selected port. The default setting is "UDP Only".
The following figures demonstrate a port forwarding example to provide phone’s Web GUI access to public side.
P a g e | 60
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 24: UCM630X Port Forwarding Configuration
This will allow users to access the GXP2160 Web GUI from public side, by typing in public IP address (example:
1.1.1.1:8088).
ARP Settings
The ARP settings can be configured under Web GUISystem SettingsNetwork SettingsARP Settings
P a g e | 61
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 11: ARP Settings
Minimum number of entries to keep. Garbage collector will not purge entries if there
ARP GC
are fewer than this number. The default value is 128.
Threshold 1
ARP GC Threshold when garbage collector becomes more aggressive about purging
Threshold 2 entries. Entries older than 5 seconds will be cleared when over this number. The
default value is 512.
Maximum number of non-PERMANENT neighbor entries allowed. Increase this
ARP GC
when using large numbers of interfaces and when communicating with large
Threshold 3
numbers of directly connected peers. The default value is 1024.
OpenVPN®
OpenVPN® settings allow the users to configure UCM630X to use VPN features, the following table gives details
about the various options in order to configure the UCM as OpenVPN Client.
OpenVPN®
Enable / Disable the OpenVPN® feature.
Enable
OpenVPN®
Server Address Configures the hostname/IP and port of the server. For example: 192.168.1.2:22
OpenVPN® Specify the protocol user, user should use the same settings as used on the
Server Protocol server
Use the same setting as used on the server.
OpenVPN®
Dev TUN: Create a routed IP tunnel.
Device mode
Dev TAP: Create an Ethernet tunnel.
OpenVPN® Use Compress tunnel packets using the LZO algorithm on the VPN link. Do not
Compression enable this unless it is also enabled in the server config file.
Enable Weak
Either to enable the Weak SSL ciphers or not.
SSL Ciphers
P a g e | 62
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
OpenVPN®
Specify the cryptographic cipher. Users should make sure to use the same
Encryption
setting that they are using on the OpenVPN server.
Algorithm
OpenVPN® CA Upload as SSL/TLS root certificate. This file will be renamed as ‘ca.crt’
Cert automatically.
OpenVPN®
Upload a client certificate. This file will be renamed as ‘cliend.crt’ automatically.
Client Cert
OpenVPN®
Upload a client private key. This file will be renamed as ‘client.key’ automatically.
Client Key
P a g e | 63
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
DDNS Settings
DDNS setting allows user to access UCM630X via domain name instead of IP address.
The UCM supports DDNS service from the following DDNS provider:
dydns.org
noip.com
freedns.afraid.org
zoneedit.com
oray.net
1. Register domain in DDNS service provider. Please note the UCM630X needs to have public IP access.
P a g e | 64
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 28: UCM630X DDNS Setting
3. Now you can use domain name instead of IP address to connect to the UCM630X Web GUI.
P a g e | 65
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Security Settings
The UCM630X provides users firewall security configurations to prevent certain malicious attack to the
UCM630X system. Users could configure to allow, restrict, or reject specific traffic through the device for security
and bandwidth purpose. The UCM630X also provides Fail2ban feature for authentication errors in SIP
REGISTER, INVITE and SUBSCRIBE. To configure firewall settings in the UCM630X, go to Web GUISystem
SettingsSecurity Settings page.
Static Defense
Under Web GUISystem SettingsSecurity SettingsStatic Defense page, users will see the following
information:
The following table shows a sample current service status running on the UCM630X.
P a g e | 66
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
10012 gs_avs udp/ipv4 gs_avs
10013 gs_avs udp/ipv4 gs_avs
10014 gs_avs udp/ipv4 gs_avs
10015 gs_avs udp/ipv4 gs_avs
For typical firewall settings, users could configure the following options on the UCM630X.
If enabled, ICMP response will not be allowed for Ping request. The default
Ping Defense
setting is disabled. To enable or disable it, click on the check box for the LAN or
Enable
WAN (UCM630X) interface.
Allows the UCM630X to handle excessive amounts of SYN packets from one
source and keep the web portal accessible. There are two options available and
only one of these options may be enabled at one time.
SYN-Flood
eth(0)LAN defends against attacks directed to the LAN IP address of the
Defense Enable
UCM630X.
eth(1)WAN defends against attacks directed to the WAN IP address of the
UCM630X.
P a g e | 67
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SYN Flood Defense will limit the amount of SYN packets accepted by the UCM
from one source to 10 packets per second. Any excess packets from that source
will be discarded.
Enable to prevent Ping-of-Death attack to the device. The default setting is
Ping-of-Death
disabled. To enable or disable it, click on the check box for the LAN or WAN
Defense Enable
(UCM630X) interface.
Under "Custom Firewall Settings", users could create new rules to accept, reject or drop certain traffic going
through the UCM630X. To create new rule, click on "Create New Rule" button and a new window will pop up for
users to specify rule options.
Right next to "Create New Rule" button, there is a checkbox for option "Reject Rules". If it is checked, all the
rules will be rejected except the firewall rules listed below. In the firewall rules, only when there is a rule that
meets all the following requirements, the option "Reject Rules" will be allowed to check:
Action: "Accept"
Type "In"
Destination port is set to the system login port (e.g., by default 8089)
Protocol is not UDP
P a g e | 68
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 15: Firewall Rule Settings
Rule Name Specify the Firewall rule name to identify the firewall rule.
Save the change and click on "Apply" button. Then submit the configuration by clicking on "Apply Changes" on
the upper right of the web page. The new rule will be listed at the bottom of the page with sequence number,
rule name, action, protocol, type, source, destination, and operation. More operations below:
P a g e | 69
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Dynamic Defense
Dynamic defense is supported on the UCM630X series. It can blacklist hosts dynamically when the LAN mode
is set to "Route" under Web GUISystem SettingsNetwork SettingsBasic Settings page. If enabled, the
traffic coming into the UCM630X can be monitored, which helps prevent massive connection attempts or brute
force attacks to the device. The blacklist can be created and updated by the UCM630X firewall, which will then
be displayed in the web page. Please refer to the following table for dynamic defense options on the UCM630X.
Dynamic Defense
Enable dynamic defense. The default setting is disabled.
Enable
Blacklist Update Configure the blacklist update time interval (in seconds). The default setting is
Interval 120.
Configure the connection threshold. Once the number of connections from the
Connection
same host reaches the threshold, it will be added into the blacklist. The default
Threshold
setting is 100.
Allowed IPs and ports range, multiple IP addresses and port range.
Dynamic Defense For example:
Whitelist 192.168.2.100-192.168.2.105, 1000:9999
If a host at IP address 192.168.5.7 initiates more than 20 TCP connections to the UCM630X it will be added
into UCM630X blacklist.
This host 192.168.5.7 will be blocked by the UCM630X for 500 seconds.
Since IP range 192.168.5.100-192.168.5.200 is in whitelist, if a host initiates more than 20 TCP connections
to the UCM630X it will not be added into UCM630X blacklist. It can still establish TCP connection with the
UCM630X.
P a g e | 70
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 31: Configure Dynamic Defense
Fail2ban
Fail2Ban feature on the UCM630X provides intrusion detection and prevention for authentication errors in SIP
REGISTER, INVITE and SUBSCRIBE. Once the entry is detected within "Max Retry Duration", the UCM630X
will act to forbid the host for certain period as defined in "Banned Duration". This feature helps prevent SIP brute
force attacks to the PBX system.
P a g e | 71
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 32: Fail2ban Settings
Table 17: Fail2Ban Settings
Global Settings
Enable Fail2Ban. The default setting is disabled. Please make sure both "Enable
Enable Fail2Ban Fail2Ban" and "Asterisk Service" are turned on to use Fail2Ban for SIP
authentication on the UCM630X.
Configure the duration (in seconds) for the detected host to be banned. The default
Banned Duration
setting is 600. If set to 0, the host will be always banned.
P a g e | 72
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Within this duration (in seconds), if a host exceeds the max times of retry as
Max Retry Duration
defined in "MaxRetry", the host will be banned. The default setting is 600.
Configure the number of authentication failures during "Max Retry Duration" before
MaxRetry
the host is banned. The default setting is 5.
Configure IP address, CIDR mask or DNS host in the whitelist. Fail2Ban will not
Fail2Ban Whitelist ban the host with matching address in this list. Up to 20 addresses can be added
into the list.
Local Settings
Enable Asterisk service for Fail2Ban. The default setting is disabled. Please make
Asterisk Service sure both "Enable Fail2Ban" and "Asterisk Service" are turned on to use Fail2Ban
for SIP authentication on the UCM630X.
Listening Port Configure the listening port number for the service. By default, port 5060 will be
Number used for UDP and TCP, and port 5061 will be used for TCP.
Configure the number of authentication failures during "Max Retry Duration" before
MaxRetry the host is banned. The default setting is 5. Please make sure this option is
properly configured as it will override the "MaxRetry" value under "Global Settings".
Enables defense against excessive login attacks to the UCM’s web GUI.
Login Attack Defense
The default setting is disabled.
This is the Web GUI listening port number which is configured under System
Listening Port
SettingsHTTP ServerPort.
Number
The default is 8089.
When the number of failed login attempts from an IP address exceeds the
MaxRetry
MaxRetry number, that IP address will be banned from accessing the Web GUI.
Blacklist
Blacklist Users will be able to view the IPs that have been blocked by UCM.
SSH Access
SSH switch now is available via Web GUI and LCD. User can enable or disable SSH access directly from Web
GUI or LCD screen. For web SSH access, please log in UCM630X web interface and go to Web GUISystem
SettingsSecurity SettingsSSH Access.
The "Enable SSH access" option is for system debugging. If you enable this option, the system will allow SSH
access. The SSH connection also requires the username and password of the super administrator. This option
is turned off by default. It is recommended to turn off this option when debugging is not required.
Enable the "Enable remote SSH (via GDMS)" option, the system will allow remote SSH access via the GDMS
platform. This option is turned off by default, and it is strongly recommended to turn off this option when remote
troubleshooting is not required.
P a g e | 73
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 33: SSH Access
Table 18: SSH Access
This option is used for system debugging. Once enabled, UCM will allow SSH
access. The SSH connection requires super administrator's username and
Enable SSH Access
password. The default setting is "No". It is recommended to set it to "No" if there is
no need for debugging.
If this option is enabled, remote SSH access will be allowed through the GDMS
Enable Remote SSH
platform. It is strongly recommended to keep this disabled unless remote
via GDMS
troubleshooting is necessary.
LDAP Server
The UCM630X has an embedded LDAP/LDAPS server for users to manage corporate phonebook in a
centralized manner.
By default, the LDAP server has generated the first phonebook with PBX DN "ou=pbx,dc=pbx,dc=com"
based on the UCM630X user extensions already.
Users could add new phonebook with a different Phonebook DN for other external contacts. For example,
"ou=people,dc=pbx,dc=com".
All the phonebooks in the UCM630X LDAP server have the same Base DN "dc=pbx,dc=com".
Term Explanation:
P a g e | 74
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If users have the Grandstream phone provisioned by the UCM630X, the LDAP directory will be set up on the
phone and can be used right away for users to access all phonebooks.
Additionally, users could manually configure the LDAP client settings to manipulate the built-in LDAP server on
the UCM630X. If the UCM630X has multiple LDAP phonebooks created, in the LDAP client configuration, users
could use "dc=pbx,dc=com" as Base DN to have access to all phonebooks on the UCM630X LDAP server, or
use a specific phonebook DN, for example "ou=people,dc=pbx,dc=com", to access to phonebook with
Phonebook DN "ou=people,dc=pbx,dc=com " only.
UCM can also act as a LDAP client to download phonebook entries from another LDAP server.
To access LDAP server and client settings, go to Web GUISettingsLDAP Server.
The following figure shows the default LDAP server configurations on the UCM630X.
P a g e | 75
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The UCM630X LDAP server supports anonymous access (read-only) by default. Therefore, the LDAP client
does not have to configure username and password to access the phonebook directory. The "Root DN" and
"Root Password" here are for LDAP management and configuration where users will need provide for
authentication purpose before modifying the LDAP information.
The default phonebook list in this LDAP server can be viewed and edited by clicking on for the first
phonebook under LDAP Phonebook.
The UCM630X support secure LDAP (LDAPS) where the communication is encrypted and secure.
P a g e | 76
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
LDAP Phonebook
Users could use the default phonebook, edit the default phonebook, add new phonebook, import phonebook on
the LDAP server as well as export phonebook from the LDAP server. The first phonebook with default phonebook
dn "ou=pbx,dc=pbx,dc=com" displayed on the LDAP server page is for extensions in this PBX. Users cannot
add or delete contacts directly. The contacts information will need to be modified via Web
GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions first. The default LDAP phonebook will then be updated automatically.
A new sibling phonebook of the default PBX phonebook can be added by clicking on "Add" under "LDAP
Phonebook" section.
Configure the "Phonebook Prefix" first. The "Phonebook DN" will be automatically filled in. For example, if
configuring "Phonebook Prefix" as "people", the "Phonebook DN" will be filled with "ou=people,dc=pbx,dc=com".
Once added, users can select to edit the phonebook attributes and contact list (see figure below) or select
to delete the phonebook.
P a g e | 77
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 39: Edit LDAP Phonebook
Click on “Import Phonebook” and a dialog will prompt as shown in the figure below.
The file to be imported must be a CSV, VCF or XML file with UTF-8 encoding. Users can open the file with
Notepad and save it with UTF-8 encoding.
Here is how a sample file looks like. Please note “Account Number” and “Phonebook DN” fields are required.
Users could export a phonebook file from the UCM630X LDAP phonebook section first and use it as a sample
to start with.
P a g e | 78
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The Phonebook DN field is the same “Phonebook Prefix” entry as when the user clicks on “Add” to create a new
phonebook. Therefore, if the user enters “phonebook” in “Phonebook DN” field in the CSV file, the actual
phonebook DN “ou=phonebook,dc=pbx,dc=com” will be automatically created by the UCM630X once the CSV
file is imported.
In the CSV file, users can specify different phonebook DN fields for different contacts. If the phonebook DN
already exists on the UCM630X LDAP Phonebook, the contacts in the CSV file will be added into the existing
phonebook. If the phonebook DN does not exist on the UCM630X LDAP Phonebook, a new phonebook with this
phonebook DN will be created.
The sample phonebook CSV file in above picture will result in the following LDAP phonebook in the UCM630X.
As the default LDAP phonebook with DN “ou=pbx,dc=pbx,dc=com” cannot be edited or deleted in LDAP
phonebook section, users cannot import contacts with Phonebook DN field “pbx” if existed in the CSV file.
Select the checkbox for the LDAP phonebook and then click on “Export Selected Phonebook” to export the
selected phonebook. The exported phonebook can be used as a record or a sample CSV, VFC or XML file for
the users to add more contacts in it and import to the UCM630X again.
P a g e | 79
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 43: Export Selected LDAP Phonebook
The configuration on LDAP client is useful when you use other LDAP servers. Here we provide an example on
how to configure the LDAP client on the UCM.
Assuming the remote server base dn is “dc=pbx,dc=com”, configure the LDAP client as follows:
The following figure gives a sample configuration for UCM acting as a LDAP client.
P a g e | 80
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
To configure Grandstream IP phones as the LDAP clients for UCM, please refer to the following example:
The following figure shows the configuration information on a Grandstream GXP2170 to successfully use the
LDAP server as configured in [Figure 34: LDAP Server Configurations].
P a g e | 81
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 45: GXP2170 LDAP Phonebook Configuration
Time Settings
The current system time on the UCM630X can be found under Web GUISystem StatusDashboardPBX
Status.
To configure the UCM630X to update time automatically, go to Web GUISystem SettingsTime
SettingsAutomatic date and Time.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
The configurations under Web GUISettingsTime Settings Automatic date and Time page require
reboot to take effect. Please consider configuring auto time updating related changes when setting up the
UCM630X for the first time to avoid service interrupt after installation and deployment in production.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 82
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 19: Time Auto Updating
Specify the URL or IP address of the NTP server for the UCM630X to
Remote NTP Server
synchronize the date and time. The default NTP server is pool.ntp.org.
If set to "Yes", the UCM630X can get provisioned for Time Zone from
Enable DHCP Option 2 DHCP Option 2 in the local server automatically. The default setting is
"Yes".
If set to "Yes", the UCM630X can get provisioned for NTP Server from
Enable DHCP Option 42 DHCP Option 42 in the local server automatically. This will override the
manually configured NTP Server. The default setting is "Yes".
Select the proper time zone option so the UCM630X can display correct
Time Zone
time accordingly.
To manually set the time on the UCM630X, go to Web GUISystem SettingsTime SettingsSet Date and
Time. The format is YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
Manually setup time will take effect immediately after saving and applying change in the Web GUI. If users would
like to reboot the UCM630X and keep the manually setup time setting, please make sure "Remote NTP Server",
"Enable DHCP Option 2" and "Enable DHCP Option 42" options under Web GUISettingsTime
SettingsAuto Time Updating page are unchecked or set to empty. Otherwise, time auto updating settings in
this page will take effect after reboot.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 83
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
NTP Server
The UCM630X can be used as an NTP server for the NTP clients to synchronize their time with. To configure
the UCM630X as the NTP server, set "Enable NTP server" to "Yes" under Web GUISystem SettingsTime
SettingsNTP Server. On the client side, point the NTP server address to the UCM630X IP address or host
name to use the UCM630X as the NTP server.
Office Time
On the UCM630X, the system administrator can define "office time", which can be used to configure time
condition for extension call forwarding schedule and inbound rule schedule. To configure office time, go to Web
GUISystem SettingsTime SettingsOffice Time. Click on "Add" to create an office time.
P a g e | 84
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select "Start Time", "End Time" and the day for the "Week" for the office time. The system administrator can also
define month and day of the month as advanced options. Once done, click on "Save" and then "Apply Change"
for the office time to take effect. The office time will be listed in the web page as the figure shows below.
Holiday
On the UCM630X, the system administrator can define "holiday", which can be used to configure time condition
for extension call forwarding schedule and inbound rule schedule. To configure holiday, go to Web GUISystem
SettingsTime SettingsHoliday. Click on "Add" to create holiday time.
P a g e | 85
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 49: Create New Holiday
Enter holiday "Name" and "Holiday Memo" for the new holiday. Then select "Month" and "Day". The system
administrator can also define days in one week as advanced options. Once done, click on "Save" and then
"Apply Change" for the holiday to take effect. The holiday will be listed in the web page as the figure shows
below.
P a g e | 86
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 50: SettingsTime SettingsHoliday
Note:
For more details on how to use office time and holiday, please refer to the link below:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/office_time_and_holiday_on_ucm6xxx.pdf
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Email Settings
Email settings
The Email application on the UCM630X can be used to send out alert event Emails, Voicemail (Voicemail-To-
Email) etc. The configuration parameters can be accessed via Web GUISystem SettingsEmail
SettingsEmail Settings.
Table 22: Email Settings
P a g e | 87
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SMTP Server Specify the SMTP server when using type "Client".
Enable SASL Authentication. When disabled, UCM will not try to use
the username and password for mail client login authentication. Most
Enable SASL of the mail server requires login authentication while some others
Authentication private mail servers allow anonymous login which requires disabling
this option to send Email as normal. For Exchange Server, please
disable this option.
Username is required when using type "Client". Normally it is the Email
Username
address.
Password to login for the above Username (Email address) is required
Password
when using type "Client".
Configure the POP/POP3 server address for the configured username
POP/POP3 Server Address
Example: pop.gmail.com
Configure the POP/POP3 server port for the configured username
POP/POP3 Server Port
Example: 995
Display Name Specify the display name in the FROM header in the Email.
Specify the sender's Email address.
Sender
For example: [email protected].
The following figure shows a sample Email setting on the UCM630X, assuming the Email is using 192.168.6.202
as the SMTP server.
P a g e | 88
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 51: UCM630X Email Settings
Once the configuration is finished, click on "Test". In the prompt, fill in a valid Email address to send a test Email
to verify the Email settings on the UCM630X.
Email Templates
The Email templates on the UCM630X can be used for email notification, the configuration parameters can be
accessed via Web GUISettingsEmail SettingsEmail Templates.
P a g e | 89
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 52: Email Template
Under UCM Web GUISystem SettingsEmail SettingsEmail Send Log, users could search, filter and
check whether the Email is sent out successfully or not. This page will also display the corresponding error
message if the Email is not sent out successfully.
P a g e | 90
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 53: Email Send Log
Field Description
Start Time Enter the start time for filter
End Time Enter the end time for filter
Receivers Enter the email recipient, while searching for multiple recipients, please
separate then with comma and no spaces.
Send Result Enter the status of the send result to filter with
Email logs will be shown on bottom of the “Email Send Log” page, as shown on the following figure.
P a g e | 91
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 54: Email Logs
Below are the codes returned when sending emails and their description:
Code Description
250 Mail sent successfully
501 Address format parsing error, 501 will be returned when there are
unacceptable characters in the recipient's email address in MTA mode.
Please check if the recipient's email address format is correct. The
"sender" configured on the client is your mail account.
535 The user name and password verification in the client mode is incorrect.
Please check whether the user name and password are configured
correctly.
550 Possible reasons:
1. The recipient's mailbox user name does not exist or is in a banned
state, please check whether the email recipient is the correct email
address.
2. The number of destination addresses sent by the sender exceeds the
maximum limit per day and is temporarily blacklisted. Please reduce the
sending frequency or try again the next day.
3. The sender's IP does not pass the SPF permission test of the sending
domain. Emails sent in MTA mode may return this error code even if
they are sent.
552 The sent email is too large or the email attachment type is prohibited
553 The sender and the email account are inconsistent, please configure the
sender as your email account correctly.
554 The email was identified as spam. Please reduce the sending frequency
or try again the next day
P a g e | 92
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
none Indicates that there is no return code.
If the sending result is "deferred", the general reason is that the mail
service area is configured incorrectly. Please check whether the server
configuration is correct.
If the sending result is "bounced", the general reason is that the
receiving email address domain name is wrong, please check whether
the email recipient is the correct email address. If it is in MTA mode,
please check whether the "domain" is configured to be in the same
domain name as the "recipient".
TR-069
Parameter Description
Enable TR-069 Toggle it on to enable TR-069. It is enabled by default
ACS URL URL for TR-069 Auto Configuration Servers (ACS), e.g., http://myacs.grandstream.com
TR-069 Username ACS username for TR-069, must be the same as in the ACS configuration.
TR-069 Password ACS password for TR-069, must be the same as in the ACS configuration.
Periodic Inform Enable Enables periodic inform. If set to 'Yes', device will send inform packets to the ACS.
Periodic Inform Periodic time when UCM630X will send inform packets to TR-069 ACS server.
Interval This option is specified in seconds.
ACS Connection
The username for the ACS to connect to UCM.
Request Username
ACS Connection
The password for the ACS to connect to UCM.
Request Password
Connection Request Port for incoming connection requests.
Port The default value is 7547.
CPE Cert File The Cert file for UCM to connect to the ACS via SSL.
CPE Cert Key The Cert key for UCM to connect to the ACS via SSL.
P a g e | 93
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PROVISIONING
Overview
Grandstream SIP Devices can be configured via Web interface as well as via configuration file through
TFTP/HTTP/HTTPS download. All Grandstream SIP devices support a proprietary binary format configuration
file and XML format configuration file. The UCM630X provides a Plug and Play mechanism to auto-provision the
Grandstream SIP devices in a zero-configuration manner by generating XML config file and having the phone to
download it within LAN area. This allows users to finish the installation with ease and start using the SIP devices
in a managed way.
To provision a phone, three steps are involved, i.e., discovery, configuration, and provisioning. This section
explains how Zero Config works on the UCM630X. The settings for this feature can be accessed via Web
GUIValue-added FeaturesZero Config.
Started from firmware version 1.0.7.10, the end point device configuration in zero config is divided into the
following three layers with priority from the lowest to the highest:
Global
This is the lowest layer. Users can configure the most basic options that could apply to all Grandstream SIP
devices during provisioning via Zero config.
Model
In this layer, users can define model-specific options for the configuration template.
Device
This is the highest layer. Users can configure device-specific options for the configuration for individual
device here.
Each layer also has its own structure in different levels. Please see figure below. The details for each layer are
explained in sections [Global Configuration], [Model configuration] and [Device Configuration].
P a g e | 94
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 55: Zero Config Configuration Architecture for End Point Device
The configuration options in model layer and device layer have all the option in global layers already, i.e., the
options in global layer is a subset of the options in model layer and device layer. If an option is set in all three
layers with different values, the highest layer value will override the value in lower layer. For example, if the user
selects English for Language setting in Global Policy and Spanish for Language setting in Default Model
Template, the language setting on the device to be provisioned will use Spanish as model layer has higher
priority than global layer. To sum up, configurations in higher layer will always override the configurations
for the same options/fields in the lower layer when presented at the same time.
After understanding the zero-config configuration architecture, users could configure the available options for
end point devices to be provisioned by the UCM630X by going through the three layers. This configuration
architecture allows users to set up and manage the Grandstream end point devices in the same LAN area in a
centralized way.
By default, the Zero Config feature is enabled on the UCM630X for auto provisioning. Three methods of
auto provisioning are used.
P a g e | 95
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 56: UCM630X Zero Config
SIP SUBSCRIBE
When the phone boots up, it sends out SUBSCRIBE to a multicast IP address in the LAN. The UCM630X
discovers it and then sends a NOTIFY with the XML config file URL in the message body. The phone will
then use the path to download the config file generated in the UCM630X and take the new configuration.
DHCP OPTION 66
Route mode needs to be set to use this feature. When the phone restarts (by default DHCP Option 66 is
turned on), it will send out a DHCP DISCOVER request. The UCM630X receives it and returns DHCP
OFFER with the config server path URL in Option 66, for example, https://192.168.2.1:8089/zccgi/. The
phone will then use the path to download the config file generated in the UCM630X.
mDNS
When the phone boots up, it sends out mDNS query to get the TFTP server address. The UCM630X will
respond with its own address. The phone will then send TFTP request to download the XML config file from
the UCM630X.
To start the auto provisioning process, under Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config
Settings, fill in the auto provision information.
P a g e | 96
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 57: Auto Provision Settings
Enable or disable the zero-config feature on the PBX. The default setting
Enable Zero Config
is enabled.
By default, this is disabled. If disabled, when SIP device boots up, the
UCM630X will not send the SIP device the URL to download the config file
and therefore the SIP device will not be automatically provisioned by the
UCM630X.
Enable Automatic
Configuration Assignment
Note:
When disabled, SIP devices can still be provisioned by manually sending
NOTIFY from the UCM630X which will include the XML config file URL for
the SIP device to download.
If enabled, when the device is discovered, the PBX will automatically
Auto Assign Extension assign an extension within the range defined in "Zero Config Extension
Segment" to the device. The default setting is disabled.
P a g e | 97
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Click on the link "Zero Config Extension Segment" to specify the extension
range to be assigned if "Automatically Assign Extension" is enabled. The
Zero Config Extension
default range is 5000-6299. Zero Config Extension Segment range can be
Segment
defined in Web GUIPBX SettingsGeneral SettingsGeneral
pageExtension Preference section: "Auto Provision Extensions".
If enabled, the extension list will be sent out to the device after receiving
the device's request. This feature is for the GXP series phones that support
Enable Pick Extension
selecting extension to be provisioned via phone's LCD. The default setting
is disabled.
Click on the link "Pick Extension Segment" to specify the extension list to
be sent to the device. The default range is 4000 to 4999. Pick Extension
Pick Extension Segment Segment range can be defined in Web GUI PBX Settings General
Settings General page Extension Preference section: "Pick
Extensions".
Specify the number of minutes to allow the phones being provisioned to
Pick Extension Period (hour)
pick extensions.
This feature allows the UCM to provision devices in different subnets other
than UCM network.
Enter subnets IP addresses to allow devices within these subnets to be
provisioned. The syntax is <IP>/<CIDR>.
Subnet Whitelist Examples:
10.0.0.1/8
192.168.6.0/24
Note: Only private IP ranges (10.0.0.0 | 172.16.0.0 | 192.168.0.0) are
supported.
Please make sure an extension is manually assigned to the phone or "Automatically Assign Extension" is
enabled during provisioning. After the configuration on the UCM630X Web GUI, click on "Save" and "Apply
Changes". Once the phone boots up and picks up the config file from the UCM630X, it will take the configuration
right away.
Discovery
Grandstream endpoints are automatically discovered after bootup. Users could also manually discover device
by specifying the IP address or scanning the entire LAN network. Three methods are supported to scan the
devices.
PING
ARP
P a g e | 98
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SIP Message (NOTIFY)
Click on "Auto Discover" under Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config, fill in the "Scan
Method" and "Scan IP". The IP address segment will be automatically filled in based on the network mask
detected on the UCM630X. If users need scan the entire network segment, enter 255 (for example,
192.168.40.255) instead of a specific IP address. Then click on "Save" to start discovering the devices within the
same network. To successfully discover the devices, "Zero Config" needs to be enabled on the UCM630X Web
GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigAuto Provisioning Settings.
The following figure shows a list of discovered phones. The MAC address, IP Address, Extension (if assigned),
Version, Vendor, Model, Connection Status, Create Config, Options (Edit /Delete /Update /Reboot /Access
Device WebGUI) are displayed in the list.
P a g e | 99
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Uploading Devices List
Besides the built-in discovery method on the UCM, users could prepare a list of devices on .CSV file and upload
it by clicking on the button ”Import”, after which a success message prompt should be displayed.
Users need to make sure that the CSV file respects the format as shown on the following figure and that the
entered information is correct (valid IP address, valid MAC address, device model and an existing account),
otherwise the UCM will reject the file and the operation will fail:
Sorting: Press or to sort per MAC Address, IP Address, Version, Vendor, Model or Create
Config columns from lower to higher or higher to lower, respectively.
P a g e | 100
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
From the main menu of zero config, users can perform the following operations:
Click on to add a new device to zero config database using its MAC address.
Click on to batch update a list of devices, the UCM on this case will send SIP NOTIFY
message to all selected devices in order to update them at once.
Click on to reboot selected devices (the selected devices, should have been provisioned with
extensions since the phone will authenticate the server which is trying to send it reboot command).
Click on to export CSV file containing list of devices. This file can be imported to another UCM
Click on to copy configuration from one device to another. This can be useful for easily replace
devices and note that this feature works only between devices of same model.
Global Configuration
Global Policy
Global configuration will apply to all the connected Grandstream SIP end point devices in the same LAN with the
UCM630X no matter what the Grandstream device model it is. It is divided into two levels:
Global Policy
Global Templates
Note: Global Templates configuration has higher priority to Global Policy configuration.
P a g e | 101
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Global Policy can be accessed in Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigGlobal Policy page. On
the top of the configuration table, users can select category in the “Options” dropdown list to quickly navigate to
the category. The categories are:
Select the checkbox on the left of the parameter you would like to configure to activate the dropdown list for this
parameter.
The following tables list the Global Policy configuration parameters for the SIP end device.
Language settings
Language Select the LCD display language on the SIP end device.
Date and Time
Date Format Configure the date display format on the SIP end device’s LCD.
P a g e | 102
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the time display in 12-hour or 24-hour format on the SIP end
Time Format
device’s LCD.
Enable NTP To enable the NTP service.
Configure the URL or IP address of the NTP server. The SIP end device
NTP Server
may obtain the date and time from the server.
NTP Update Interval Configure the NTP update interval.
Time Zone Configure the time zone used on the SIP end device.
Enable Daylight Saving Time Select either to enable or disable the DST.
Table 27: Global Policy Parameters – Phone Settings
P a g e | 103
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 28: Global Policy Parameters – Contact List
LDAP Phonebook
Select “Manual” or “PBX” as the LDAP configuration source.
If “Manual” is selected, the LDAP configuration below will be applied to
Source the SIP end device.
If “PBX” is selected, the LDAP configuration built-in from UCM630X
Web GUISystem SettingsLDAP Server will be applied.
Address Configure the IP address or DNS name of the LDAP server.
Port Configure the LDAP server port. The default value is 389.
This is the location in the directory where the search is requested to begin.
Example:
Base DN
dc=grandstream, dc=com
ou=Boston, dc=grandstream, dc=com
Configure the bind “Username” for querying LDAP servers. The field can
Username
be left blank if the LDAP server allows anonymous binds.
Configure the bind “Password” for querying LDAP servers. The field can be
Password
left blank if the LDAP server allows anonymous binds.
Configure the filter used for number lookups. Please refer to user manual
Number Filter
for more details.
Configure the filter used for name lookups. Please refer to user manual for
Name Filter
more details.
Select the protocol version for the phone to send the bind requests. The
Version
default value is 3.
Specify the “name” attributes of each record which are returned in the
LDAP search result.
Name Attribute Example:
gn
cn sn description
Specify the “number” attributes of each record which are returned in the
LDAP search result.
Number Attribute Example:
telephoneNumber
telephoneNumber Mobile
Configure the entry information to be shown on phone’s LCD. Up to 3 fields
can be displayed.
Display Name
Example:
%cn %sn %telephoneNumber
P a g e | 104
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Specify the maximum number of results to be returned by the LDAP server.
Max Hits
Valid range is 1 to 3000. The default value is 50.
Specify the interval (in seconds) for the server to process the request and
Search Timeout
client waits for server to return. Valid range is 0 to 180. Default value is 30.
Sort Results Specify whether the searching result is sorted or not. Default setting is No.
Configure to enable LDAP number searching when receiving calls. The
Incoming Calls
default setting is No.
Configure to enable LDAP number searching when making calls. The
Outgoing Calls
default setting is No.
Configures the display name when LDAP looks up the name for incoming
Lookup Display Name call or outgoing call.
It must be a subset of the LDAP Name Attributes.
XML Phonebook
Select the source of the phonebook XML server.
Disable
Disable phonebook XML downloading.
Manual
Once selected, users need specify downloading protocol HTTP,
HTTPS or TFTP and the server path to download the phonebook XML
Phonebook XML Server file. The server path could be IP address or URL, with up to 256
characters.
P a g e | 105
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
URL
If select to use URL to upgrade, complete the configuration for the
following four parameters: “Upgrade Via”, “Server Path”, “File Prefix”
and “File Postfix”.
P a g e | 106
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
By minute
Once selected, specify the interval X that the SIP end device will
request for new firmware every X minutes.
Firmware Upgrade Rule Specify how firmware upgrading and provisioning request to be sent.
Zero Config Select either to enable or disable zero config.
Web Access
Admin Password Configure the administrator password for admin level login.
End-User Password Configure the end-user password for the end user level login.
Web Access Mode Select HTTP or HTTPS as the web access protocol.
Configure the port for web access.
Web Server Port
The valid range is 1 to 65535.
RTSP Port Configure the RTSP Port.
Enable UPnP Discovery Select either to enable or disable Enable UPnP Discovery
Security
Enable Telnet/SSH access for the SIP end device. If the SIP end device
supports Telnet access, this option controls the Telnet access of the device;
Disable Telnet/SSH
if the SIP end device supports SSH access, this option controls the SSH
access of the device.
Syslog
Syslog Server Configure the URL/IP address for the syslog server.
Syslog Level Select the level of logging for syslog.
Send SIP Log Configure whether the SIP log will be included in the syslog message.
Basic Settings
Configure how the SIP end device shall obtain the IP address. DHCP or
PPPoE can be selected.
IP Address DHCP
Once selected, users can specify the Host Name (option 12) of the SIP
end device as DHCP client, and Vendor Class ID (option 60) used by
P a g e | 107
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
the client and server to exchange vendor class ID information.
PPPoE
Once selected, users need specify the Account ID, Password and
Service Name for PPPoE.
Specifies the name of the client. This field is optional but may be required
Host Name
by Internet Service Providers.
Vendor Class ID Used by clients and servers to exchange vendor class ID.
Account ID Enter the PPPoE account ID.
Password Enter the PPPoE Password.
Service Name Enter the PPPoE Service Name.
Advanced Setting
Define the Layer 3 QoS parameter. This value is used for IP Precedence,
Layer 3 QoS
Diff-Serv or MPLS. Valid range is 0-63.
Assign the priority value of the Layer 3 QoS for RTP packets.
Layer 3 QoS For RTP
Valid range is 0 -63.
Assign the priority value of the Layer 3 QoS for SIP packets.
Layer 3 QoS For SIP
Valid range is 0 -63.
Assign the VLAN Tag of the Layer 2 QoS packets.
Layer 2 QoS Tag
Valid range is 0 -4095.
Assign the priority value of the Layer 2 QoS packets.
Layer 2 QoS Priority Value
Valid range is 0-7.
Configure the IP address or Domain name of the STUN server. Only non-
STUN Server
symmetric NAT routers work with STUN.
Keep Alive Select either to enable or disable Keep Alive.
Specify how often the phone will send a blank UDP packet to the SIP server
Keep Alive Interval in order to keep the “ping hole” on the NAT router to open. Valid range is
10-160.
Register Expiration Specify the Register Expiration.
Local SIP Port Configure Local SIP Port.
Local RTP Port Configure Local RTP Port.
Auto On-Hook Timer(s) Configure Auto On-Hook Timer(s).
Ring Timeout Configure Ring Timeout.
SIP Transport Select either UDP, TCP or TLS/TCP as SIP transport protocol.
Direct IP Call Select either to disable or enable Direct IP Call support.
SIP Proxy Compatibility
Select either to disable or enable SIP Proxy Compatibility Mode.
Mode
P a g e | 108
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Unregister On Reboot Select either to disable or enable Unregister On Reboot.
Whitelist
Whitelist Select either to enable or disable Whitelist
SIP Phone Number Whitelist Configure the SIP Phone Number Whitelist.
Wallpaper
Check this option if the SIP end device shall use 1024 x 600 resolution for
the LCD screen wallpaper.
Source
Screen Resolution 1024 x Configure the location where wallpapers are stored.
600 File
If “URL” is selected as source, specify the URL of the wallpaper file. If
“Local UCM Server” is selected as source, click to upload wallpaper
file to the UCM630X.
Check this option if the SIP end device shall use 800 x 400 resolution for
the LCD screen wallpaper.
Source
Screen Resolution 800 x 400 Configure the location where wallpapers are stored.
File
If “URL” is selected as source, specify the URL of the wallpaper file. If
“Local UCM Server” is selected as source, click to upload wallpaper
file to the UCM630X.
Check this option if the SIP end device shall use 480 x 272 resolution for
the LCD screen wallpaper.
Source
Screen Resolution 480 x 272 Configure the location where wallpapers are stored.
File
If “URL” is selected as source, specify the URL of the wallpaper file. If
“Local UCM Server” is selected as source, click to upload wallpaper
file to the UCM630X.
Check this option if the SIP end device supports 320 x 240 resolution for
the LCD screen wallpaper.
Screen Resolution 320 x 240 Source
Configure the location where wallpapers are stored.
File
P a g e | 109
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If “URL” is selected as source, specify the URL of the wallpaper file. If
“Local UCM Server” is selected as source, click to upload wallpaper
file to the UCM630X.
Email Settings
Check this option to configure the email settings that will be sent to the
provisioned phones:
Server
IP address of the SMTP server
Port
Email address
Sender Username
SMTP Settings Username of the sender
Enable SSL
Server
FTP server address
P a g e | 110
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Port
FTP port to be used
Username
FTP username
Path
FTP Directory path
Global Templates
When creating global template, users can select the categories and the parameters under each category to be
used in the template. The global policy and the selected global template will both take effect when generating
the config file. However, the selected global template has higher priority to the global policy when it comes to the
same setting option/field. If the same option/field has different value configured in the global policy and the
selected global template, the value for this option/field in the selected global template will override the value in
global policy.
Click on "Add" to add a global template. Users will see the following configurations.
The window for editing global template is shown in the following figure. In the “Options” field, after entering the
option name key word, the options containing the key word will be listed. Users could then select the options to
be modified under the global template.
P a g e | 111
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 63: Edit Global Template
The added options will show in the list. Users can then enter or select value for each option to be used in the
global template. On the left side of each added option, users can click on to delete this option from the
template. On the right side of each option, users can click on to reset the option value to the default value.
Templates page. Users can click on to delete the global template or delete multiple selected templates
at once.
Click on “Toggle Selected Template(s)” to toggle the status between enabled/disabled for the selected
templates.
P a g e | 112
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Model configuration
Model templates
Model layer configuration allows users to apply model-specific configurations to different devices. Users could
create/edit/delete a model template by accessing Web GUI, page Value-added FeaturesZero
ConfigModel Templates. If multiple model templates are created and enabled, when the user configures the
device in Edit Device dialogAdvanced Settings, the user can select to use one of the model templates for the
device. Please refer to section [Manage Devices] for more details on using the model template.
For each created model template, users can assign it as default model template. If assigned as default model
template, the values in this model template will be applied to all the devices of this model. There is always only
one default model template that can be assigned at one time on the UCM630X.
The selected model template and the default model template will both take effect when generating the config file
for the device. However, the model template has higher priority to default model template when it comes to the
same setting option/field. If the same option/field has different value configured in the default model template
and the selected model template, the value for this option/field in the selected model template will override the
value in default model template.
Select to assign this model template as the default model template. The value
Default Model Template of the option in default model template will be overridden if other selected
model template has a different value for the same option.
The editing window for model template is shown in the following figure. In the “Options” field, enter the option
name key word, the option that contains the key word will be listed. User could then select the option to be
modified under the model template.
P a g e | 113
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Once added, the option will be shown in the list below. On the left side of each option, users can click on
to remove this option from the model template. On the right side of each option, users can click on to
reset the option to the default value.
User could also click on “Add New Field” to add a P value number and the value to the configuration. The
following figure shows setting P value “P1362” to “en”, which means the display language on the LCD is set to
English. For P value information of different models, please refer to configuration template here
http://www.grandstream.com/support/tools.
Click on Save when done. The model template will be displayed on Web GUIValue-added
FeaturesZero ConfigModel Templates page.
Click on to delete the model template or click on “Delete Selected Templates” to delete multiple selected
templates at once.
Click on “Toggle Selected Template(s)” to toggle the status between enabled/disabled for the selected model
templates.
P a g e | 114
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Model Update
UCM630X zero config feature supports provisioning all models of Grandstream SIP end devices including OEM
device models.
OEM Models
Users can associate OEM device models with their original Grandstream-branded models, allowing these OEM
devices to be provisioned appropriately.
Click on button.
In the Source Model field, select the Grandstream device that the OEM model is based on from the dropdown
list.
For the Destination Model and Destination Vendor field, enter the custom OEM model name and vendor
name.
The newly added OEM model should now be selectable as an option in Model fields.
Templates for most of the Grandstream models are built in with the UCM630X already. Templates for GS Wave
and Grandstream surveillance products require users to download and install under Web GUIValue-added
FeaturesZero ConfigModel Update first before they are available in the UCM630X for selection. After
downloading and installing the model template to the UCM630X, it will show in the dropdown list for “Model”
selection when editing the model template.
P a g e | 115
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Click on to download the template.
Click on to upgrade the model template. Users will see this icon available if the device model has
In case the UCM630X is placed in the private network and Internet access is restricted, users will not be able to
get packages by downloading and installing from the remote server. Model template package can be manually
uploaded from local device through Web GUI. Please contact Grandstream customer support if the model
package is needed for manual uploading.
Device Configuration
On Web GUI, page Value-added FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config, users could create new device, delete
existing device(s), make special configuration for a single device, or send NOTIFY to existing device(s).
P a g e | 116
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Create New Device
Besides configuring the device after the device is discovered, users could also directly create a new device and
configure basic settings before the device is discovered by the UCM630X. Once the device is plugged in, it can
then be discovered and provisioned. This gives the system administrator adequate time to set up each device
beforehand.
Click on "Add" and the following dialog will show. Follow the steps below to create the configurations for the new
device.
1. Firstly, select a model for the device to be created and enter its MAC address, IP address and firmware
version (optional) in the corresponding field.
2. Basic settings will show a list of settings based on the model selected in step 1. Users could assign
extensions to accounts, assign functions to Line Keys and Multiple-Purposed Keys if supported on the
selected model.
Manage Devices
The device manually created or discovered from Auto Discover will be listed in the Web GUIValue-added
FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config page. Users can see the devices with their MAC address, IP address,
vendor, model etc.
P a g e | 117
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 69: Manage Devices
A preview of the “Advanced” settings is shown in the above figure. There are five levels configurations as
described in (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) below, with priority from the lowest to the highest. The configurations in all levels
will take effect for the device. If there are same options existing in different level configurations with different
value configured, the higher-level configuration will override the lower-level configuration.
P a g e | 118
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
(1) Global Policy
This is the lowest level configuration. The global policy configured in Web GUIValue-added
FeaturesZero ConfigGlobal Policy will be applied here. Clicking on “Modify Global Policy” to
redirect to page Value-added FeaturesZero ConfigGlobal Policy.
Select a global template to be used for the device and click on to add. Multiple global templates
can be selected, and users can arrange the priority by adjusting orders via and . All the selected
global templates will take effect. If the same option exists on multiple selected global templates, the
value in the template with higher priority will override the one in the template with lower priority. Click on
Select a model template to be used for the device and click on to add. Multiple model templates
can be selected, and users can arrange the priority by adjusting orders via and . All the selected
model templates will take effect. If the same option exists on multiple selected model templates, the
value in the template with higher priority will override the one in the template with lower priority. Click on
P a g e | 119
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 71: Edit Customize Device Settings
Scroll down in the dialog to view and edit the device-specific options. If the users would like to add more options
which are not in the pre-defined list, click on “Add New Field” to add a P value number and the value to the
configuration. The above figure shows setting P value “P1362” to “en”, which means the display language on the
LCD is set to English. The warning information on right tells that the option matching the P value number exists
and clicking on it will lead to the matching option. For P value information of different models, please refer to
configuration template here http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/config-template.zip.
Select multiple devices that need to be modified and then click on ”Update Config” to batch modify devices.
If selected devices are of the same model, the configuration dialog is like the following figure. Configurations in
five levels are all available for users to modify.
P a g e | 120
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 72: Modify Selected Devices - Same Model
If selected devices are of different models, the configuration dialog is like the following figure. Click on
to view more devices of other models. Users are only allowed to make modifications in Global Templates and
Global Policy level.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
Performing batch operation will override all the existing device configuration on the page.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 121
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
After the above configurations, save the changes and go back to Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero
ConfigZero Config page. Users could then click on to send NOTIFY to the SIP end point device and
trigger the provisioning process. The device will start downloading the generated configuration file from the URL
contained in the NOTIFY message.
In this web page, users can also click on “Reset All Extensions” to reset the extensions of all the devices.
Sample Application
Assuming in a small business office where there are 8 GXP2140 phones used by customer support and 1
GXV3275 phone used by customer support supervisor. 3 of the 8 customer support members speak Spanish
and the rest speak English. We could deploy the following configurations to provisioning the office phones for
the customer support team.
P a g e | 122
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 75: Zero Config Sample - Global Policy
5. After 9 devices are powered up and connected to the LAN network, use “Auto Discover” function or “Create
New Device” function to add the devices to the device list on Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero
ConfigZero Config.
P a g e | 123
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
6. On Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config page, users could identify the devices
by their MAC addresses or IP addresses displayed on the list. Click on to edit the device settings.
7. For each of the 5 phones used by English speaking customer support, in “Basic settings” select an available
extension for account 1 and click on “Save”. Then click on “Advanced settings” tab to bring up the following
dialog. Users will see the English support template is applied since this is the default model template. A
preview of the device settings will be listed on the right side.
8. For the 3 phones used by Spanish support, in “Basic settings” select an available extension for account 1
and click on “Save”. Then click on “Advanced settings” tab to bring up the following dialog.
P a g e | 124
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select “Spanish Support Template” in “Model Template”. The preview of the device settings is displayed on the
right side and we can see the language is set to “Español” since Model Template has the higher priority for the
option “Language”, which overrides the value configured in default model template.
9. For the GXV3275 used by the customer support supervisor, select an available extension for account 1 on
“Basic settings” and click on “Save”. Users can see the preview of the device configuration in “Advanced
settings”. There is no model template configured for GXV3275.
11. On the Web GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config page, click on to send NOTIFY
to trigger the device to download config file from UCM630X.
Now all the 9 phones in the network will be provisioned with a unique extension registered on the UCM630X. 3
of the phones will be provisioned to display Spanish on LCD and the other 5 will be provisioned to display English
on LCD. The GXV3275 used by the supervisor will be provisioned to use the default language on LCD display
since it is not specified in the global policy.
P a g e | 125
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
EXTENSIONS
To manually create new SIP user, go to Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions. Click on "Add" and a new
window will show for users to fill in the extension information.
Basic Settings
Media
Features
Specific Time
Follow me
Select first which type of extension: SIP Extension, IAX Extension or FXS Extension. The configuration
parameters are as follows.
P a g e | 126
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 35: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersBasic Settings
General
Extension The extension number associated with the user.
Configure the CallerID Number that would be applied for outbound calls from this
user.
CallerID Number Note:
The ability to manipulate your outbound Caller ID may be limited by your VoIP
provider.
Assign permission level to the user. The available permissions are "Internal", "Local",
"National" and "International" from the lowest level to the highest level. The default
setting is "Internal".
Privilege
Note:
Users need to have the same level as or higher level than an outbound rule's privilege
to make outbound calls using this rule.
Configure the password for the user. A random secure password will be automatically
SIP/IAX Password
generated. It is recommended to use this password for security purpose.
Configure the authentication ID for the user. If not configured, the extension number
Auth ID
will be used for authentication.
Configure Voicemail. There are three valid options, and the default option is "Enable
Local Voicemail".
Disable Voicemail: Disable Voicemail.
Voicemail Enable Local Voicemail: Enable voicemail for the user.
Enable Remote Voicemail: Forward the notify message from remote
voicemail system for the user, and the local voicemail will be disabled. Note:
Remote voicemail feature is used only for Infomatec (Brazil).
Configure voicemail password (digits only) for the user to access the voicemail box.
Voicemail
A random numeric password is automatically generated. It is recommended to use
Password
the random generated password for security purpose.
Skip Voicemail
When user dials voicemail code, the password verification IVR is skipped. If enabled,
Password
this would allow one-button voicemail access. By default, this option is disabled.
Verification
Send Voicemail Configures whether or not to send emails to the extension's email address to notify of
Email Notification new voicemail.
Configures whether or not to attach voicemail audio file to the voicemail notification
Attach Voicemail emails.
to Email Note: When set to “Default”, the global settings in Call Features Voicemail
Voicemail Email Settings will be used.
P a g e | 127
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Whether to keep the local voicemail recording after sending them. If set to “Default”,
Keep Voicemail the global settings will be used.
after Emailing Note: When set to “Default”, the global settings in Call Features Voicemail
Voicemail Email Settings will be used.
If enabled, empty SDP packet will be sent to the SIP server periodically to keep the
Enable Keep-alive
NAT port open. The default setting is "No".
Keep-alive Configure the Keep-alive interval (in seconds) to check if the host is up. The default
Frequency setting is 60 seconds.
If enabled, (1) Call Forward, Call Waiting and Do Not Disturb settings will not work,
Enable SCA (2) Concurrent Registrations can be set only to 1, and (3) Private numbers can be
added in Call Features->SCA page.
Emergency CID
CallerID name that will be used for emergency calls and callbacks.
Name
If selected, this extension will be disabled on the UCM630X.
Disable This
Note:
Extension
The disabled extension still exists on the PBX but cannot be used on the end device.
User Settings
Configure the first name of the user.
First Name
The first name can contain characters, letters, digits and _.
Configure the last name of the user.
Last Name
The last name can contain characters, letters, digits and _.
Email Address Fill in the Email address for the user. Voicemail will be sent to this Email address.
Configure the password for user portal access. A random numeric password is
User Password automatically generated. It is recommended to use the randomly generated password
for security purpose.
Select the voice prompt language to be used for this extension. The default setting is
"Default" which is the selected voice prompt language under Web GUIPBX
SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings. The dropdown list shows all the
Language
current available voice prompt languages on the UCM630X. To add more languages
in the list, please download voice prompt package by selecting "Check Prompt List"
under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings.
Concurrent The maximum endpoints which can be registered into this extension. For security
Registrations concerns, the default value is 1.
Configure the phone number for the extension, user can type the related star code for
Mobile Phone phone number followed by the extension number to directly call this number.
Number Example: user can type *881000 to call the mobile number associated with extension
1000.
P a g e | 128
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 36: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersMedia
SIP Settings
Use NAT when the UCM630X is on a public IP communicating with devices hidden
behind NAT (e.g., broadband router). If there is one-way audio issue, usually it is
NAT
related to NAT configuration or Firewall's support of SIP and RTP ports. The default
setting is enabled.
By default, the UCM630X will route the media steams from SIP endpoints through
Enable Direct itself. If enabled, the PBX will attempt to negotiate with the endpoints to route the
Media media stream directly. It is not always possible for the UCM630X to negotiate
endpoint-to-endpoint media routing. The default setting is "No".
Select DTMF mode for the user to send DTMF. The default setting is "RFC4733". If
"Info" is selected, SIP INFO message will be used. If "Inband" is selected, a-law or u-
DTMF Mode
law are required. When "Auto" is selected, RFC4733 will be used if offered, otherwise
"Inband" will be used.
If the phone has an assigned PSTN telephone number, this field should be set to
“User=Phone”. “User=Phone” parameter will be attached to the Request-Line and
TEL URI
“TO” header in the SIP request to indicate the E.164 number. If set to “Enable”, “Tel”
will be used instead of “SIP” in the SIP request.
When present in an INVITE request, the alert-Info header field specifies and
Alert-Info
alternative ring tone to the UAS.
Enable T.38
Enable or disable T.38 UDPTL support.
UDPTL
SRTP Enable SRTP for the call. The default setting is disabled.
Select jitter buffer method.
Disable: Jitter buffer will not be used.
Fixed: Jitter buffer with a fixed size (equal to the value of "jitter buffer size")
Jitter Buffer
Adaptive: Jitter buffer with an adaptive size (no more than the value of "max
jitter buffer").
NetEQ: Dynamic jitter buffer via NetEQ.
Configure to enable Packet Loss Retransmission.
Packet Loss NACK
Retransmission NACK+RTX(SSRC-GROUP)
OFF
Video FEC Check to enable Forward Error Correction (FEC) for Video.
Audio FEC Check to enable Forward Error Correction (FEC) for Audio.
FECC Configure to enable Remote Camera Management.
P a g e | 129
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Access Control List manages the IP addresses that can register to this extension.
Allow All: Any IP address can register to this extension.
ACL Policy Local Network: Only IP addresses in the configured network segments can
register to this extension. Press “Add Local Network Address” to add more IP
segments.
Select audio and video codec for the extension. The available codecs are: PCMU,
Codec Preference PCMA, GSM, AAL2-G.726-32, G,726, G.722, G.729, G.723, iLBC, ADPCM, H.264,
H.265, H.263, H.263p, RTX and VP8.
Call Transfer
Select which presence status to set for the extension and configure call forward
Presence Status conditions for each status. Six possible options are possible: “Available”, “Away”,
“Chat”, “Custom”, “DND” and “Unavailable”. More details at [PRESENCE].
Enable and configure the Call Forward Unconditional target number. Available options
for target number are:
“None”: Call forward deactivated.
“Extension”: Select an extension from dropdown list as CFU target.
“Custom Number”: Enter a customer number as target. For example: *97.
Call Forward
“Voicemail”: Select an extension from dropdown list. Incoming calls will be
Unconditional
forwarded to voicemail of selected extension.
“Ring Group”: Select a ring group from dropdown list as CFU target.
“Queues”: Select a queue from dropdown list as CFU target.
“Voicemail Group”: Select a voicemail group from dropdown list as CFU target.
The default setting is “None”.
Select time condition for Call Forward Unconditional. CFU takes effect only during the
selected time condition. The available time conditions are “Office Time”, “Out of Office
Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday” and “Specific”.
Note:
CFU Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured under Specific Time section. Scroll down the add
Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
P a g e | 130
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the Call Forward No Answer target number. Available options for target
number are:
“None”: Call forward deactivated.
“Extension”: Select an extension from dropdown list as CFN target.
“Custom Number”: Enter a customer number as target. For example: *97.
Call Forward No
“Voicemail”: Select an extension from dropdown list. Incoming calls will be
Answer
forwarded to voicemail of selected extension.
“Ring Group”: Select a ring group from dropdown list as CFN target.
“Queues”: Select a queue from dropdown list as CFN target.
“Voicemail Group”: Select a voicemail group from dropdown list as CFN target.
The default setting is “None”.
Select time condition for Call Forward No Answer. The available time conditions are
“Office Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or
Holiday” and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFN Time
“Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition
period.
Specific time can be configured under Specific Time section. Scroll down the add
Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Configure the Call Forward Busy target number. Available options for target number
are:
“None”: Call forward deactivated.
“Extension”: Select an extension from dropdown list as CFB target.
“Custom Number”: Enter a customer number as target. For example: *97.
Call Forward Busy “Voicemail”: Select an extension from dropdown list. Incoming calls will be
forwarded to voicemail of selected extension.
“Ring Group”: Select a ring group from dropdown list as CFB target.
“Queues”: Select a queue from dropdown list as CFB target.
“Voicemail Group”: Select a voicemail group from dropdown list as CFB target.
The default setting is “None”.
P a g e | 131
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select time condition for Call Forward Busy. The available time conditions are “Office
Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFB Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured under Specific Time section. Scroll down the add
Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
If Do Not Disturb is enabled, all incoming calls will be dropped. All call forward settings
Do Not Disturb
will be ignored.
Select time condition for Do Not Disturb. The available time conditions are “Office
Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
and “Specific”.
Notes:
DND Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured under Specific Time section. Scroll down the add
Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
If DND is enabled, calls from the whitelisted numbers will not be rejected. Multiple
numbers are supported and must be separated by new lines. Pattern matching is
supported.
DND Whitelist
Z match any digit from 1-9.
N match any digit from 2-9.
X match any digit from 0-9.
Calls from users in the forward whitelist will not be forwarded. Pattern matching is
supported.
FWD Whitelist Z match any digit from 1-9,
N match any digit from 2-9,
X match any digit from 0-9.
P a g e | 132
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CC Settings
If enabled, UCM630X will automatically alert this extension when a called party is
Enable CC available, given that a previous call to that party failed for some reason. By default, it
is disabled.
Configure the maximum number of CCSS agents which may be allocated for this
channel. In other words, this number serves as the maximum number of CC requests
CC Max Agents
this channel can make.
The minimum value is 1.
Configure the maximum number of monitor structures which may be created for this
device. In other words, this number tells how many callers may request CC services
CC Max Monitors
for a specific device at one time.
The minimum value is 1.
Ring Simultaneously
Enable this option to have an external number ring simultaneously along with the
Ring
extension. If a register trunk is used for outbound, the register number will be used to
Simultaneously
be displayed for the external number as caller ID number.
Set the external number to be rang simultaneously. ‘-’ is the connection character
External Number which will be ignored.
This field accepts only letters, numbers, and special characters + = * #.
Use callee DOD on Use the DOD number when calls are being diverted/forwarded to external
FWD or RS destinations or when ring simultaneous is configured.
Allowed to Add members from “Available Extensions” to “Selected Extensions” so that the
call-barging selected extensions can spy on the used extension using feature code.
P a g e | 133
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Seamless transfer privilege control
Any extensions on the UCM can perform seamless transfer. When using Pickup Incall
Allowed to
feature, only extensions available on the “Selected Extensions” list can perform
seamless transfer
seamless transfer to the edited extension.
Select the
extensions that
Selected extensions can set a PMS wakeup service for this extension via feature
can set wakeup
code.
service for other
extensions
Other Settings
Configure the number of seconds to ring the user before the call is forwarded to
voicemail (voicemail is enabled) or hang up (voicemail is disabled). If not specified,
the default ring timeout is 60 seconds on the UCM630X. The valid range is between
Ring Timeout
5 seconds and 600 seconds.
Note: If the end point also has a ring timeout configured, the actual ring timeout used
is the shortest time set by either device.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this extension. The default setting is
Auto Record
disabled. The recordings can be accessed under Web GUICDRRecording Files.
If set to “yes”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound calls.
If set to “By Time”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound
Skip Trunk Auth calls during the selected time condition.
If set to “No”, users will be asked to enter the password when making outbound
calls.
Time Condition for If ‘Skip Trunk Auth’ is set to ‘By Time’, select a time condition during which users can
Skip Trunk Auth skip entering password when making outbound calls.
Dial Trunk
Configure personal password when making outbound calls via trunk.
Password
Check to enable Hot-Desking Mode on the extension. Hot-Desking allows to use the
same endpoint device and login using extension/password combination. This feature
Support Hot-
is used in scenarios where different users need to use the same endpoint device
Desking Mode
during different time of a day for instance. If enabled, SIP Password will accept only
alphabet characters and digits. Auth ID will be changed to the same as Extension.
P a g e | 134
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If enabled, the extension will be added to LDAP Phonebook PBX list.
Enable LDAP
Default is enabled.
Use MOH as IVR If enabled, when the call to the extension is made through the IVR, the caller will hear
ringback tone MOH as ringback tone instead of the regular ringback tone.
Specify which Music On Hold class to suggest to the bridged channel when putting
Music On Hold
them on hold.
If enabled, the system will create a room whose room number, by default, will equal
Bind PMS Room the extension number in PMS module. Note: If this room already exists, the
configuration of the existing room will be overwritten.
Call Duration Limit Check to enable and set the call limit the duration.
Maximum Call The maximum call duration (in seconds). The default value 0 means no limit. Max
Duration (s) value is 86400 seconds
The Maximum
The maximum number of simultaneous calls that the extension can have.
Number of Call
0 indicates no limit.
Lines
Enable Auto- If enabled, the extension will support auto-answer when indicated by Call-info/Alert-
Answer Support info headers.
Email Missed Calls Send a log of missed calls to the extension's email address.
If Email Missed Calls enabled, users can select the type of missed calls to be sent
via email, the available types are:
Default: All missed calls will be sent in email notifications.
Missed Call Type Missed Internal Call: Only missed local extension-to-extension calls will be
sent in email notifications.
Missed External Call: Only missed calls from trunks will be sent in email
notifications.
Allows calls to the extension even when it is already in a call. This only works if the
caller is directly dialing the extension. If disabled, the CC service will take effect only
Call Waiting
for unanswered and timeout calls.
P a g e | 135
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 38: SIP Extension Configuration ParametersSpecific Time
Specific Time
Time Condition Click to add Time Condition to configure specific time for this extension.
Follow Me
If the outbound calls need to check the password, we should enable this option or
Skip Trunk Auth enable the option "Skip Trunk Auth" of the Extension. Otherwise this Follow Me cannot
call out.
Music On Hold
Configure the Music On Hold class that the caller would hear while tracking the user.
Class
Enable
Configure to enable destination.
Destination
Default
The call will be routed to this destination if no one in the Follow Me answers the call.
Destination
Confirm When
If enabled, call will need to be confirmed after answering.
Answering
Use Callee DOD Use the callee DOD number as CID if configured Follow Me numbers are external
for Follow Me numbers.
Dialing Order This is the order in which the Follow Me destinations will be dialed to reach the user.
The UCM630X supports Inter-Asterisk eXchange (IAX) protocol. IAX is used for transporting VoIP telephony
sessions between servers and terminal devices. IAX is like SIP but also has its own characteristic. For more
information, please refer to RFC 5465.
To manually create new IAX user, go to Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions. Click on "Add" and a new
dialog window will show for users which need to make sure first to select the extension type to be IAX Extension
before proceeding to fill in the extension information. The configuration parameters are as follows.
P a g e | 136
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 40: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersBasic Settings
General
Configure the CallerID Number that would be applied for outbound calls from this
CallerID Number user. Note: The ability to manipulate your outbound Caller ID may be limited by your
VoIP provider.
Assign permission level to the user. The available permissions are "Internal", "Local",
"National" and "International" from the lowest level to the highest level. The default
Privilege setting is "Internal".
Note: Users need to have the same level as or higher level than an outbound rule's
privilege to make outbound calls using this rule.
Configure the password for the user. A random secure password will be automatically
SIP/IAX Password
generated. It is recommended to use this password for security purpose.
Configure Voicemail.
There are three valid options and the default option is "Enable Local Voicemail".
Voicemail
Disable Voicemail: Disable Voicemail.
Enable Local Voicemail: Enable voicemail for the user.
Configure voicemail password (digits only) for the user to access the voicemail box.
Voicemail
A random numeric password is automatically generated. It is recommended to use
Password
the random generated password for security purpose.
Skip Voicemail
When user dials voicemail code, the password verification IVR is skipped. If enabled,
Password
this would allow one-button voicemail access. By default, this option is disabled.
Verification
Send Voicemail Configures whether or not to send emails to the extension’s email address to notify of
Email Notification new voicemail.
Attach Voicemail Configures whether or not to attach voicemail audio file to the voicemail notification
to Email emails.
Keep Voicemail
Only applies if extension-level or global Send Voicemail to Email is enabled.
after Emailing
P a g e | 137
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
User Settings
Configure the first name of the user. The first name can contain characters, letters,
First Name
digits and _.
Configure the last name of the user. The last name can contain characters, letters,
Last Name
digits and _.
Email Address Fill in the Email address for the user. Voicemail will be sent to this Email address.
Configure the password for user portal access. A random numeric password is
User Password automatically generated. It is recommended to use the randomly generated password
for security purpose.
Select the voice prompt language to be used for this extension. The default setting is
"Default" which is the selected voice prompt language under Web GUIPBX
SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings. The dropdown list shows all the
Language
current available voice prompt languages on the UCM630X. To add more languages
in the list, please download voice prompt package by selecting "Check Prompt List"
under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings.
Mobile Phone
Configure the Mobile number of the user.
Number
IAX Settings
Max Number of
Configure the maximum number of calls allowed for each remote IP address.
Calls
Configure to enable/disable requiring call token. If set to "Auto", it might lock out users
Require Call
who depend on backward compatibility when peer authentication credentials are
Token
shared between physical endpoints. The default setting is "Yes".
SRTP Enable SRTP for the call. The default setting is disabled.
Access Control List manages the IP addresses that can register to this extension.
Allow All: Any IP address can register to this extension.
ACL Policy
Local Network: Only IP addresses in the configured network segments can
register to this extension.
Select audio and video codec for the extension. The available codecs are: PCMU,
Codec Preference PCMA, GSM, AAL2-G.726-32, G,726, G.722, G.729, G.723, iLBC, ADPCM, H.264,
H.265, H.263, H.263p, RTX and VP8.
P a g e | 138
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 42: IAX Extension Configuration ParametersFeatures
Call Transfer
Call Forward Configure the Call Forward Unconditional target number. If not configured, the Call
Unconditional Forward Unconditional feature is deactivated. The default setting is deactivated.
Select time condition for Call Forward Unconditional. CFU takes effect only during the
selected time condition. The available time conditions are “Office Time”, “Out of Office
Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday” and “Specific”.
Note:
CFU Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Call Forward No Configure the Call Forward No Answer target number. If not configured, the Call
Answer Forward No Answer feature is deactivated. The default setting is deactivated.
Select time condition for Call Forward No Answer. The available time conditions are
“Office Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or
Holiday” and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFN Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Configure the Call Forward Busy target number. If not configured, the Call Forward
Call Forward Busy
Busy feature is deactivated. The default setting is deactivated.
Select time condition for Call Forward Busy. The available time conditions are “Office
Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
CFB Time and “Specific”.
Condition Notes:
“Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
period.
P a g e | 139
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
If Do Not Disturb is enabled, all incoming calls will be dropped. All call forward settings
Do Not Disturb
will be ignored.
DND Time The time condition of DND. The DND will take effect while the time condition is
Condition satisfied.
If DND is enabled, calls from the whitelisted numbers will not be rejected. Multiple
numbers are supported and must be separated by new lines. Pattern matching is
supported.
DND Whitelist
Z match any digit from 1-9.
N match any digit from 2-9.
X match any digit from 0-9.
Enable this option to have an external number ring simultaneously along with the
Ring
extension. If a register trunk is used for outbound, the register number will be used to
Simultaneously
be displayed for the external number as caller ID number.
Set the external number to be rang simultaneously. ‘-’ is the connection character
External Number
which will be ignored.
Use callee DOD on Use the callee's DOD number as CallerID on Outgoing Forwarding or Ring
FWD or RS Simultaneously calls.
Allow call-barging Members of the list can spy on this extension via feature codes.
P a g e | 140
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Seamless transfer privilege control
Allowed to
Members of the list can seamlessly transfer via feature code.
seamless transfer
Other Settings
Configure the number of seconds to ring the user before the call is forwarded to
voicemail (voicemail is enabled) or hang up (voicemail is disabled). If not specified,
the default ring timeout is 60 seconds on the UCM630X, which can be configured in
the global ring timeout setting under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice
Ring Timeout
PromptCustom Prompt: General Preference. The valid range is between 5 seconds
and 600 seconds.
Note: If the end point also has a ring timeout configured, the actual ring timeout used
is the shortest time set by either device.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this extension. The default setting is
Auto Record disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web GUICDRRecording
Files.
If set to “Yes”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound calls.
If set to “By Time”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound
Skip Trunk Auth calls during the selected time condition.
If set to “No”, users will be asked to enter the password when making outbound
calls.
Time Condition for If “Skip Trunk Auth” is set to “By Time”, select a time condition during which users can
Skip Trunk Auth skip entering password when making outbound calls.
Dial Trunk
Configure personal password when making outbound calls via trunk.
Password
Enable LDAP If enabled, the extension will be added to LDAP Phonebook PBX lists.
Configure the Music On Hold class to suggest to the bridged channel when putting
Music On Hold
them on hold.
Use MOH as IVR If enabled, when the call to the extension is made through the IVR, the caller will hear
ringback tone MOH as ringback tone instead of the regular ringback tone.
Call Duration Limit Check to enable and set the call limit the duration.
Maximum Call The maximum call duration (in seconds). The default value 0 means no limit. Max
Duration (s) value is 86400 seconds
Email Missed Send a log of missed calls to the extension's email address.
P a g e | 141
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Calls
If Email Missed Calls enabled, users can select the type of missed calls to be sent
via email, the available types are:
Default: All missed calls will be sent in email notifications.
Missed Call Type Missed Internal Call: Only missed local extension-to-extension calls will be
sent in email notifications.
Missed External Call: Only missed calls from trunks will be sent in email
notifications.
Specific Time
Time Condition Click to add Time Condition to configure specific time for this extension.
Follow Me
Enable Configure to enable or disable Follow Me for this user.
If the outbound calls need to check the password, we should enable this option or
Skip Trunk Auth enable the option "Skip Trunk Auth" of the Extension. Otherwise this Follow Me cannot
call out.
Music On Hold
Configure the Music On Hold class that the caller would hear while tracking the user.
Class
Enable
Configure to enable destination.
Destination
Default
The call will be routed to this destination if no one in the Follow Me answers the call.
Destination
Confirm When
If enabled, call will need to be confirmed after answering.
Answering
Use Callee DOD Use the callee DOD number as CID if configured Follow Me numbers are external
for Follow Me numbers.
Add a new Follow Me number which could be a "Local Extension" or an "External
New Follow Me
Number". The selected dial plan should have permissions to dial the defined external
Number
number.
Dialing Order This is the order in which the Follow Me destinations will be dialed to reach the user.
P a g e | 142
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Create New FXS Extension
The UCM630X supports Foreign eXchange Subscriber (FXS) interface. FXS is used when user needs to connect
analog phone lines or FAX machines to the UCM630X.
To manually create new FXS user, go to Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions. Click on "Add" and a new
dialog window will show for users which need to make sure first to select the extension type to be FXS Extension
before proceeding to fill in the extension information. The configuration parameters are as follows.
General
Extension The extension number associated with the user.
Analog Station Select the FXS port to be assigned for this extension.
Configure the CallerID Number that would be applied for outbound calls from this
user.
Caller ID Number
Note: The ability to manipulate your outbound Caller ID may be limited by your VoIP
provider.
Assign permission level to the user. The available permissions are "Internal", "Local",
"National" and "International" from the lowest level to the highest level. The default
setting is "Internal".
Privilege
Note:
Users need to have the same level as or higher level than an outbound rule's privilege
to make outbound calls using this rule.
Configure Voicemail.
There are three valid options and the default option is "Enable Local Voicemail".
Voicemail
Disable Voicemail: Disable Voicemail.
Enable Local Voicemail: Enable voicemail for the user.
Configure voicemail password (digits only) for the user to access the voicemail box.
Voicemail
A random numeric password is automatically generated. It is recommended to use
Password
the random generated password for security purpose.
Skip Voicemail
When user dials voicemail code, the password verification IVR is skipped. If enabled,
Password
this would allow one-button voicemail access. By default, this option is disabled.
Verification
Send Voicemail Configures whether or not to send emails to the extension’s email address to notify of
Email Notification new voicemail.
Attach Voicemail Configures whether or not to attach voicemail audio file to the voicemail notification
to Email emails.
Keep Voicemail Only applies if extension-level or global Send Voicemail to Email is enabled.
P a g e | 143
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
after Emailing
Emergency CID
CallerID name that will be used for emergency calls and callbacks.
Name
If selected, this extension will be disabled on the UCM630X.
Disable This
Note: The disabled extension still exists on the PBX but cannot be used on the end
Extension
device.
User Settings
Configure the first name of the user. The first name can contain characters, letters,
First Name
digits and _.
Configure the last name of the user. The last name can contain characters, letters,
Last Name
digits and _.
Email Address Fill in the Email address for the user. Voicemail will be sent to this Email address.
Configure the password for user portal access. A random numeric password is
User Password automatically generated. It is recommended to use the randomly generated password
for security purpose.
Mobile Phone
Configure the Mobile number of the user.
Number
Select the voice prompt language to be used for this extension. The default setting is
"Default" which is the selected voice prompt language under Web GUIPBX
SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings. The dropdown list shows all the
Language
current available voice prompt languages on the UCM630X. To add more languages
in the list, please download voice prompt package by selecting "Check Prompt List"
under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings.
Analog Settings
Call Waiting Configure to enable/disable call waiting feature. The default setting is "No".
If configured, the # key can be used as SNED key after dialing the number on the
User ‘#’ as SEND
analog phone. The default setting is "Yes".
Configure the RX gain for the receiving channel of analog FXS port. The valid range
RX Gain
is -30dB to +6dB. The default setting is 0.
Configure the TX gain for the transmitting channel of analog FXS port. The valid range
TX Gain
is -30dB to +6dB. The default setting is 0.
Configure the minimum period of time (in milliseconds) that the hook-flash must
Min RX Flash remain unpressed for the PBX to consider the event as a valid flash event. The valid
range is 30ms to 1000ms. The default setting is 200ms.
P a g e | 144
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the maximum period of time (in milliseconds) that the hook-flash must
remain unpressed for the PBX to consider the event as a valid flash event. The
Max RX Flash
minimum period of time is 256ms and it cannot be modified. The default setting is
1250ms.
If enabled, a polarity reversal will be marked as received when an outgoing call is
Enable Polarity answered by the remote party. For some countries, a polarity reversal is used for
Reversal signaling the disconnection of a phone line and the call will be considered as Hangup
on a polarity reversal. The default setting is "Yes".
Specify "ON", "OFF" or a value (the power of 2) from 32 to 1024 as the number of
taps of cancellation.
Echo Cancellation Note: When configuring the number of taps, the number 256 is not translated into
256ms of echo cancellation. Instead, 256 taps mean 256/8 = 32 ms. The default
setting is "ON", which is 128 taps.
Configure to enable/disable 3-way calling feature on the user. The default setting is
3-Way Calling
enabled.
Send CallerID
Configure the number of rings before sending CID. Default setting is 1.
After
For FXS extension, there are three options available in Fax Mode. The default setting
is “None”.
None: Disable Fax.
Fax Gateway: If selected, the UCM630X can support conversation and
Fax Mode processing of Fax data from T.30 to T.38 or T.38 to T.30. only for FXS ports.
Fax Detection: During a call, the fax signal from the user/trunk will be detected,
and the received fax will be sent to the email address configured for the user. If
an email address has been configured for the user, the fax will be sent to the
Default Email Address configured in Fax/T.38->Fax Settings .
Call Transfer
Call Forward Configure the Call Forward Unconditional target number. If not configured, the Call
Unconditional Forward Unconditional feature is deactivated. The default setting is deactivated.
Select time condition for Call Forward Unconditional. CFU takes effect only during the
selected time condition. The available time conditions are “Office Time”, “Out of Office
Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday” and “Specific”.
CFU Time Note:
Condition “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
P a g e | 145
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Call Forward No Configure the Call Forward No Answer target number. If not configured, the Call
Answer Forward No Answer feature is deactivated. The default setting is deactivated.
Select time condition for Call Forward No Answer. The available time conditions are
“Office Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or
Holiday” and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFN Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Configure the Call Forward Busy target number. If not configured, the Call Forward
Call Forward Busy
Busy feature is deactivated. The default setting is deactivated.
Select time condition for Call Forward Busy. The available time conditions are “Office
Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFB Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
DND Time The time condition of DND. The DND will take effect while the time condition is
Condition satisfied.
If DND is enabled, calls from the whitelisted numbers will not be rejected. Multiple
numbers are supported and must be separated by new lines. Pattern matching is
supported.
DND Whitelist
Z match any digit from 1-9.
N match any digit from 2-9.
X match any digit from 0-9..
P a g e | 146
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Calls from users in the forward whitelist will not be forwarded.
Pattern matching is supported.
FWD Whitelist Z match any digit from 1-9.
N match any digit from 2-9.
X match any digit from 0-9.
CC Settings
If enabled, UCM630X will automatically alert this extension when a called party is
Enable CC
available, given that a previous call to that party failed for some reason.
Ring Simultaneously
Enable this option to have an external number ring simultaneously along with the
Ring
extension. If a register trunk is used for outbound, the register number will be used to
Simultaneously
be displayed for the external number as caller ID number.
Set the external number to be rang simultaneously. ‘-’ is the connection character
External Number
which will be ignored.
Use callee DOD on Use the callee's DOD number as CallerID on Outgoing Forwarding or Ring
FWD or RS Simultaneously calls.
Hotline
If enabled, hotline dialing plan will be activated, a pre-configured number will be used
Enable Hotline
according to the selected Hotline Type.
Immediate Hotline:
When the phone is off-hook, UCM630X will immediately dial the preset number
Hotline Type
Delay Hotline:
When the phone is off hook, if there is no dialing within 5 seconds, UCM630X will
dial the preset number.
Monitor privilege control
Allow call-barging Members of the list can spy on this extension via feature codes.
P a g e | 147
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Seamless transfer privilege control
Allowed to
Members of the list can seamlessly transfer via feature code.
seamless transfer
Other Settings
Configure the number of seconds to ring the user before the call is forwarded to
voicemail (voicemail is enabled) or hang up (voicemail is disabled). If not specified,
the default ring timeout is 60 seconds on the UCM630X, which can be configured in
the global ring timeout setting under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice
Ring Timeout
PromptCustom Prompt: General Preference. The valid range is between 5 seconds
and 600 seconds.
Note: If the end point also has a ring timeout configured, the actual ring timeout used
is the shortest time set by either device.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this extension. The default setting is
Auto Record disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web GUICDRRecording
Files.
If set to “Yes”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound calls.
If set to “By Time”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound
Skip Trunk Auth calls during the selected time condition.
If set to “No”, users will be asked to enter the password when making outbound
calls.
Time Condition for If “Skip Trunk Auth” is set to “By Time”, select a time condition during which users can
Skip Trunk Auth skip entering password when making outbound calls.
Dial Trunk
Configure personal password when making outbound calls via trunk.
Password
If enabled, this extension will be added to LDAP Phonebook PBX list; if disabled, this
Enable LDAP
extension will be skipped when creating LDAP Phonebook.
Use MOH as IVR If enabled, when the call to the extension is made through the IVR, the caller will hear
ringback tone MOH as ringback tone instead of the regular ringback tone.
Select which Music On Hold class to suggest to extension when putting the active call
Music On Hold
on hold.
Call Duration Limit Check to enable and set the call limit the duration.
Maximum Call The maximum call duration (in seconds). The default value 0 means no limit. Max
Duration (s) value is 86400 seconds
Email Missed
Send a log of missed calls to the extension's email address.
Calls
If Email Missed Calls enabled, users can select the type of missed calls to be sent
Missed Call Type
via email, the available types are:
P a g e | 148
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Default: All missed calls will be sent in email notifications.
Missed Internal Call: Only missed local extension-to-extension calls will be
sent in email notifications.
Missed External Call: Only missed calls from trunks will be sent in email
notifications.
Specific Time
Time Condition Click to add Time Condition to configure specific time for this extension.
Follow Me
Enable Configure to enable or disable Follow Me for this user.
If the outbound calls need to check the password, we should enable this option or
Skip Trunk Auth enable the option "Skip Trunk Auth" of the Extension. Otherwise this Follow Me cannot
call out.
Music On Hold
Configure the Music On Hold class that the caller would hear while tracking the user.
Class
Enable
Configure to enable destination.
Destination
Default
The call will be routed to this destination if no one in the Follow Me answers the call.
Destination
Confirm When
If enabled, call will need to be confirmed after answering.
Answering
Use Callee DOD Use the callee DOD number as CID if configured Follow Me numbers are external
for Follow Me numbers.
Add a new Follow Me number which could be a "Local Extension" or an "External
New Follow Me
Number". The selected dial plan should have permissions to dial the defined external
Number
number.
Dialing Order This is the order in which the Follow Me destinations will be dialed to reach the user.
P a g e | 149
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Batch Add Extensions
To add multiple SIP extensions, BATCH add can be used to create standardized SIP extension accounts.
However, unique extension username cannot be set using BATCH add.
Under Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions, click on "Add” and select extension type as SIP extension,
and “Select Add Method” as Batch.
General
Create Number Specify the number of extensions to be added. The default setting is 5.
Extension Select how much to increment successive extensions. For example, if the value is 2,
Incrementation the extensions will be 1000,1002,1004,...... Note: Up to 3 characters.
Extension Configure the starting extension number of the batch of extensions to be added.
Assign permission level to the user. The available permissions are "Internal", "Local",
"National" and "International" from the lowest level to the highest level. The default
Permission setting is "Internal".
Note: Users need to have the same level as or higher level than an outbound rule's
privilege to make outbound calls from this rule.
Configure Voicemail.
There are three valid options and the default option is "Enable Local Voicemail".
Disable Voicemail: Disable Voicemail.
Voicemail Enable Local Voicemail: Enable voicemail for the user.
Enable Remote Voicemail: Forward the notify message from remote
voicemail system for the user, and the local voicemail will be disabled. Note:
Remote voicemail feature is used only for Infomatec (Brazil).
Configure the SIP/IAX password for the users. Three options are available to create
password for the batch of extensions.
User Random Password.
SIP/IAX Password A random secure password will be automatically generated. It is recommended
to use this password for security purpose.
Use Extension as Password.
Enter a password to be used on all the extensions in the batch.
Configure Voicemail password (digits only) for the users.
User Random Password.
Voicemail
A random password in digits will be automatically generated. It is recommended
Password
to use this password for security purpose.
Use Extension as Password.
P a g e | 150
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Enter a password to be used on all the extensions in the batch.
Send voicemail messages to the configured email address. If set to "Default", the
Send Voicemail to
global setting will be used. Global settings can be found in Voicemail->Voicemail
Email
Email Settings.
Keep Voicemail
Only applies if extension-level or global Send Voicemail to Email is enabled.
after Emailing
Configure CallerID Number when adding Batch Extensions.
Use as Number
Users can choose to set a specific number instead of using the extension number.
Skip Voicemail
When user dials voicemail code, the password verification IVR is skipped. If enabled,
Password
this would allow one-button voicemail access. By default, this option is disabled.
Verification
Enable Keep-alive If enabled, the PBX will regularly send SIP OPTIONS to check if host device is online.
Keep-alive
Configure the keep-alive interval (in seconds) to check if the host is up.
Frequency
Disable This
Check this box to disable this extension.
Extension
If enabled, (1) Call Forward, Call Waiting and Do Not Disturb settings will not work,
Enable SCA (2) Concurrent Registrations can be set only to 1, and (3) Private numbers can be
added in Call Features->SCA page.
Emergency Calls
CallerID number that will be used when calling out and receiving direct callbacks.
CID
Select voice prompt language for this extension. If set to "Default", the global setting
Language
for voice prompt language will be used.
Media
Use NAT when the PBX is on a public IP communicating with devices hidden behind
NAT (e.g., broadband router). If there is one-way audio issue, usually it is related to
NAT
NAT configuration or Firewall's support of SIP and RTP ports.
The default setting is enabled.
By default, the PBX will route the media steams from SIP endpoints through itself. If
Enable Direct enabled, the PBX will attempt to negotiate with the endpoints to route the media
Media stream directly. It is not always possible for the PBX to negotiate endpoint-to-endpoint
media routing. The default setting is "No".
P a g e | 151
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select DTMF mode for the user to send DTMF. The default setting is "RFC4733". If
"Info" is selected, SIP INFO message will be used. If "Inband" is selected, a-law or u-
DTMF Mode
law are required. When "Auto" is selected, RFC4733 will be used if offered, otherwise
"Inband" will be used.
When present in an INVITE request, the Alert-info header field specifies an alternative
Alert-info
ring tone to the UAS.
Video FEC Check to enable Forward Error Correction (FEC) for Video.
Audio FEC Check to enable Forward Error Correction (FEC) for Audio.
Access Control List manages the IP addresses that can register to this extension.
Allow All: Any IP address can register to this extension.
ACL Policy Local Network: Only IP addresses in the configured network segments can
register to this extension. Press “Add Local Network Address” to add more IP
segments.
Select jitter buffer method.
Disable: Jitter buffer will not be used.
Fixed: Jitter buffer with a fixed size (equal to the value of "jitter buffer size")
Jitter Buffer
Adaptive: Jitter buffer with an adaptive size (no more than the value of
"max jitter buffer").
NetEQ: Dynamic jitter buffer via NetEQ.
Codec Preference Configure the codecs to be used.
Call Transfer
Select which presence status to set for the extension and configure call forward
Presence Status conditions for each status. Six possible options are possible: “Available”, “Away”,
“Chat”, “Custom”, “DND” and “Unavailable”. More details at [PRESENCE].
P a g e | 152
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Enable and configure the Call Forward Unconditional target number. Available options
for target number are:
“None”: Call forward deactivated.
“Extension”: Select an extension from dropdown list as CFU target.
“Custom Number”: Enter a customer number as target. For example: *97.
Call Forward
“Voicemail”: Select an extension from dropdown list. Incoming calls will be
Unconditional
forwarded to voicemail of selected extension.
“Ring Group”: Select a ring group from dropdown list as CFU target.
“Queues”: Select a queue from dropdown list as CFU target.
“Voicemail Group”: Select a voicemail group from dropdown list as CFU target.
The default setting is “None”.
Select time condition for Call Forward Unconditional. CFU takes effect only during the
selected time condition. The available time conditions are “Office Time”, “Out of Office
Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday” and “Specific”.
Note:
CFU Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Configure the Call Forward No Answer target number. Available options for target
number are:
“None”: Call forward deactivated.
“Extension”: Select an extension from dropdown list as CFN target.
“Custom Number”: Enter a customer number as target. For example: *97.
Call Forward No
“Voicemail”: Select an extension from dropdown list. Incoming calls will be
Answer
forwarded to voicemail of selected extension.
“Ring Group”: Select a ring group from dropdown list as CFN target.
“Queues”: Select a queue from dropdown list as CFN target.
“Voicemail Group”: Select a voicemail group from dropdown list as CFN target.
The default setting is “None”.
CFN Time Select time condition for Call Forward No Answer. The available time conditions are
Condition “Office Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or
P a g e | 153
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Holiday” and “Specific”.
Notes:
“Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Configure the Call Forward Busy target number. Available options for target number
are:
“None”: Call forward deactivated.
“Extension”: Select an extension from dropdown list as CFB target.
“Custom Number”: Enter a customer number as target. For example: *97.
Call Forward Busy “Voicemail”: Select an extension from dropdown list. Incoming calls will be
forwarded to voicemail of selected extension.
“Ring Group”: Select a ring group from dropdown list as CFB target.
“Queues”: Select a queue from dropdown list as CFB target.
“Voicemail Group”: Select a voicemail group from dropdown list as CFB target.
The default setting is “None”.
Select time condition for Call Forward Busy. The available time conditions are “Office
Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFB Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
DND Time Select time condition for Do Not Disturb. The available time conditions are “Office
Condition Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
P a g e | 154
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
and “Specific”.
Notes:
“Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
If DND is enabled, calls from the whitelisted numbers will not be rejected. Multiple
numbers are supported and must be separated by new lines. Pattern matching is
DND Whitelist supported.
Z match any digit from 1-9,N match any digit from 2-9,X match any digit from 0-9.
Calls from users in the forward whitelist will not be forwarded. Pattern matching is
FWD Whitelist supported.
Z match any digit from 1-9,N match any digit from 2-9,X match any digit from 0-9.
CC Settings
If enabled, UCM630X will automatically alert this extension when a called party is
Enable CC available, given that a previous call to that party failed for some reason. By default, it
is disabled.
Configure the maximum number of CCSS agents which may be allocated for this
CC Max Agents channel. In other words, this number serves as the maximum number of CC requests
this channel can make. The minimum value is 1.
Configure the maximum number of monitor structures which may be created for this
CC Max Monitors device. In other words, this number tells how many callers may request CC services
for a specific device at one time. The minimum value is 1.
Ring Simultaneously
P a g e | 155
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Enable this option to have an external number ring simultaneously along with the
Ring
extension. If a register trunk is used for outbound, the register number will be used to
Simultaneously
be displayed for the external number as caller ID number.
Set the external number to be rang simultaneously. ‘-’ is the connection character
External Number which will be ignored.
This field accepts only letters, numbers, and special characters + = * #.
Use callee DOD on Use the DOD number when calls are being diverted/forwarded to external
FWD or RS destinations or when ring simultaneous is configured.
P a g e | 156
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Skip Trunk Auth skip entering password when making outbound calls.
Dial Trunk
Configure personal password when making outbound calls via trunk.
Password
Enable LDAP If enabled, the extension will be added to LDAP Phonebook PBX list.
Enable WebRTC
Enable registration and call from WebRTC.
Support
If enabled, the system will create a room whose room number, by default, will equal
Bind PMS Room the extension number in PMS module. Note: If this room already exists, the
configuration of the existing room will be overwritten.
Specify which Music On Hold class to suggest to the bridged channel when putting
Music On Hold
them on hold.
Call Duration Limit The maximum duration of call-blocking.
Maximum Call
The maximum call duration (in seconds). The default value 0 means no limit.
Duration
If disabled, UCM will not invite the extension when it is already in a call and will do
the same work as the user is busy.
Call Waiting
Note: the option only works when the caller dials the extension directly.
Under Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions, click on “Add”, then select extension type as IAX Extension
and the add method to be Batch.
T
able 51: Batch Add IAX Extension Parameters
General
Create Number Specify the number of extensions to be added. The default setting is 5.
Extension Select how much to increment successive extensions. For example, if the value is 2,
Incrementation the extensions will be 1000,1002,1004,......
Extension The extension number associated with this particular user/phone.
Assign permission level to the user. The available permissions are “Internal”, “Local”,
“National” and “International” from the lowest level to the highest level. The default
Permission setting is “Internal”.
Note: Users need to have the same level as or higher level than an outbound rule’s
privilege in order to make outbound calls from this rule.
Configure the Caller ID number displayed when dialing calls from this user. Note:
CallerID Number
The Caller ID usage might be limited by your VoIP provider. In Batch Add Method,
P a g e | 157
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
"e" means to use the extension as the number.
Configure Voicemail. There are three valid options and the default option is "Enable
Local Voicemail".
Voicemail
Disable Voicemail: Disable Voicemail.
Enable Local Voicemail: Enable voicemail for the user.
Configure the SIP/IAX password for the users. Three options are available to create
password for the batch of extensions.
User Random Password.
SIP/IAX Password A random secure password will be automatically generated. It is recommended
to use this password for security purpose.
Use Extension as Password.
Enter a password to be used on all the extensions in the batch.
Configure Voicemail password (digits only) for the users.
User Random Password.
Voicemail A random password in digits will be automatically generated. It is recommended
Password to use this password for security purpose.
Use Extension as Password.
Enter a password to be used on all the extensions in the batch.
Send voicemail messages to the configured email address. If set to "Default", the
Send Voicemail to
global setting will be used. Global settings can be found in Voicemail->Voicemail
Email
Email Settings.
Keep Voicemail
Only applies if extension-level or global Send Voicemail to Email is enabled.
after Emailing
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this extension. The default setting is
Auto Record disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web GUICDRRecording
Files.
Skip Voicemail
When user dials voicemail code, the password verification IVR is skipped. If enabled,
Password
this would allow one-button voicemail access. By default, this option is disabled.
Verification
Disable This
Check this box to disable this extension.
Extension
Select voice prompt language for this extension. If set to "Default", the global setting
Language
for voice prompt language will be used.
IAX Settings
Max Number of Calls Configure the maximum number of calls allowed for each remote IP address.
Configure to enable/disable requiring call token. If set to "Auto", it might lock out
Require Call Token users who depend on backward compatibility when peer authentication credentials
are shared between physical endpoints.
P a g e | 158
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The default setting is "Yes".
SRTP Enable/disable SRTP for RTP stream encryption.
Access Control List manages the IP addresses that can register to this extension.
Allow All: Any IP address can register to this extension.
ACL Policy
Local Network: Only IP addresses in the configured network segments can
register to this extension.
Codec Preference Configure the codecs to be used.
Call Transfer
Call Forward Enable and configure the Call Forward Unconditional target number.
Unconditional
Select time condition for Call Forward Unconditional. CFU takes effect only during the
selected time condition. The available time conditions are “Office Time”, “Out of Office
Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday” and “Specific”.
Note:
CFU Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Call Forward No Configure the Call Forward No Answer target number.
Answer
Select time condition for Call Forward No Answer. The available time conditions are
“Office Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or
Holiday” and “Specific”.
Notes:
CFN Time
“Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition
period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
Call Forward Busy Configure the Call Forward Busy target number.
CFB Time Select time condition for Call Forward Busy. The available time conditions are “Office
P a g e | 159
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Condition Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
and “Specific”.
Notes:
“Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
If Do Not Disturb is enabled, all incoming calls will be dropped.
Do Not Disturb
All call forward settings will be ignored.
Select time condition for Do Not Disturb. The available time conditions are “Office
Time”, “Out of Office Time”, “Holiday”, “Out of Holiday”, “Out of Office Time or Holiday”
and “Specific”.
Notes:
DND Time “Specific” has higher priority to “Office Times” if there is a conflict in terms of time
Condition period.
Specific time can be configured on the bottom of the extension configuration
dialog. Scroll down the add Time Condition for specific time.
Office Time and Holiday could be configured on page System SettingsTime
SettingsOffice Time/Holiday page.
If DND is enabled, calls from the whitelisted numbers will not be rejected. Multiple
numbers are supported and must be separated by new lines. Pattern matching is
supported.
DND Whitelist
Z match any digit from 1-9,
N match any digit from 2-9,
X match any digit from 0-9.
Calls from users in the forward whitelist will not be forwarded. Pattern matching is
supported.
FWD Whitelist Z match any digit from 1-9,
N match any digit from 2-9,
X match any digit from 0-9.
Ring Simultaneously
Enable this option to have an external number ring simultaneously along with the
Ring
extension. If a register trunk is used for outbound, the register number will be used to
Simultaneously
be displayed for the external number as caller ID number.
P a g e | 160
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Set the external number to be rang simultaneously. ‘-’ is the connection character
External Number which will be ignored.
This field accepts only letters, numbers, and special characters + = * #.
Use callee DOD on Use the DOD number when calls are being diverted/forwarded to external
FWD or RS destinations or when ring simultaneous is configured.
Allowed to Add members from “Available Extensions” to “Selected Extensions” so that the
call-barging selected extensions can spy on the used extension using feature code.
Any extensions on the UCM can perform seamless transfer. When using Pickup Incall
Allowed to
feature, only extensions available on the “Selected Extensions” list can perform
seamless transfer
seamless transfer to the edited extension.
Other Settings
Configure the number of seconds to ring the user before the call is forwarded to
voicemail (voicemail is enabled) or hang up (voicemail is disabled). If not specified,
the default ring timeout is 60 seconds on the UCM630X, which can be configured in
the global ring timeout setting under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice
Ring Timeout
PromptCustom Prompt: General Preference. The valid range is between 5 seconds
and 600 seconds.
Note: If the end point also has a ring timeout configured, the actual ring timeout used
is the shortest time set by either device.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this extension. The default setting is
Auto Record
disabled. The recordings can be accessed under Web GUICDRRecording Files.
If set to “yes”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound calls.
If set to “By Time”, users can skip entering the password when making outbound
Skip Trunk Auth calls during the selected time condition.
If set to “No”, users will be asked to enter the password when making outbound
calls.
Time Condition for If ‘Skip Trunk Auth’ is set to ‘By Time’, select a time condition during which users can
Skip Trunk Auth skip entering password when making outbound calls.
P a g e | 161
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Dial Trunk
Configure personal password when making outbound calls via trunk.
Password
Enable LDAP If enabled, the extension will be added to LDAP Phonebook PBX list.
Specify which Music On Hold class to suggest to the bridged channel when putting
Music On Hold
them on hold.
Call Duration Limit Check to enable and set the call limit the duration.
Maximum Call The maximum call duration (in seconds). The default value 0 means no limit. Max
Duration (s) value is 86400 seconds
Users can select multiple extensions and reset their settings to default by pressing the reset button
and confirm the reset functionality. Once done, all settings in Basic Settings page will be restored to default
values with the exception of Concurrent Registrations. User voicemail password will be reset to Random
Password. User voicemail prompts and recordings will be deleted. User Management settings will also be
restored to default with the exception of usernames and custom privileges
All the UCM630X extensions are listed under Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions, with status,
Extension, CallerID Name, Technology (SIP, IAX and FXS), IP and Port. Each extension has a checkbox for
users to "Edit" or "Delete". Also, options "Edit” , "Reboot" and "Delete" are available per extension.
User can search an extension by specifying the extension number to find an extension quickly.
Status
Users can see the following icon for each extension to indicate the SIP status.
Green: Idle
P a g e | 162
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Blue: Ringing
Yellow: In Use
Grey: Unavailable (the extension is not registered or disabled on the PBX)
Click on to send NOTIFY reboot event to the device which has an UCM630X extension already
registered. To successfully reboot the user, "Zero Config" needs to be enabled on the UCM630X Web
GUIValue-added FeaturesZero ConfigZero Config Settings.
Click on to delete the extension. Or select the checkbox of the extension and then click on "Delete
Selected Extensions".
Export Extensions
The extensions configured on the UCM630X can be exported to csv format file with selected technology "SIP",
"IAX" or "FXS". Click on "Export Extensions" button and select technology in the prompt below.
P a g e | 163
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 81: Export Extensions
The exported csv file can serve as a template for users to fill in desired extension information to be imported to
the UCM630X.
Import Extensions
The capability to import extensions to the UCM630X provides users flexibility to batch add extensions with similar
or different configuration quickly into the PBX system.
1. Export extension csv file from the UCM630X by clicking on "Export Extensions" button.
2. Fill up the extension information you would like in the exported csv template.
3. Click on "Import Extensions" button. The following dialog will be prompted.
4. Select the option in "On Duplicate Extension" to define how the duplicate extension(s) in the imported csv
file should be treated by the PBX.
Skip: Duplicate extensions in the csv file will be skipped. The PBX will keep the current extension
information as previously configured without change.
P a g e | 164
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Delete and Recreate: The current extension previously configured will be deleted and the duplicate
extension in the csv file will be loaded to the PBX.
Update Information: The current extension previously configured in the PBX will be kept. However, if
the duplicate extension in the csv file has different configuration for any options, it will override the
configuration for those options in the extension.
5. Click on “Choose file to upload” to select csv file from local directory in the PC.
6. Click on "Apply Changes" to apply the imported file on the UCM630X.
P a g e | 165
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Skip Trunk Auth yes/no/bytime
Codec Preference PCMU,PCMA,GSM,G.726,G.722,G.729,H.264,
H.265,ILBC,AAL2-G.726-
32,ADPCM,G.723,H.263,H.263p,vp8,opus
Permission Internal/Local/National/International
NAT yes/no
DTMF Mode RFC4733/info/inband/auto
Insecure Port
Enable Keep-alive Yes/no
Keep-alive Frequency Value from 1-3600
AuthID Alphanumeric value without special characters
TEL URI Disabled/user=phone/enabled
Call Forward Busy Digits
Call Forward No Answer Digits
Call Forward Unconditional Digits
Support Hot-Desking Mode Yes/no
Dial Trunk Password Digits
Disable This Extension Yes/no
CFU Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of
holiday/out of office time or holiday/specific time
CFN Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of
holiday/out of office time or holiday/specific time
CFB Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of
holiday/out of office time or holiday/specific time
Music On Hold Default/ringbacktone_default
CC Agent Policy If CC is disabled use: never
If CC is set to normal use: generic
If CC is set to trunk use: native
CC Monitor Policy Generic/never
CCBS Available Timer 3600/4800
CCNR Available Timer 3600/7200
CC Offer Timer 60/120
CC Max Agents Value from 1-999
CC Max Monitors Value from 1-999
Ring simultaneously Yes/no
External Number Digits
P a g e | 166
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Time Condition for Ring Simultaneously All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of
holiday/out of office time or holiday/specific time
Time Condition for Skip Trunk Auth All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of
holiday/out of office time or holiday/specific time
Enable LDAP Yes/no
Enable T.38 UDPTL Yes/no
Max Contacts Values from 1-10
Enable WebRTC Yes/no
Alert-Info None/Ring 1/Ring2/Ring3/Ring 4/Ring 5/Ring 6/Ring 7/ Ring
8/Ring 9/Ring 10/bellcore-dr1/bellcore-dr2/ bellcore-dr3/
bellcore-dr4/ bellcore-dr5/custom
Do Not Disturb Yes/no
DND Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of
holiday/out of office time or holiday/specific time
Custom Auto answer Yes/no
Do Not Disturb Whitelist Empty/digits
User Password Alphanumeric characters.
First Name Alphanumeric without special characters.
Last Name Alphanumeric without special characters.
Email Address Email address
Language Default/en/zh
Phone Number Digits
Call-Barging Monitor Extensions allowed to call barging
Seamless Transfer Members Extensions allowed to seamless transfer
P a g e | 167
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SRTP yes/no
Strategy Allow All/Local Subnet Only/A Specific IP Address
Local Subnet 1 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 2 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 3 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 4 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 5 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 6 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 7 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 8 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 9 IP address/Mask
Local Subnet 10 IP address/Mask
Specific IP Address IP address
Skip Trunk Auth yes/no/bytime
Codec Preference PCMU,PCMA,GSM,G.726,G.722,G.729,H.264,
H.265,ILBC,AAL2-G.726-
32,ADPCM,G.723,H.263,H.263p,vp8,opus
Permission Internal/Local/National/International
NAT yes/no
Call Forward Busy Digits
Call Forward No Answer Digits
Call Forward Unconditional Digits
Require Call Token Yes/no/auto
Max Number of Calls Values from 1-512
Dial Trunk Password Digits
Disable This Extension Yes/no
CFU Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
CFN Time Condition of office time or holiday/specific time
CFB Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
Music On Hold Default/ringbacktone_default
Ring simultaneously Yes/no
External Number Digits
Time Condition for Ring Simultaneously All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
P a g e | 168
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Time Condition for Skip Trunk Auth All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
Enable LDAP Yes/no
Limit Max time (s) empty
Do Not Disturb Yes/no
DND Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
Do Not Disturb Whitelist Empty/digits
User Password Alphanumeric characters.
First Name Alphanumeric without special characters.
Last Name Alphanumeric without special characters.
Email Address Email address
Language Default/en/zh
Phone Number Digits
Call-Barging Monitor Extensions allowed to call barging
Seamless Transfer Members Extensions allowed to seamless transfer
P a g e | 169
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Call Waiting Yes/no
Use # as SEND Yes/no
RX Gain Values from -306
TX Gain Values from -306
MIN RX Flash Values from: 30 – 1000
MAX RX Flash Values from: 40 – 2000
Enable Polarity Reversal Yes/no
Echo Cancellation On/Off/32/64/128/256/512/1024
3-Way Calling Yes/no
Send CallerID After 1/2
Dial Trunk Password digits
Disable This Extension Yes/no
CFU Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
CFN Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
CFB Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
Music On Hold Default/ringbacktone_default
CC Agent Policy If CC is disabled use: never
If CC is set to normal use: generic
If CC is set to trunk use: native
CC Monitor Policy Generic/never
CCBS Available Timer 3600/4800
CCNR Available Timer 3600/7200
CC Offer Timer 60/120
CC Max Agents Value from 1-999
CC Max Monitors Value from 1-999
Ring simultaneously Yes/no
External Number Digits
Time Condition for Ring Simultaneously All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
Time Condition for Skip Trunk Auth of office time or holiday/specific time
P a g e | 170
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Hotline Number digits
Limit Max time (s) empty
Do Not Disturb Yes/no
DND Time Condition All time/Office time/out of office time/holiday/out of holiday/out
of office time or holiday/specific time
Do Not Disturb Whitelist Empty/digits
User Password Alphanumeric characters.
First Name Alphanumeric without special characters.
Last Name Alphanumeric without special characters.
Email Address Email address
Language Default/en/zh
Phone Number Digits
Call-Barging Monitor Extensions allowed to call barging
Seamless Transfer Members Extensions allowed to seamless transfer
The CSV file should contain all the above fields, if one of them is missing or empty, the UCM630X will display
the following error message for missing fields.
Extension Details
Users can click on an extension number in the Extensions list page and quickly view information about it such
as:
Extension: Shows the Extension number.
Status: Shows the status of the extension.
Presence status: Indicates the Presence Status of this extension.
Terminal Type: Shows the Type of the terminal using this extension (SIP, FXS…etc.).
Caller ID Name: Reveals the Caller ID Name configured on the extension.
Messages: Shows the messages stats.
IP and Port: The IP address and the ports of the device using the extension.
Email status: Show the Email status (sent, to be sent…etc.).
Ring Group: Indicates the ring groups that this extension belongs to.
Call Queue: Indicates the Cal Queues that this extension belongs to.
Call Queue (Dynamic): Indicates the Call Queues that this extension belongs to as a dynamic agent.
P a g e | 171
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 85: Extension Details
E-mail Notification
Once the extensions are created with Email addresses, the PBX administrator can click on button “E-mail
Notification” to send the account registration and configuration information to the user. Please make sure Email
setting under Web GUISystem SettingsEmail Settings is properly configured and tested on the UCM630X
before using “E-mail Notification”.
When click on ”More” > “E-mail Notification” button, the following message will be prompted in the web page.
Click on OK to confirm sending the account information to all users’ Email addresses.
P a g e | 172
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The user will receive Email including account registration information as well as the GSWave Settings with the
QR code:
P a g e | 173
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Multiple Registrations per Extension
UCM630X supports multiple registrations per extension so that users can use the same extension on devices in
different locations.
This feature can be enabled by configuring option “Concurrent Registrations” under Web
GUIExtension/TrunkEdit Extension. The default value is set to 1 for security purpose. Maximum is 10.
P a g e | 174
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SMS Message Support
The UCM630X provides built-in SIP SMS message support. For SIP end devices such as Grandstream GXP or
GXV phones that supports SIP message, after an UCM630X account is registered on the end device, the user
can send and receive SMS message. Please refer to the end device documentation on how to send and receive
SMS message.
P a g e | 175
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
EXTENSION GROUPS
The UCM630X extension group feature allows users to assign and categorize extensions in different groups to
better manage the configurations on the UCM630X. For example, when configuring "Enable Filter on Source
Caller ID", users could select a group instead of each person's extension to assign. This feature simplifies the
configuration process and helps manage and categorize the extensions for business environment.
Select extensions from the list on the left side to the right side.
P a g e | 176
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Click on in order to change the ringing priority of the members selected on the group.
Here is an example where the extension group can be used. Go to Web GUIExtension/TrunkOutbound
Routes and select "Enable Filter on Source Caller ID". Both single extensions and extension groups will show
up for users to select.
P a g e | 177
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ANALOG TRUNKS
P a g e | 178
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
When FXO port answers the call, FXS may send a Polarity Reversal. If this interval is
Polarity on shorter than the value of “Polarity on Answer Delay”, the Polarity Reversal will be
Answer Delay ignored. Otherwise, the FXO will Onhook to disconnect the call. The default setting is
600ms.
Current
This is the periodic time (in ms) that the UCM630X will use to check on a voltage
Disconnect
drop in the line. The default setting is 200. The valid range is 50 to 3000.
Threshold (ms)
Configure the ring timeout (in ms). Trunk (FXO) devices must have a timeout to
determine if there was a Hangup before the line is answered. This value can be used
Ring Timeout
to configure how long it takes before the UCM630X considers a non-ringing line with
Hangup activity. The default setting is 8000.
Configure the RX gain for the receiving channel of analog FXO port. The valid range
RX Gain
is from -13.5 (dB) to + 12.0 (dB). The default setting is 0.
Configure the TX gain for the transmitting channel of analog FXO port. The valid range
TX Gain
is from -13.5 (dB) to + 12.0 (dB). The default setting is 0.
Configure to enable CallerID detection.
Use CallerID
The default setting is “Yes”.
Select the Caller ID scheme for this trunk.
Bellcore/Telcordia.
ETSI-FSK During Ringing
ETSI-FSK Prior to Ringing with DTAS
ETSI-FSK Prior to Ringing with LR
ETSI-FSK Prior to Ringing with RP
ETSI-DTMF During Ringing
Caller ID Scheme ETSI-DTMF Prior to Ringing with DTAS
ETSI-DTMF Prior to Ringing with LR
ETSI-DTMF Prior to Ringing with RP
SIN 227-BT
NTT Japan
Auto Detect
If you are not sure which scheme to choose, please select “Auto Detect”. The default
setting is “Bellcore/Telcordia”.
Configures how faxes to this extension will be handled.
None: Faxes will not be processed.
Fax Mode Fax Gateway: Faxes to this extension will be processed and converted from
T.30 to T.38 or vice-versa. FXS/FXO ports only.
The default setting is None.
P a g e | 179
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
FXO Dial Delay
Configure the time interval between off-hook and first dialed digit for outbound calls.
(ms)
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this trunk. The default setting is
Auto Record disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web GUICDRRecording
Files.
If selected, the trunk will be disabled and incoming/Outgoing calls via this trunk will
Disable This Trunk
not be possible.
This is to implement analog trunk outbound line selection strategy.
Three options are available:
Ascend
When the call goes out from this analog trunk, it will always try to use the first idle
FXO port. The port order that the call will use to go out if UCM6302 is used would
be port 1port 2. Every time it will start with port 1 (if it is idle).
Poll
DAHDI Out Line
When the call goes out from this analog trunk, it will use the port that is not used
Selection
last time. And it will always use the port in the order of port 121212...,
following the last port being used in case UCM6302 is used.
Descend
When the call goes out from this analog trunk, it will always try to use the last idle
FXO port. The port order that the call will use to go out if UCM6302 is used would
be port 2port 1. Every time it will start with port 2 (if it is idle).
Default: The NLP limits the signal level to the background noise level when
active, and the background noise level adjustment is low.
High Noise Level Adjustment: The NLP limits the signal level to the
Echo Cancellation
background noise level when active, and the background noise level adjustment
Mode
is high.
Noise Masking: The NLP sends sign noise when active, and the background
noise level adjustment is high.
White Noise Injection: The NLP injects white noise when active. The level
corresponds to the background noise level at Sin, and the background noise
level adjustment is high.
P a g e | 180
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Allows external numbers the option to get directed to the extension that last called
them.
For Example: User 2002 has dialed external number 061234575 but they were not
Direct Callback
reachable, once they have received missed call notification on their phone, they
would mostly call back the number, if the option “Direct Callback” is enabled then
they will be directly bridged to user 2002 regardless of the configured inbound
destination.
Tone Settings
Busy Detection is used to detect far end Hangup or for detecting busy signal. The
Busy Detection
default setting is "Yes".
If "Busy Detection" is enabled, users can specify the number of busy tones to be
played before hanging up. The default setting is 2. Better results might be achieved if
Busy Tone Count set to 4, 6 or even 8. Please note that the higher the number is, the more time is
needed to Hangup the channel. However, this might lower the probability to get
random Hangup.
Congestion Congestion detection is used to detect far end congestion signal. The default setting
Detection is "Yes".
If "Congestion Detection" is enabled, users can specify the number of congestion
Congestion Count
tones to wait for. The default setting is 2.
Select the country for tone settings. If "Custom" is selected, users could manually
Tone Country configure the values for Busy Tone and Congestion Tone. The default setting is
"United States of America (USA)".
Syntax:
f1=val[@level][,f2=val[@level]],c=on1/off1[-on2/off2[-on3/off3]];
Frequencies are in Hz and cadence on and off are in ms.
Frequencies Range: [0, 4000)
Busy Tone Busy Level Range: (-300, 0)
Cadence Range: [0, 16383].
Select Tone Country "Custom" to manually configure Busy Tone value.
Default value:
f1=480@-50,f2=620@-50,c=500/500
Syntax:
f1=val[@level][,f2=val[@level]],c=on1/off1[-on2/off2[-on3/off3]];
Frequencies are in Hz and cadence on and off are in ms.
Congestion Tone
Frequencies Range: [0, 4000)
Busy Level Range: (-300, 0)
Cadence Range: [0, 16383].
P a g e | 181
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select Tone Country "Custom" to manually configure Busy Tone value.
Default value:
f1=480@-50,f2=620@-50,c=250/250
Click on "Detect" to detect the busy tone, Polarity Reversal and Current Disconnect
by PSTN. Before the detecting, please make sure there are more than one channel
PSTN Detection
configured and working properly. If the detection has busy tone, the "Tone Country"
option will be set as "Custom".
PSTN Detection
The UCM630X provides PSTN detection function to help users detect the busy tone, Polarity Reversal and
Current Disconnect by making a call from the PSTN line to another destination. The detecting call will be
answered and up for about 1 minute. Once done, the detecting result will show and can be used for the UCM630X
settings.
P a g e | 182
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 95: UCM630X PSTN Detection
If there are two FXO ports connected to PSTN lines, use the following settings for auto-detection.
Detect Model: Auto Detect.
Source Channel: The source channel to be detected.
Destination Channel: The channel to help detecting. For example, the second FXO port.
Destination Number: The number to be dialed for detecting. This number must be the actual PSTN
number for the FXO port used as the destination channel.
P a g e | 183
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 96: UCM630X PSTN Detection: Auto Detect
If there is only one FXO port connected to PSTN line, use the following settings for auto-detection.
P a g e | 184
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
5. Click "Detect" to start detecting. The source channel will initiate a call to the destination number. For "Auto
Detect", the call will be automatically answered. For "Semi-auto Detect", the UCM630X Web GUI will display
prompt to notify the user to answer or hang up the call to finish the detecting process.
6. Once done, the detected result will show. Users could save the detecting result as the current UCM630X
settings.
Table 56: PSTN Detection for Analog Trunk
Auto Detect
Please make sure two or more channels are connected to the
UCM630X and in idle status before starting the detection. During the
detection, one channel will be used as caller (Source Channel) and
another channel will be used as callee (Destination Channel). The
UCM630X will control the call to be established and hang up between
caller and callee to finish the detection.
Detect Model
Semi-auto Detect
Semi-auto detection requires answering or hanging up the call
manually. Please make sure one channel is connected to the
UCM630X and in idle status before starting the detection. During the
detection, source channel will be used as caller and send the call to
the configured Destination Number. Users will then need follow the
prompts in Web GUI to help finish the detection.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
The PSTN detection process will keep the call up for about 1 minute.
If "Semi-auto Detect' is used, please pick up the call only after informed from the Web GUI prompt.
Once the detection is successful, the detected parameters "Busy Tone", "Polarity Reversal" and "Current
Disconnect by PSTN" will be filled into the corresponding fields in the analog trunk configuration.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 185
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
VOIP TRUNKS
VoIP trunks can be configured in UCM630X under Web GUIExtension/TrunkVoIP Trunks. Once created,
the VoIP trunks will be listed with Provider Name, Type, Hostname/IP, Username and Options to edit/detect the
trunk.
Click on "Add SIP Trunk" or "Add IAX Trunk" to add a new VoIP trunk.
Click on to configure Direct Outward Dialing (DOD) for the SIP Trunk.
For VoIP trunk example, please refer to the document in the following link:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/ucm6xxx_sip_trunk_guide.pdf
Configure a unique label (up to 64 character) to identify this trunk when listed in
Provider Name
outbound rules, inbound rules etc.
Host Name Configure the IP address or URL for the VoIP provider’s server of the trunk.
Keep the CID from the inbound call when dialing out. This setting will override
Keep Original CID “Keep Trunk CID” option. Please make sure that the peer PBX at the other side
supports to match user entry using “username” field from authentication line.
If enabled, the trunk CID will not be overridden by extension’s CID when the
Keep Trunk CID
extension has CID configured. The default setting is “No”.
P a g e | 186
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Turn on this setting when the PBX is using public IP and communicating with
NAT devices behind NAT. If there is one-way audio issue, usually it is related to NAT
configuration or SIP/RTP port support on the firewall.
Important Note: When making outgoing calls, the following priority order rule will
Caller ID Number be used to determine which CallerID will be set before sending out the call:
From user (Register Trunk Only) CID from inbound call (Keep Original CID
Enabled) Trunk Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID Enabled) DOD
Extension CallerID Number Trunk Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID
Disabled) Global Outbound CID.
Configure the new name of the caller when the extension has no CallerID Name
CallerID Name
configured.
Select whether the trunk needs to register on the external server or not when
Need Registration
"Register SIP Trunk" type is selected. The default setting is No.
Allow outgoing calls Uncheck to block outgoing calls if registration fails. If "Need Registration" option is
if registration fails unchecked, this setting will be ignored.
Enter the username to register to the trunk from the provider when "Register SIP
Username
Trunk" type is selected.
Enter the password to register to the trunk from the provider when "Register SIP
Password
Trunk" is selected.
Auth ID Enter the Authentication ID for "Register SIP Trunk" type.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this trunk (for SIP trunk only). The
Auto Record default setting is disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web
GUICDRRecording Files.
P a g e | 187
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Allows external numbers the option to get directed to the extension that last called
them.
For Example: User 2002 has dialed external number 061234575 but they were not
Direct Callback reachable, once they have received missed call notification on their phone, they
would mostly call back the number, if the option “Direct Callback” is enabled then
they will be directly bridged to user 2002 regardless of the configured inbound
destination.
RemoteConnect If enabled, the RemoteConnect related parameters will be set synchronously.
Mode Please make sure the trunk host is allocated by GDMS or it supports TLS.
Basic Settings
Configure a unique label to identify this trunk when listed in outbound rules,
Provider Name
inbound rules etc.
Host Name Configure the IP address or URL for the VoIP provider’s server of the trunk.
Configure the SIP transport protocol to be used in this trunk. The default setting is
"UDP".
Transport UDP
TCP
TLS
SIP URI Scheme When TLS is selected as Transport for register trunk, users can select
When Using TLS between SIP and SIPS URI scheme
Keep the CID from the inbound call when dialing out. This setting will override
Keep Original CID “Keep Trunk CID” option. Please make sure that the peer PBX at the other side
supports to match user entry using “username” field from authentication line.
If enabled, the trunk CID will not be overridden by extension’s CID when the
Keep Trunk CID
extension has CID configured. The default setting is “No”.
Turn on this option when the PBX is using public IP and communicating with
NAT devices behind NAT. If there is one-way audio issue, usually it is related to NAT
configuration or SIP/RTP port configuration on the firewall.
If selected, the trunk will be disabled.
Disable This Trunk Note: If a current SIP trunk is disabled, UCM will send UNREGISTER message
(REGISTER message with expires=0) to the SIP provider.
If the trunk has an assigned PSTN telephone number, this field should be set to
"User=Phone". Then a "User=Phone" parameter will be attached to the Request-
TEL URI Line and TO header in the SIP request to indicate the E.164 number. If set to
"Enable", "Tel:" will be used instead of "SIP:" in the SIP request. The default setting
is disabled.
P a g e | 188
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select whether the trunk needs to register on the external server or not when
Need Registration "Register SIP Trunk" type is selected.
The default setting is No.
If enabled outgoing calls even if the registration to this trunk fail will still be able to
Allow outgoing calls
go through.
if registration failure
Note that if we uncheck “Need Registration” option, this option will be ignored.
Configure the new name of the caller when the extension has no CallerID Name
CallerID Name
configured.
Configure the actual domain name where the extension comes from. This can be
used to override the “From” Header.
From Domain
For example, "trunk.UCM630X.provider.com" is the From Domain in From Header:
sip:[email protected].
Configure the actual username of the extension. This can be used to override the
“From” Header. There are cases where there is a single ID for registration (single
From User trunk) with multiple DIDs.
For example, "1234567" is the From User in From Header:
sip:[email protected].
Enter the username to register to the trunk from the provider when "Register SIP
Username
Trunk" type is selected.
Password Enter the password to register to the trunk when "Register SIP Trunk" is selected.
If enabled, the UCM will send 401 response to the incoming call to authenticate
Auth Trunk
the trunk.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this trunk (for SIP trunk only). The
Auto Record default setting is disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web
GUICDRRecording Files.
Allows external numbers the option to get directed to the extension that last called
them.
For Example: User 2002 has dialed external number 061234575 but they were not
Direct Callback reachable, once they have received missed call notification on their phone, they
would mostly call back the number, if the option “Direct Callback” is enabled then
they will be directly bridged to user 2002 regardless of the configured inbound
destination.
P a g e | 189
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Advanced Settings
Select audio and video codec for the VoIP trunk. The available codecs are: PCMU,
Codec Preference PCMA, GSM, AAL2-G.726-32, G.726, G.722, G.729, G.723, iLBC, ADPCM,
H.264, H.265, H.263, H.263p and VP8.
If enabled, the SIP INVITE message sent to the trunk will contain PPI (P-Preferred-
Identity) header. The default setting is “No”.
Send PPI Header
Note: “Send PPI Header” and “Send PAI Header” cannot be enabled at the same
time. Only one of the two headers can be contained in SIP INVITE message.
Default – Include the trunk’s preferred CID (configured in Basic Settings) in the
PPI Header.
PPI Mode Original CID – Include the original CID in the PPI Header.
DOD Number – Include the trunk’s DOD number in the PPI Header. If no DOD
number has been set, the trunk’s preferred CID will be used.
If enabled, the SIP INVITE message sent to the trunk will contain PAI (P-Asserted-
Identity) header including configured PAI Header. The default setting is “No”.
Send PAI Header
Note: “Send PPI Header” and “Send PAI Header” cannot be enabled at the same
time. Only one of the two headers can be contained in the SIP INVITE message.
If “Send PAI Header” is enabled and “PAI Header” is configured as “123456” for
instance, the PAI header in the SIP message sent from the UCM will contain
“123456”. If “Send PAI Header” is enabled and “PAI Header” is configured as
PAI Header “empty”, the PAI header in the SIP message sent from the UCM will contain the
original CID.
Note:
“Send PAI Header” needs to be enabled to use this feature
If checked, the "From" header in outgoing INVITE message will be set to
Send Anonymous
anonymous.
If enabled and "From User" is configured, the INVITE's From header will contain
DOD As From Name the DOD number.
Passthrough PAI If checked and option "Send PAI Header" not checked, the PAI header will be
Header passthrough from one side to the other side.
If checked, the INVITE and REGISTER sent to the trunk will contain P-Access-
Send PANI Header Network-Info header.
Access Network Info The access network information in the P-Access-Network-Info header.
P a g e | 190
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If checked, the "From" header in outgoing INVITE message will be set to
Send Anonymous anonymous.
Default: The global setting of DTMF mode will be used. The global setting
for DTMF Mode setting is under Web GUIPBX SettingsSIP
SettingsToS.
Inband: Send DTMF using inband audio. This requires 64-bit codec, i.e.,
PCMU and PCMA.
P a g e | 191
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
FECC Configure to enable Far-end Camera Control
SRTP Enable SRTP for the VoIP trunk. The default setting is "No".
Enable T.38 UDPTL Enable or disable T.38 UDPTL support.
STIR/SHAKEN Block disturbance calls, this function needs to be supported by the opposite end.
CC Settings
If enabled, the system will automatically alert the user when a called party is
Enable CC
available, given that a previous call to that party failed for some reason.
Configure the maximum number of CCSS agents which may be allocated for this
CC Max Agents channel. In other words, this number serves as the maximum number of CC
requests this channel is allowed to make. The minimum value is 1.
Configure the maximum number of monitor structures which may be created for
CC Max Monitors this device. In other words, this number tells how many callers may request CC
services for a specific device at one time. The minimum value is 1.
Basic Settings
Configure a unique label to identify this trunk when listed in outbound rules,
Provider Name
inbound rules and etc.
Host Name Configure the IP address or URL for the VoIP provider’s server of the trunk.
Enable automatic recording for the calls using this trunk (for SIP trunk only). The
Auto Record default setting is disabled. The recording files can be accessed under Web
GUICDRRecording Files.
Keep the CID from the inbound call when dialing out, this setting will override “Keep
Keep Original CID Trunk CID” option. Please make sure that the peer PBX at the other side supports
to match user entry using “username” field from authentication line.
If enabled, the trunk CID will not be overridden by extension’s CID when the
Keep Trunk CID
extension has CID configured. The default setting is “No”.
Turn on this option when the PBX is using public IP and communicating with
NAT devices behind NAT. If there is one-way audio issue, usually it is related to NAT
configuration or SIP/RTP port configuration on the firewall.
If selected, the trunk will be disabled.
Disable This Trunk Note: If a current SIP trunk is disabled, UCM will send UNREGISTER message
(REGISTER message with expires=0) to the SIP provider.
If the trunk has an assigned PSTN telephone number, this field should be set to
TEL URI
"User=Phone". Then a "User=Phone" parameter will be attached to the Request-
P a g e | 192
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Line and TO header in the SIP request to indicate the E.164 number. If set to
"Enable", "Tel:" will be used instead of "SIP:" in the SIP request. The default setting
is disabled.
Configure the Caller ID. This is the number that the trunk will try to use when
making outbound calls. For some providers, it might not be possible to set the
CallerID with this option and this option will be ignored.
Important Note: When making outgoing calls, the following priority order rule will
Caller ID Number be used to determine which CallerID will be set before sending out the call :
CID from inbound call (Keep Original CID Enabled) Trunk
Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID Enabled) DOD Extension CallerID
Number Trunk Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID Disabled) Global
Outbound CID.
Configure the name of the caller to be displayed when the extension has no
CallerID Name
CallerID Name configured.
Configure the SIP transport protocol to be used in this trunk. The default setting is
"UDP".
Transport UDP
TCP
TLS
RemoteConnect If enabled, the RemoteConnect related parameters will be set synchronously.
Mode Please make the trunk host is allocated by GDMS or it supports TLS.
Allows external numbers the option to get directed to the extension that last called
them.
For Example: User 2002 has dialed external number 061234575 but they were not
Direct Callback reachable, once they have received missed call notification on their phone, they
would mostly call back the number, if the option “Direct Callback” is enabled then
they will be directly bridged to user 2002 regardless of the configured inbound
destination.
Advanced Settings
Select audio and video codec for the VoIP trunk. The available codecs are: PCMU,
Codec Preference PCMA, GSM, AAL2-G.726-32, G.726, G.722, G.729, G.723, iLBC, ADPCM,
H.264, H.265, H.263, H.263p and VP8.
If checked, the invite message sent to trunks will contain PPI (P-Preferred-Identity)
Send PPI Header
Header.
If checked, the INVITE, 18x and 200 SIP messages sent to trunks will contain P-
Send PAI Header
Asserted-Identity (PAI) header. It is not possible to send both PPI and PAI headers.
Passthrough PAI If enabled and "Send PAI Header" is disabled, PAI headers will be preserved as
Header calls pass through the UCM.
P a g e | 193
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If checked, the INVITE sent to the trunk will contain P-Access-Network-Info
Send PANI Header
header.
If checked, the "From" header in outgoing INVITE message will be set to
Send Anonymous
anonymous.
Configure where to get the destination ID of an incoming SIP call, from SIP
DID Mode
Request-line or To-header. The default is set to "Request-line".
Configure the default DTMF mode when sending DTMF on this trunk.
Default: The global setting of DTMF mode will be used. The global setting
for DTMF Mode setting is under Web GUIPBX SettingsSIP
SettingsToS.
Inband: Send DTMF using inband audio. This requires 64-bit codec, i.e.,
PCMU and PCMA.
P a g e | 194
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Sync LDAP Password used for LDAP phonebook encryption and decryption. The password
Password must be the same for both peers to ensure successful syncing.
Specify an outbound rule for LDAP sync feature. The UCM630X will automatically
LDAP Outbound Rule
modify the remote contacts by adding prefix parsed from this rule.
Specify the prefix for LDAP sync feature. The UCM630X will automatically modify
LDAP Dialed Prefix
the remote contacts by adding this prefix.
LDAP Last Sync Date The last successful sync date.
Enable T.38 UDPTL Enable or disable T.38 UDPTL support.
STIR/SHAKEN Block disturbance calls, this function needs to be supported by the opposite end.
CC Settings
If enabled, the system will automatically alert the user when a called party is
Enable CC
available, given that a previous call to that party failed for some reason.
Configure the maximum number of CCSS agents which may be allocated for this
CC Max Agents channel. In other words, this number serves as the maximum number of CC
requests this channel can make. The minimum value is 1.
Configure the maximum number of monitor structures which may be created for
this device. In other words, this number tells how many callers may request CC
CC Max Monitors
services for a specific device at one time.
The minimum value is 1.
P a g e | 195
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
enabled and the call is originally from another trunk) >>> Trunk CID (Keep Trunk
CID enabled) >>> DOD CID >>> Extension CID >>> Register Trunk Username
(Keep Trunk CID disabled) >>> Global Outbound CID.
Note 1: Certain providers may ignore this CID.
Note 2: If this CID contains asterisk (*), call recordings from this trunk might be lost
when saving them to NAS storage.
Configure the new name of the caller when the extension has no CallerID Name
CallerID Name
configured.
Basic Settings
Configure a unique label to identify this trunk when listed in outbound rules,
Provider Name
inbound rules etc.
Host Name Configure the IP address or URL for the VoIP provider’s server of the trunk.
If enabled, the trunk CID will not be overridden by extension's CID when the
Keep Trunk CID
extension has CID configured. The default setting is "No".
Disable This Trunk If selected, the trunk will be disabled.
Configure the Caller ID. This is the number that the trunk will try to use when
making outbound calls. For some providers, it might not be possible to set the
CallerID with this option and this option will be ignored.
Important Note: When making outgoing calls, the following priority order rule will
Caller ID be used to determine which CallerID will be set before sending out the call :
From user (Register Trunk Only) CID from inbound call (Keep Original CID
Enabled) Trunk Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID Enabled) DOD
Extension CallerID Number Trunk Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID
Disabled) Global Outbound CID.
Configure the name of the caller to be displayed when the extension has no
CallerID Name
CallerID Name configured.
Username Enter the username to register to the trunk from the provider.
Password Enter the password to register to the trunk from the provider.
Advanced Settings
Select audio and video codec for the VoIP trunk. The available codecs are: PCMU,
Codec Preference PCMA, GSM, AAL2-G.726-32, G.726, G.722, G.729, G.723, iLBC, ADPCM,
H.264, H.265, H.263, H.263p and VP8.
P a g e | 196
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Enable Heartbeat If enabled, the UCM630X will regularly send SIP OPTIONS to the device to check
Detection if the device is still online. The default setting is "No".
When "Enable Heartbeat Detection" option is set to "Yes", configure the interval
Heartbeat Frequency (in seconds) of the SIP OPTIONS message sent to the device to check if the device
is still online. The default setting is 60 seconds.
Maximum Number of The maximum number of concurrent calls using the trunk. The default settings 0,
Call Lines which means no limited.
Basic Settings
Configure a unique label to identify this trunk when listed in outbound rules,
Provider Name
inbound rules etc.
Host Name Configure the IP address or URL for the VoIP provider’s server of the trunk.
If enabled, the trunk CID will not be overridden by extension's CID when the
Keep Trunk CID
extension has CID configured. The default setting is "No".
Disable This Trunk If selected, the trunk will be disabled.
Configure the Caller ID. This is the number that the trunk will try to use when
making outbound calls. For some providers, it might not be possible to set the
CallerID with this option and this option will be ignored.
Important Note: When making outgoing calls, the following priority order rule will
Caller ID
be used to determine which CallerID will be set before sending out the call :
CID from inbound call (Keep Original CID Enabled) Trunk Username/CallerID
(Keep Trunk CID Enabled) DOD Extension CallerID Number Trunk
Username/CallerID (Keep Trunk CID Disabled) Global Outbound CID..
Configure the name of the caller to be displayed when the extension has no
CallerID Name
CallerID Name configured.
Advanced Settings
Select audio and video codec for the VoIP trunk. The available codecs are: PCMU,
Codec Preference PCMA, GSM, AAL2-G.726-32, G.726, G.722, G.729, G.723, iLBC, ADPCM,
H.264, H.265, H.263, H.263p and VP8.
Enable Heartbeat If enabled, the UCM630X will regularly send SIP OPTIONS to the device to check
Detection if the device is still online. The default setting is "No".
When "Enable Heartbeat Detection" option is set to "Yes", configure the interval
Heartbeat Frequency (in seconds) of the SIP OPTIONS message sent to the device to check if the device
is still online. The default setting is 60 seconds.
P a g e | 197
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Maximum Number of The maximum number of concurrent calls using the trunk. The default settings 0,
Call Lines which means no limited.
Trunk Groups
Users can create VoIP Trunk Groups to register and easily apply the same settings on multiple accounts within
the same SIP server. This can drastically reduce the amount of time needed to manage accounts for the same
server and improve the overall cleanliness of the web UI.
Once creating the new trunk group and configuring the SIP settings, users can add multiple accounts within the
configured SIP server by pressing button and configuring the username, password, and authentication ID
fields.
P a g e | 198
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 99: Trunk Group Configuration
The UCM630X provides Direct Outward Dialing (DOD) which is a service of a local phone company (or local
exchange carrier) that allows subscribers within a company's PBX system to connect to outside lines directly.
P a g e | 199
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
2. Click to access the DOD options for the selected SIP Trunk.
4. For "DOD Number" enter one of the numbers (DIDs) from your SIP trunk provider. In the example above
Company ABC received 4 DIDs from their provider. ABC will enter in the number for the CEO's direct line.
5. Set the DOD name and If extension number need to be appended to the DID number click on “Add
Extension”.
6. Select an extension from the "Available Extensions" list. Users have the option of selecting more than one
extension. In this case, Company ABC would select the CEO's extension. After making the selection, click
on the button to move the extension(s) to the "Selected Extensions" list.
Once completed, the user will return to the EDIT DOD page that shows all the extensions that are associated to
a particular DOD.
P a g e | 200
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SLA STATION
The UCM630X supports SLA that allows mapping the key with LED on a multi-line phone to different external
lines. When there is an incoming call and the phone starts to ring, the LED on the key will flash in red and the
call can be picked up by pressing this key. This allows users to know if the line is occupied or not. The SLA
function on the UCM630X is like BLF but SLA is used to monitor external line i.e., analog trunk on the UCM630X.
Users could configure the phone with BLF mode on the MPK to monitor the analog trunk status or press the line
key pick up call from the analog trunk on the UCM630X.
Click on to edit the SLA Station. The following table shows the SLA Station configuration parameters.
P a g e | 201
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the time (in seconds) for delay before ringing the station when a call
Ring Delay first coming in on the shared line. No delay is set by default. If set to 0, there will
be no delay.
This option defines the competence of the hold action for one particular trunk. If
set to “open”, any station could hold a call on that trunk or resume one held
Hold Access
session; if set to “private”, only the station that places the trunk call on hold could
resume the session. The default setting is “open”.
Sample Configuration
1. On the UCM630X, go to Web GUIExtension/TrunkAnalog Trunks page. Create analog trunk or edit
the existing analog trunk. Make sure “SLA Mode” is enabled for the analog trunk. Once enabled, this analog
trunk will be only available for the SLA stations created under Web GUIExtension/TrunkSLA Station
page.
2. Click on “Save”. The analog trunk will be listed with trunk mode “SLA”.
3. On the UCM630X, go to Web GUIExtension/TrunkSLA Station page, click on “Add”. Please refer to
section [Create/Edit SLA Station] for the configuration parameters. Users can create one or more SLA
stations to monitor the analog trunk. The following figure shows two stations, 1002 and 1005, are configured
to be associated with SLA trunk “fxo1”.
P a g e | 202
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
4. On the SIP phone 1, configure to register UCM630X extension 1002. Configure the MPK as BLF mode and
the value must be set to “extension_trunkname”, which is 1002_fxo1 in this case.
5. On the SIP phone 2, configure to register UCM630X extension 1005. Configure the MPK as BLF mode and
value must be set to “extension_trunkname”, which is 1005_fxo1 in this case.
Now the SLA station is ready to use. The following functions can be achieved by this configuration.
P a g e | 203
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CALL ROUTES
Outbound Routes
In the following sections, we will discuss the steps and parameters used to configure and manage outbound
rules in UCM630X, these rules are the regulating points for all external outgoing calls initiated by the UCM through
all types of trunks: SIP, Analog and Digital.
In the UCM630X, an outgoing calling rule pairs an extension pattern with a trunk used to dial the pattern. This
allows different patterns to be dialed through different trunks (e.g., "Local" 7-digit dials through an FXO while
"Long distance" 10-digit dials through a low-cost SIP trunk). Users can also set up a failover trunk to be used
when the primary trunk fails.
On the UCM630X, the outbound route priority is based on “Best matching pattern”. For example, the UCM630X
has outbound route A with pattern 1xxx and outbound route B with pattern 10xx configured. When dialing 1000
for outbound call, outbound route B will always be used first. This is because pattern 10xx is a better match than
pattern 1xxx. Only when there are multiple outbound routes with the same pattern configured.
Configure the name of the calling rule (e.g., local, long_distance, and etc.). Letters,
Outbound Rule Name
digits, _ and - are allowed.
All patterns are prefixed by "_" character, but please do not enter more than one
"_" at the beginning. All patterns can add comments, such as "_pattern /* comment
*/". In patterns, some characters have special meanings:
[12345-9] ... Any digit in the brackets. In this example, 1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9 is
allowed.
Pattern N ... Any digit from 2-9.
. ... Wildcard, matching one or more characters.
! ... Wildcard, matching zero or more characters immediately.
X ... Any digit from 0-9.
Z ... Any digit from 1-9.
- ... Hyphen is to connect characters and it will be ignored.
P a g e | 204
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
[] Contain special characters ([x], [n], [z]) represent letters x, n, z.
After creating the outbound route, users can choose to enable and disable it. If the
Disable This Route route is disabled, it will not take effect anymore. However, the route settings will
remain in UCM. Users can enable it again when it is needed.
Password Configure the password for users to use this rule when making outbound calls.
If your local country code is affected by the outbound blacklist, please enter it here
Local Country Code
to bypass the blacklist.
Call Duration Limit Enable to configure the maximum duration for the call using this outbound route.
Maximum Call Configure the maximum duration of the call (in seconds). The default setting is 0,
Duration which means no limit.
Configure the warning time for the call using this outbound route. If set to x
Warning Time seconds, the warning tone will be played to the caller when x seconds are left to
end the call.
Auto Record If enabled, calls using this route will automatically be recorded.
Configure the warning repeat interval for the call using this outbound route. If set
Warning Repeat
to X seconds, the warning tone will be played every x seconds after the first
Interval
warning.
PIN Groups Select a PIN Group
PIN Groups with If enabled and PIN Groups are used, Privilege Levels and Filter on Source Caller
Privilege Level ID will also be applied.
Internal: The lowest level required. All users can use this rule.
Local: Users with Local, National, or International level can use this rule.
National: Users with National or International level can use this rule.
International: The highest level required. Only users with international level
Privilege Level
can use this rule.
Disable: The default setting is "Disable". If selected, only the matched source
caller ID will be allowed to use this outbound route.
Please be aware of the potential security risks when using "Internal" level, which
means all users can use this outbound rule to dial out from the trunk.
When enabled, users could specify extensions allowed to use this outbound route.
"Privilege Level" is automatically disabled if using "Enable Filter on Source Caller
Enable Filter on ID".
Source Caller ID
The following two methods can be used at the same time to define the
extensions as the source caller ID.
P a g e | 205
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
1. Select available extensions/extension groups from the list. This allows users
to specify arbitrary single extensions available in the PBX.
2. Custom Dynamic Route: define the pattern for the source caller ID. This
allows users to define extension range instead of selecting them one by one.
Strip Example:
The users will dial 9 as the first digit of a long-distance calls. However, 9 should
not be sent out via analog lines and the PSTN line. In this case, 1 digit should be
stripped before the call is placed.
Specify the digits to be prepended before the call is placed via the trunk. Those
Prepend
digits will be prepended after the dialing number is stripped.
Use Failover Trunk
Failover trunks can be used to make sure that a call goes through an alternate
route when the primary trunk is busy or down. If "Use Failover Trunk" is enabled
and "Failover trunk" is defined, the calls that cannot be placed via the regular trunk
may have a secondary trunk to go through.
Failover Trunk UCM630X support up to 10 failover trunks.
Example:
The user's primary trunk is a VoIP trunk and the user would like to use the PSTN
when the VoIP trunk is not available. The PSTN trunk can be configured as the
failover trunk of the VoIP trunk.
P a g e | 206
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Allows the user to specify the number of digits that will be stripped from the
beginning of the dialed string before the call is placed via the selected trunk.
Strip Example:
The users will dial 9 as the first digit of a long-distance calls. However, 9 should
not be sent out via analog lines and the PSTN line. In this case, 1 digit should be
stripped before the call is placed.
Specify the digits to be prepended before the call is placed via the trunk. Those
Prepend
digits will be prepended after the dialing number is stripped.
Time Condition
Use Main Trunk or Failover Trunk: Use the Main Trunk and its settings during the
configured time conditions. If the main trunk is unavailable, the Failover Trunk and
its settings will be used instead.
Time Condition Mode
Use Specific Trunks: Use specific trunks during the configured time conditions.
The Strip and Prepend settings of the Main Trunk will be used. If a trunk is
unavailable during its time condition, no failover trunks will be used.
Outbound Blacklist
The UCM630X allows users to configure blacklist for outbound routes. If the dialing number matches the blacklist
numbers or patterns, the outbound call will not be allowed. The outbound blacklist can be configured under UCM
Web GUIExtension/TrunkOutbound Routes: Outbound Blacklist.
Users can configure numbers, patterns or select country code to add in the blacklist. Please note that the blacklist
settings apply to all outbound routes.
P a g e | 207
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 107: Country Codes
Note: Users can export outbound route blacklists and delete all blacklist entries. Additionally, users can also
import blacklists for outbound routes.
P a g e | 208
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Scheduled Sync
The UCM630X allows users to synchronize the outbound routes, this feature can be found on the
WebGUIExtension/TrunkOutbound Routes Scheduled Sync.
Server Address Enter the TFTP server address. For example, "192.168.1.2:69".
Sync Time Enter the sync time (24hr format). Valid range is 0-23.
Sync Frequency Create new sync every x day(s). The valid range is 1 to 30.
PIN Groups
The UCM630X supports pin group. Once this feature is configured, users can apply pin group to specific
outbound routes. When placing a call on pin protected outbound routes, caller will be asked to input the group
pin number, this feature can be found on the WebGUIExtension/TrunkOutbound RoutesPIN Groups.
PIN Number Specify the code that will asked once dialing via a trunk
Once user click on the following figure shows to configure the new PIN.
P a g e | 209
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 109: Create New PIN Group
The following screenshot shows an example of created PIN Groups and members:
Note:
If PIN group is enabled on outbound route level, password, privilege level and enable filter on source caller ID
will be disabled, unless if you check the option “PIN Groups with Privilege Level” where you can use the PIN
Groups and Privilege Level or PIN Groups and Enable Filter on Source Caller ID.
P a g e | 210
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If PIN group CDR is enabled, the call with PIN group information will be displayed as part of CDR under Account
Code field.
User can also import PIN Groups by uploading CSV files for each group. To do this:
1. Navigate to Extension/TrunkOutbound RoutesPIN Groups and click on the “Upload” button.
2. Select the CSV file to upload. Incorrect file formats and improperly formatted CSV files will result in
error messages such as the one below:
3. To ensure a successful import, please follow the format in the sample image below
P a g e | 211
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 115: CSV File Format
The top-left value (A1) is the PIN Group name. In this case, it is “ALPHA”.
Row 2 contains the labels for the modifiable fields: pin and pin_name. These values should not
be changed and will cause an upload error otherwise.
Rows 3+ contain the user-defined values with Column A holding the PINs and Column B
holding the PIN names. PIN values must consist of at least four digits.
Once the file is successfully uploaded, the entry will be added to the list of PIN Groups.
Inbound Routes
P a g e | 212
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Inbound Rule Configurations
Note:
Multiple patterns can be used. Each pattern should be entered in new
line.
Users can add comments to the end of patterns to better organize and
keep track of complex rules by typing “/*” and “*/” before and after
each comment respectively
Example:
Pattern CallerID Pattern
_X. 1000
_ NNXXNXXXXX /* 10-digit long distance */ 1001
After creating the inbound route, users can choose to enable and disable it. If
Disable This Route the route is disabled, it will not take effect anymore. However, the route
settings will remain in UCM. Users can enable it again when it is needed.
Allows the selected extension to use this function. If an extension is busy, and
Seamless Transfer Whitelist a mobile phone is bound to that extension, the mobile phone can pick up calls
to that extension.
Ringback tone Choose the custom ring back tone to play when caller reaches the route.
P a g e | 213
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Auto Record If enabled, calls using this route will automatically be recorded.
If enabled, collect calls will be blocked.
Note: Collect calls are indicated by the header "P-Asserted-Service-Info:
Block Collect Call
service-code=Backward Collect Call, P-Asserted-Service-Info: service-
code=Collect Call".
Configure the Alert-Info, when UCM receives an INVITE request, the Alert-
Alert-Info
Info header field specifies an alternative ring tone to the UAS.
Fax Detection If enabled, fax signals from the trunk during a call will be detected.
P a g e | 214
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
n${CALLERID(num)}: Prepends n to a CID number, where n is a
number.
Default string is ${CALLERID(name)},which means the name of an
incoming caller, it is a pattern-matching syntax format.
A${CALLERID(name)}B means Prepend a character 'A' and suffix a
CallerID Name
character 'B' to ${CALLERID(name)}.
Not using pattern-matching syntax means setting fix name to incoming caller.
Gives uses the ability to configure inbound mode per individual route. When
enabled two field will show allowing to set the Inbound mode and the Inbound
Enable Route-Level Inbound
mode Suffix.
Mode
Note: Global inbound mode must be enabled before users can configure
route-level inbound mode
Choose the inbound mode for this route.
Note: Toggling the global inbound mode will not affect routes that have Route-
Inbound Mode level Inbound Mode enabled. If all routes have the option enabled, toggling
the global inbound mode via BLF will trigger a voice prompt indicating that
none of the routes will be affected by the global inbound mode change.
Dial "Global Inbound Mode feature code + Inbound Mode Suffix" or a route's
assigned suffix to toggle the route's inbound mode.
Inbound Mode Suffix
The BLF subscribed to the inbound mode suffix can monitor the current
inbound mode.
Multiple mode allows user to switch between destinations of the inbound rule
by feature codes. Configure related feature codes as described in [Inbound
Inbound Multiple Mode
Route: Multiple Mode]. If this option is enabled, user can use feature code
to switch between different modes/destinations.
This option shows up only when "By DID" is selected. If enabled, the external
Dial Trunk users dialing in to the trunk via this inbound route can dial outbound call using
the UCM’s trunk.
This option shows up only when "By DID" is selected.
Disable: Only the selected Extensions or Extension Groups are
allowed to use this rule, when enabled Filter on Source Caller ID.
Privilege Level Internal: The lowest level required. All users are allowed to use this
rule, check this level might be risky for security purpose.
P a g e | 215
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
National: Users with National or International Level are allowed to
use this rule.
P a g e | 216
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Specify the digits to be prepended before the call is placed via the trunk.
Prepend
Those digits will be prepended after the dialing number is stripped.
Time Condition
Start Time Select the start time "hour:minute" for the trunk to use the inbound rule.
End Time Select the end time "hour:minute" for the trunk to use the inbound rule.
Select "By Week" or "By Day" and specify the date for the trunk to use the
Date
inbound rule.
Week Select the day in the week to use the inbound rule.
Select the destination for the inbound call under the defined time condition.
Extension
Voicemail
Conference Room
Call Queue
Ring Group
Paging/Intercom
Voicemail Group
DISA
IVR
Destination
By DID
When "By DID" is used, the UCM will look for the destination based on
the number dialed, which could be local extensions, conference, call
queue, ring group, paging/intercom group, IVR and voicemail groups as
configured in "DID destination". If the dialed number matches the DID
pattern, the call will be allowed to go through.
Configure the number of digits to be stripped in "Strip" option.
Dial By Name
External Number
Callback
UCM630X now allows user to prepend digits to an inbound DID pattern, with strip taking precedence over
prepend. With the ability to prepend digits in inbound route DID pattern, user no longer needs to create multiple
routes for the same trunk to route calls to different extensions. The following example demonstrates the process:
P a g e | 217
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
3. If Prepend is set to 2, UCM630X will then prepend a 2 to the stripped number, now the number become
2163.
4. UCM630X will now forward the incoming call to extension 2163.
In the UCM630X, the user can configure inbound route to enable multiple mode to switch between different
destinations. The inbound multiple mode can be enabled under Inbound Route settings.
P a g e | 218
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 118: Inbound Route - Multiple Mode
When Multiple Mode is enabled for the inbound route, the user can configure a “Default Destination” and a “Mode
1” destination for all routes. By default, the call coming into the inbound routes will be routed to the default
destination.
SIP end devices that have registered on the UCM630X can dial feature code *62 to switch to inbound route
“Mode 1” and dial feature code *61 to switch back to “Default Destination”. Switching between different mode
can be easily done without Web GUI login.
For example, the customer service hotline destination has to be set to a different IVR after 7PM. The user can
dial *62 to switch to “Mode 1” with that IVR set as the destination before off work.
To customize feature codes for “Default Mode” and “Mode 1”, click on under
“Inbound Routes” page, check “Enable Inbound Multiple Mode” option and change “Inbound Default Mode” and
“Inbound Mode 1” values (By default, *61 and *62 respectively).
P a g e | 219
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 119: Inbound Route - Multiple Mode Feature Codes
In the UCM630X, users can enable Route-Level Inbound Mode to switch between different destinations for each
individual inbound route. The inbound Route-Level mode can be enabled under Inbound Route settings.
Global inbound mode must be enabled before configuring Route-Level Inbound Mode. Additionally, the Mode 1
must be configured as well.
When Route-Level Inbound Mode is enabled, the user can configure a “Default Destination” and a “Mode 1”
destination for each specific route. By default, the call coming into this specific inbound route will be routed to
the default destination.
P a g e | 220
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Users can toggle the route’s inbound mode by dialing "Global Inbound Mode feature code + Inbound Mode
Suffix” and the current inbound route can be monitored by subscribing a BLF to the Inbound Mode Suffix.
For example, Inbound Default Mode feature code is set to *61 and the Inbound Mode suffix for route 1 is set to
1010. To switch the mode of route 1 to Default Mode, users can dial *611010.
Note: Toggling the global inbound mode will not affect routes that have Route-level Inbound Mode enabled. If
all routes have the option enabled, toggling the global inbound mode via BLF will trigger a voice prompt indicating
that none of the routes will be affected by the global inbound mode change.
Users can assign MPKs and VPKs to monitor and toggle the current global inbound mode of the UCM.
To do this, please refer to the following steps:
4. Configure the BLF value on a phone’s MPK/VPK. As an example, a GXP2140 with the BLF configured
will show the Inbound Mode status on its screen once configured. The 777 BLF is lit green, indicating
that the current inbound mode is “Default Mode”.
P a g e | 221
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 122: Inbound Mode - Default Mode
5. Pressing the key will toggle the inbound mode to “Mode 1”, and the button’s color will change to red.
Users can now import and export inbound routes to quickly set up inbound routing on a UCM or to back up an
existing configuration. An exported inbound route configuration can be directly imported without needing any
manual modifications.
The imported file should be on CSV format and using UTF-8 encoding, the imported file should contain below
columns, and each column should be separated by a comma (It is recommended to use Notepad++ for the
imported file creation):
Disable This Route: Yes/No.
Pattern: Always prefixed with _
CallerID Pattern: Always prefixed with _
Prepend Trunk Name: Yes/No.
P a g e | 222
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Prepend User Defined Name Enable: Yes/No.
Prepend User Defined Name: A string.
Alert-info: None, Ring 1, Ring 2… User should enter an Alert-info string following the values we have in
the Inbound route Alert-Info list.
Allowed to seamless transfer: [Extension_number]
Inbound Multiple Mode: Yes/No.
Default Destination: By DID, Extension, Voicemail… User should enter a Default Destination string
following the values we have in the Inbound route Default Destination list.
Destination: An Extension number, Ring Group Extension…
Default Time Condition.
Mode 1: By DID, Extension, Voicemail… User should enter a Default Destination string following the
values we have in the mode 1 Default Destination list.
Mode 1 Destination: An Extension number, Ring Group Extension…
Mode 1 Time Condition.
The UCM630X supports Fax re-INVITE with multiple codec negotiation. If a Fax re-INVITE contains both T.38
and PCMA/PCMU codec, UCM630X will choose T.38 codec over PCMA/PCMU.
Blacklist Configurations
In the UCM630X, Blacklist is supported for all inbound routes. Users could enable the Blacklist feature and
manage the Blacklist by clicking on "Blacklist".
Select the checkbox for "Blacklist Enable" to turn on Blacklist feature for all inbound routes. Blacklist is
disabled by default.
Enter a number in "Add Blacklist Number" field and then click ”Add” to add to the list. Anonymous can also
be added as a Blacklist Number by typing “Anonymous” in Add Blacklist Number field.
To remove a number from the Blacklist, select the number in "Blacklist list" and click on or click on
”Clear” button to remove all the numbers on the blacklist.
User can also export the inbound route blacklist by pressing on button.
P a g e | 223
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 125: Blacklist Configuration Parameters
To add blacklist number in batch, click on “Import” to upload blacklist file in csv format. The supported csv
format is as below.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
Users could also add a number to the Blacklist or remove a number from the Blacklist by dialing the feature code
for "Blacklist Add' (default: *40) and "Blacklist Remove" (default: *41) from an extension. The feature code can
be configured under Web GUICall FeaturesFeature Codes.
P a g e | 224
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
FAX SERVER
The UCM6300 series supports T.30/T.38 Fax and Fax Pass-through. It can convert the received Fax to PDF
format and send it to the configured Email address. Fax/T.38 settings can be accessed via Web GUICall
FeaturesFAX/T.38. The list of received Fax files will be displayed in the same web page for users to view,
retrieve and delete.
Configure Fax/T.38
Click on "Create New Fax Extension". In the popped-up window, fill the extension, name and Email address
to send the received Fax to.
Click on "Fax Settings" to configure the Fax parameters.
P a g e | 225
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 68: FAX/T.38 Settings
Enable Error Configure to enable Error Correction Mode (ECM) for the Fax.
Correction Mode The default setting is "Yes".
Configure the maximum transfer rate during the Fax rate negotiation.
Maximum Transfer
The possible values are 2400, 4800, 7200, 9600, 12000 and 14400.
Rate
The default setting is 14400.
Configure the minimum transfer rate during the Fax rate negotiation. The
Minimum Transfer Rate possible values are 2400, 4800, 7200, 9600, 12000 and 14000. The default
setting is 2400.
Configure the concurrent fax that can be sent by UCM6300. Two modes “Only”
and “More” are supported.
Only
Max Concurrent Under this mode, the UCM6300 allows only single user to send fax at a time.
User Information in Fax If enabled this this will give users the option to send a special header in SIP fax
Header messages.
Fax Header Information Adds fax header into the fax file.
Configure the Email address to send the received Fax to if user's Email address
cannot be found.
Note:
Default Email Address
The extension's Email address or the Fax's default Email address needs to be
configured in order to receive Fax from Email. If neither of them is configured,
Fax will not be received from Email.
Fill in the "Subject:" and "Message:" content, to be used in the Email when
sending the Fax to the users.
Template Variables
The template variables are:
P a g e | 226
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
${CALLERIDNUM} : Caller ID Number
${CALLERIDNAME} : Caller ID Name
${RECEIVEEXTEN} : The extension to receive the Fax
${FAXPAGES} : Number of pages in the Fax
${VM_DATE} : The date and time when the Fax is received
If enabled, fax emails will no longer attach TIFF files. Only PDF files will be
Send PDF Files Only
attached.
Enables the fax resend option which allow the UCM to keep attempting to send
faxes up to a specified amount of times. Additionally, if a fax still fails to send, a
Enable Fax Resend
Resend button will appear in the File Send Progress list in Value-Added
FeaturesFax Sending to allow manual resending.
Receiving Fax
The following instructions describe how to use the UCM6300 to receive fax from PSTN line on the Fax machine
connected to the UCM6300 FXS port.
P a g e | 227
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 128: Configure Analog Trunk
P a g e | 228
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 130: Configure Extension for Fax Machine: Analog Settings
Now the Fax configuration is done. When there is an incoming Fax calling to the PSTN number for the FXO port,
it will send the Fax to the Fax machine.
P a g e | 229
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Example Configuration for Fax-To-Email
The following instructions describe a sample configuration on how to use Fax-to-Email feature on the UCM6300.
3. Go to UCM6300 Web GUIExtension/TrunkAnalog Trunks page. Create a new analog trunk. Please
make sure "Fax Detection" is set to "No".
4. Go to UCM6300 Web GUIExtension/TrunkInbound Routes page. Create a new inbound route and
set the default destination to the Fax extension.
P a g e | 230
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 133: Inbound Route to Fax Extension
5. Once successfully configured, the incoming Fax from external Fax machine to the PSTN line number will be
converted to PDF+Tiff file and sent to the extension 7200 and email address [email protected] as
attachment.
Note: In order for the file to be sent to the email address configured on the external extension, please make sure
that the email settings are well configured. Please refer to [Email Settings] section.
P a g e | 231
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
FAX Sending
Besides the support of Fax machines, The UCM6300 supports also sending Fax via Web GUI access. This
feature can be found on Web GUIValue-added FeaturesFax Sending page. To send fax, pre-setup for
analog trunk and outbound route is required. Please refer to [ANALOG TRUNKS], [VOIP TRUNKS] and [Outbound
Routes] sections for configuring analog trunk and outbound route.
After making sure analog trunk or VoIP Trunk is setup properly and UCM6300 can reach out to PSTN numbers
via the trunk, on Fax Sending page, enter the fax number and upload the file to be faxed. Then click on “Send”
to start. The progress of sending fax will be displayed in Web GUI. Users can also view the sending history is in
the same web page.
After that you can see the ongoing sending operation on the progress bar.
Note: Only A3, A4, and B4 paper sizes are supported for the Fax Sending.
P a g e | 232
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
AUDIO CONFERENCE
The UCM630X supports conference room allowing multiple rooms used at the same time.
The conference room configurations can be accessed under Web GUICall FeaturesAudio Conference. In
this page, users could create, edit, view, invite, manage the participants, and delete conference rooms. The
conference room status and conference call recordings (if recording is enabled) will be displayed in this web
page as well.
The UCM admin can create multiple audio conference rooms for users to dial in.
UCM6301 3 75
UCM6302 8 150
UCM6304 15 200
UCM6308 25 300
Configure the conference number for the users to dial into the conference.
Extension
Note: Up to 64 characters.
Privilege Please select the permission level for outgoing calls.
When configured, the users who would like to join the conference call must enter
Password this password before accessing the conference room.
Note: The password must be at least 4 characters.
Configure the password to join the conference room as Moderator. Conference
Moderator can manage the conference call via IVR (if "Enable Caller Menu" is
Host Password enabled) as well as invite other parties to join the conference by dialing "0"
(permission required from the invited party) or "1" (permission not required from
the invited party) during the conference call.
P a g e | 233
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Note: If the Moderator Password field is left blank, moderator functionality will not
be available for the meeting.
If enabled, conference participant could press the * key to access the conference
Enable Caller Menu
room menu. The default setting is "No".
If enabled, the calls in this conference room will be recorded automatically in a
Record Conference .wav format file. All the recording files will be displayed and can be downloaded in
the conference web page. The default setting is "No".
If there is only one participant in a conference room, a kick warning prompt will
Kicking Warning play at the configured interval. If no input from the participant is received after the
Interval prompt, he will be automatically kicked out of the conference. The valid range is
1-60 minutes.
If enabled, the participants will not hear each other until the host joins the
conference. The default setting is "No".
Wait For Moderator Note:
If "Quiet Mode" is enabled, the voice prompt for "Wait For Admin" will not be
announced.
If enabled, users could press 0 to invite other users (with the users' permission) or
press 1 to invite other users (without the user's permission) to join the conference.
The default setting is "No".
Allow User Invite
Note:
Conference administrator can always invite other users without enabling this
option.
If enabled, the caller will be announced to all conference participants when there
the caller joins the conference. The default setting is "No".
Announce Callers
Note:
"Quiet Mode" and "Announce Callers" cannot be enabled at the same time.
If enabled, if there are users joining or leaving the conference, voice prompt or
notification tone will not be played. The default setting is "No".
Quiet Mode
Note:
"Quiet Mode" and "Announce Callers" cannot be enabled at the same time.
If enabled, the UCM630X will play Hold music when there is only one user in the
Play Hold Music
conference. The default setting is "No".
Custom Music On Select the music on hold class to be played in conference call. Music On Hold
Hold class can be set up under Web GUIPBX SettingsMusic On Hold.
P a g e | 234
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If enabled, the invitation from Web GUI for a conference room with password will
Skip Authentication
skip the authentication for the invited users. The default setting is "No".
Enable Talk detection If enabled, the AMI will send the corresponding event when a user
starts or ends talking.
DSP Talking Threshold The time in milliseconds of sound above what the dsp has
established as base line silence for a user before a user is
considered to be talking. This value affects several operations and
should not be changed unless the impact on call quality is fully
understood, the default value is 200.
DSP Silence Threshold The time in milliseconds of sound falling within the what the dsp
has established as base line silence before a user is considered
to be silent. This value affects several operations and should not
be changed unless the impact on call quality is fully understood,
the default value is 2500.
Users can check the talking Caller IDs in conference control page (UCM WebUICall FeaturesConference).
The image will move up and down when the user is talking.
P a g e | 235
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Conference Call Operations
Users could dial the conference room extension to join the conference. If password is required, enter the
password to join the conference as a normal user, or enter the admin password to join the conference as
administrator.
When using the UCM630X conference room., there are two ways to invite other parties to join the conference.
For each conference room in UCM630X Web GUICall FeaturesConference, there is an icon for
option "Invite a participant". Click on it and enter the number of the party you would like to invite. Then click on
"Add". A call will be sent to this number to join it into the conference.
A conference participant can invite other parties to the conference by dialing from the phone during the
conference call. Please make sure option "Enable User Invite" is turned on for the conference room first. Enter
0 or 1 during the conference call. Follow the voice prompt to input the number of the party you would like to
invite. A call will be sent to this number to join it into the conference.
0: If 0 is entered to invite other party, once the invited party picks up the invitation call, a permission will be asked
to "accept" or "reject" the invitation before joining the conference.
1: If 1 is entered to invite other party, no permission will be required from the invited party.
P a g e | 236
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
Conference administrator can always invite other parties from the phone during the call by entering 0 or 1. To
join a conference room as administrator, enter the admin password when joining the conference. A conference
room can have multiple administrators.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
During the conference call, users can manage the conference from Web GUI or IVR.
Log in UCM630X Web GUI during the conference call, the participants in each conference room will be
listed.
3. Click on to lock this conference room so that other users cannot join it anymore.
If "Enable Caller Menu" is enabled, conference participant can input * to enter the IVR menu for the conference.
Please see options listed in the table below.
P a g e | 237
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
6 Increase the volume of the conference call.
7 Increase your volume.
More options.
1: List all users currently in the conference call.
2: Kick all non-Administrator participants from the conference call.
8
3: Mute/Unmute all non-Administrator participants from the conference call.
4: Record the conference call.
8: Exit the caller menu and return to the conference.
Conference User IVR Menu
1 Mute/unmute yourself.
4 Decrease the volume of the conference call.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
When there is participant in the conference, the conference room configuration cannot be modified.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
UCM630X now supports Google OAuth 2.0 authentication. This feature is used for supporting UCM630X
conference scheduling system. Once OAuth 2.0 is enabled, UCM630X conference system can access Google
calendar to schedule or update conference.
Google Service Settings can be found under Web GUICall FeaturesConferenceGoogle Service
SettingsGoogle Service Settings.
P a g e | 238
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 139: Google Service SettingsOAuth2.0 Authentication
If you already have OAuth2.0 project set up on Google Developers web page, please use your existing login
credential for “OAuth2.0 Client ID” and “OAuth2.0 Client Secret” in the above figure for the UCM630X to access
Google Service.
If you do not have OAuth2.0 project set up yet, please following the steps below to create new project and obtain
credentials:
P a g e | 239
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
3. Click “Credentials” on the left drop down menu to create new OAuth2.0 login credentials.
4. Use the newly created login credential to fill in “OAuth2.0 Client ID” and “OAuth2.0 Client Secret”.
5. Click “Get Authentication Code” to obtain authentication code from Google Service.
You can also configure the Status update, which automatically refresh your Google Calendar with the configured
time (m). Note: Zero means disable.
P a g e | 240
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Conference Schedule
Conference Schedule can be found under UCM630X Web GUI Call Features Audio Conference
Conference Schedule. Users can create, edit, view, and delete a Conference Schedule.
After the user configures UCM630X with Google Service Settings [Google Service Settings Support] and
enables Google Calendar for Conference Schedule, the conference schedule on the UCM630X can be
synchronized with Google Calendar for authorized Google account.
Schedule Options
Configure the name of the scheduled conference. Letters, digits, Other special
Conference Subject
characters are also supported. such as #%&@*=
P a g e | 241
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Conference Room Options
If this option is enabled, conference call will be recorded in .wav format. The
Record Conference
recorded file can be found from Conference page.
If this option is enabled, the notification tone or voice prompt for joining or leaving
the conference will not be played.
Quiet Mode Note:
Option “Quiet Mode” and option “Announce Caller” cannot be enabled at the same
time.
If this option is enabled, the user can:
Press ‘0’ to invite others to join the conference with invited party’s
permission
Press ‘1’ to invite without invited party’s permission
Allow User Invite
Press ‘2’ to create a multi-conference room to another conference room
Press ‘3’ to drop all current multi-conference rooms.
Note:
Conference Administrator is always allowed to access this menu.
If this option is enabled, UCM630X will play Hold Music while there is only one
Play Hold Music
participant in the conference room, or the conference is not yet started.
Custom Music On
Custom Music On Hold.
Hold
If this option is enabled, the invitation from Web GUI via a trunk with password will
not require authentication.
Skip Authentication
Note:
Please be aware of the potential security risks when turning on this option.
Once the Conference Schedule is configured, scheduled conference will be displayed as below figure.
P a g e | 242
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 143: Conference Schedule
Once the conference room is scheduled, at the scheduled conference time, UCM630X will send INVITE to the
extensions that have been selected for conference.
Once the conference starts, it will be displayed under Unstarted Meeting with an “Ongoing” status, as displayed
below.
Once the conference is finished, the conference will be displayed under Historical meeting as below:
P a g e | 243
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 145: Conference Schedule-Completed
In addition, once the meeting ends, the system will send a meeting report email to the host including PDF file
where he/she can view the meeting, participant information, device type and trend graph of participant levels.
Note: Please make sure that outbound route is properly configured for remote extensions to join the conference.
Contact Group
The UCM630X allows users to define a group of contacts and attribute it to a conference room. When a designed
extension calls the conference room, the UCM will make a call to all the other numbers on the contact groups to
join the conference.
P a g e | 244
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Conference Recordings
The UCM630X allows users to record the conference call and retrieve the recording from Web GUICall
Features Audio ConferenceConference Recordings.
To record the conference call, when the conference room is in idle, enable "Record Conference" from the
conference room configuration dialog. Save the setting and apply the change. When the conference call starts,
the call will be automatically recorded in .wav format.
The recording files will be listed as below once available. Users could click on to download the recording or
click on to delete the recording. Users could also delete all recording files by clicking on “Delate All
Recording Files” or delete multiple recording files at once by clicking on “Delete” after selecting the recording
files.
Conference reports will now be generated after every conference. These reports can be exported to a .CSV file
for offline viewing. The conference report page can be accessed by clicking on the Call Statistics button on the
main Conference page.
P a g e | 245
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 149: Conference Report on Web
P a g e | 246
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
VIDEO CONFERENCE
With the UCM you can easily create, schedule, manage, and join video conference calls, from your desktop or
laptop computer. UCM Video conferencing uses WebRTC technology, so all the participants don’t have to
download and install any additional software or plugins. UCM Video Conferencing must be enabled by the
administrator for the concerned extensions. The video conference configurations can be accessed under Web
GUICall FeaturesVideo Conference. In this page, users could enable, set the Basic setting, create, edit,
view, manage, delete conference rooms, and edit the Conference Schedule.
Below are the UCM video conference specifications supported for each model:
UCM6301 4 20
UCM6302 6 30
UCM6304 8 60
UCM6308 10 80
Video Conference
Configure the conference number for the users to dial into the conference.
Extension
Note: Up to 64 characters.
When configured, the users who would like to join the conference call must
enter this password before accessing the conference room.
Note:
Password Only digits are allowed.
The password has to be at least 4 characters. All repetitive and
sequential digits (e.g., 0000, 1111, 1234 and 2345) or common digits
(e.g., 111222 and 321321) are not allowed.
P a g e | 247
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Host Password Configure the Host password.
Allow User Invite If enabled, participants can invite other users to the video conference.
Enable Talk detection If enabled, the AMI will send the corresponding event when a user
starts or ends talking.
DSP Talking Threshold The time in milliseconds of sound above what the dsp has established
as base line silence for a user before a user is considered to be talking.
This value affects several operations and should not be changed
unless the impact on call quality is fully understood, the default value
is 200.
DSP Silence Threshold The time in milliseconds of sound falling within the dsp has established
as base line silence before a user is considered to be silent. This value
affects several operations and should not be changed unless the
impact on call quality is fully understood, the default value is 2500.
Max Number of Video Feeds Set the maximum number of video feeds supported per conference
room.
Audio Codec Preference Configures the preferred codecs for temporary accounts such as
conference participants who joined via link.
Packet Loss Retransmission Packet Loss Retransmission configuration for temporary accounts
(conference participants without registered extensions who entered
the conference via link)
Jitter Buffer Select jitter buffer method for temporary accounts such as conference
participants who joined via link.
Disable: Jitter buffer will not be used.
Fixed: Jitter buffer with a fixed size (equal to the value of "Jitter Buffer
Size")
Adaptive: Jitter buffer with an adaptive size that will not exceed the
value of "Max Jitter Buffer").
NetEQ: Dynamic jitter buffer via NetEQ.
P a g e | 248
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Conference Schedule
Conference Schedule can be found under UCM Web GUI Call FeaturesVideo Conference Conference
Schedule. Users can create, edit, view, and delete a Conference Schedule.
Click on “Add” to add a new Conference Schedule.
Click on the scheduled conference to edit or delete the event.
Schedule Options
Set the beginning date and duration of this scheduled conference. Please
Time
be aware to avoid time conflicts in the same conference room.
Email reminders will be sent out x minutes prior to the start of the
Email Reminder (m) conference. Valid range is 5-1440. 60 is the default value. 0 indicates not
to send out email reminders for the conference.
Allow User Invite If enabled, participants can invite other users to the video conference.
Call Participants If enabled, invited participants will be called when the meeting starts.
Once created, at the scheduled conference time, UCM630X will send INVITE to the extensions that have been
selected for conference.
P a g e | 249
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 151: Video Conference Schedule
Once the conference starts, it will be displayed under Unstarted Meeting with an “Ongoing” status, as displayed
below.
Once the conference is finished, the conference will be displayed under Historical meeting as below:
P a g e | 250
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 153: Video Conference Scheduled-Completed
In addition, once the meeting ends, the system will send a meeting report email to the host including PDF file
where he/she can view the meeting, participant information, device type and trend graph of participant levels
Notes:
Video conferencing can be resource-intensive and may cause performance issues with the UCM when used.
To ensure the best experience, please use Google Chrome (v67 or higher) or Mozilla Firefox (v60).
Web audio and video calls and conferencing can now be achieved through the UCM’s new WebRTC page. To
get started with this new feature, please make sure to:
2. Enable the WebRTC on the extensions that would use this feature under Extension / Trunk
Extensions by editing the concerned extensions.
P a g e | 251
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 155: Enabling WebRTC on Extensions
The UCM offers the possibility to login to an extension via Grandstream Wave Portal using user portal password
in addition to SIP registration password, where it offers a sleek interface to host conferences, receive email
reminders for scheduled conferences, manage contacts, initiate calls, call transfer, chat functionality and more.
Access the page by entering the UCM’s server address and port which is 8090.
(e.g. https://my.ucm.com:8090).
For more details about the Wave Web, please refer to the following guides:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/GS_Wave_Web_administration_guide.pdf
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/GS_Wave_Web_user_guide.pdf
P a g e | 252
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Grandstream Wave is also available in Androind/IOS version where it can be downloaded from Google Play or
AppStorre. For more details, please refer to the following guide:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/GSWave_mobile_app_User_Guide.pdf
Desktop version is also supported in Windows and MacOS and can be downloaded from:
https://fw.gdms.cloud/wave/download/
P a g e | 253
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
IVR
Configure IVR
IVR configurations can be accessed under the UCM630X Web GUICall FeaturesIVR. Users could create,
edit, view, and delete an IVR.
P a g e | 254
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 76: IVR Configuration Parameters
Basic Settings
Name Configure the name of the IVR. Letters, digits, _ and - are allowed.
Extension Enter the extension number for users to access the IVR.
If enabled, all callers to the IVR can use trunk. The permission must be configured
Dial Trunk
for the users to use the trunk first. The default setting is "No".
Auto Record If enabled, calls to this IVR will automatically be recorded.
Assign permission level for outbound calls if "Dial Trunk" is enabled. The available
permissions are "Internal", "Local", "National" and "International" from the lowest
level to the highest level.
The default setting is "Internal". If the user tries to dial outbound calls after dialing
Permission
into the IVR, the UCM630X will compared the IVR's permission level with the
outbound route's privilege level.
If the IVR's permission level is higher than (or equal to) the outbound route's
privilege level, the call will be allowed to go through.
This controls the destination that can be reached by the external caller via the
inbound route. The available destinations are:
Extension
Conference
Dial Other Call Queue
Extensions Ring Group
Paging/Intercom Groups
Voicemail Groups
Dial by Name
All
IVR If enabled only numbers inside of the Whitelist or outside of the Blacklist can be
Black/Whitelist called from IVR.
Internal
Contain numbers, either of Blacklist or Whitelist.
Black/Whitelist
This feature can be used only when Dial Trunk is enabled, it contains external
External
numbers allowed or denied calling from the IVR, the allowed format is the following:
Black/Whitelist
Number1, number2, number3…
Replace Display
If enabled, the UCM will replace the caller display name with IVR name.
Name
Return to IVR If enabled and if a call to an extension fails, the caller will be redirected to the IVR
Menu menu.
When present in an INVITE request, the alert-Info header field specifies and
Alert Info
alternative ring tone to the UAS.
P a g e | 255
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Select an audio file to play as the welcome prompt for the IVR. Click on "Prompt"
Prompt to add additional audio file under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice
PromptCustom Prompt.
Configure the timeout between digit entries. After the user enters a digit, the user
Digit Timeout needs to enter the next digit within the timeout. If no digit is detected within the
timeout, the UCM630X will consider the entries complete. The default timeout is 3s.
After playing the prompts in the IVR, the UCM630X will wait for the DTMF entry
Response
within the timeout (in seconds). If no DTMF entry is detected within the timeout, a
Timeout
timeout prompt will be played. The default setting is 10 seconds.
Response
Select the prompt message to be played when timeout occurs.
Timeout Prompt
Invalid Input
Select the prompt message to be played when an invalid extension is pressed.
Prompt
Response Configure the number of times to repeat the prompt if no DTMF input is detected.
Timeout Prompt When the loop ends, it will go to the timeout destination if configured, or hang up.
Repeats The default setting is 3.
Configure the number of times to repeat the prompt if the DTMF input is invalid.
Invalid Input
When the loop ends, it will go to the invalid destination if configured, or hang up.
Prompt Repeats
The default setting is 3.
Select the voice prompt language to be used for this IVR. The default setting is
"Default" which is the selected voice prompt language under Web GUIPBX
SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings. The dropdown list shows all the
Language current available voice prompt languages on the UCM630X. To add more
languages in the list, please download voice prompt package by selecting "Check
Prompt List" under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptLanguage
Settings.
Key Pressing Events
Key Press Event: Select the event for each key pressing for 0-9, *, Timeout and Invalid. The event
Press 0 options are:
Press 1 Extension
Press 2 Voicemail
Press 3 Conference Rooms
Press 4 Voicemail Group
Press 5 IVR
Press 6 Ring Group
Press 7 Queues
Press 8 Page Group
Press 9 Custom Prompt
P a g e | 256
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Press * Hangup
DISA
Dial by Name
External Number
Callback
When exceeding the number of defined answer timeout, IVR will enter the
Timeout
configured event when timeout. If not configured, then it will Hangup.
Invalid Configure the destination when the Invalid Repeat Loop is done.
In some scenarios, the IPPBX administrator needs to restrict the extensions that can be reached from IVR.
For example, the company CEO and directors prefer only receiving calls transferred by the secretary, some
special extensions are used on IP surveillance end points which should not be reached from external calls via
P a g e | 257
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
IVR for privacy reason. UCM has now added blacklist and whitelist in IVR settings for users to manage this.
To use this feature, log in UCM Web GUI and navigate to Call FeaturesIVRCreate/Edit IVR: IVR
Black/Whitelist.
If the user selects “Blacklist Enable” and adds extension in the list, the extensions in the list will not be
allowed to be reached via IVR.
If the user selects “Whitelist Enable” and adds extension in the list, only the extensions in the list can be
allowed to be reached via IVR.
P a g e | 258
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 160: Black/Whitelist
To record new IVR prompt or upload IVR prompt to be used in IVR, click on “Upload Audio File” next to the
“Welcome Prompt” option and the users will be redirected to Custom Prompt page. Or users could go to Web
GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptCustom Prompt page directly.
P a g e | 259
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 161: Click on Prompt to Create IVR Prompt
Once the IVR prompt file is successfully added to the UCM630X, it will be added into the prompt list options for
users to select in different IVR scenarios.
P a g e | 260
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
LANGUAGE SETTINGS FOR VOICE PROMPT
The UCM630X supports multiple languages in Web GUI as well as system voice prompt. Currently, there are 16
languages supported in system voice prompt: English (United States), Arabic, Chinese, Dutch, English
(United Kingdom), French, German, Greek, Hebrew, Italian, Polish, Portuguese, Russian, Spanish,
Catalan, Swedish and Turkish.
English (United States) and Chinese voice prompts are built in with the UCM630X already. The other languages
provided by Grandstream can be downloaded and installed from the UCM630X Web GUI directly. Additionally,
users could customize their own voice prompts, package them and upload to the UCM630X.
Language settings for voice prompt can be accessed under Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice
PromptLanguage Settings.
To download and install voice prompt package in different languages from UCM630X Web GUI, click on "Add
Voice Prompt Package" button.
P a g e | 261
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
A new dialog window of voice prompt package list will be displayed. Users can see the version number (latest
version available V.S. current installed version), package size and options to upgrade or download the language.
Click on to download the language to the UCM630X. The installation will be automatically started once the
downloading is finished.
P a g e | 262
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
A new language option will be displayed after successfully installed. Users then could select it to apply in the
UCM630X system voice prompt or delete it from the UCM630X.
On the UCM630X, if the user needs to replace some specific customized prompt, the user can upload a single
specific customized prompt from Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptLanguage Settings and click on
“Upload” instead of the entire language pack.
Figure 165: Upload Single Voice Prompt for Entire Language Pack
1. First, Users should have a pre-recorded file respecting the following format:
2. Go under web GUI PBX Settings Voice Prompt Username Prompt and click on ”Upload”
button.
P a g e | 263
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
3. Select the recorded file to upload it and press Save and Apply Settings.
Select username prompts and press to delete specific file or select multiple files for deletion using
the button ”Delete” .
The second option to record username is using voicemail menu, please follow below steps:
After entering the desired extension and voicemail password, dial “0” to enter the recordings menu and
Another option is that each user can record their own name by following below steps:
After entering the voicemail password, the user can press “0” to enter the recordings menu and then “3”
P a g e | 264
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
VOICEMAIL
Configure Voicemail
If the voicemail is enabled for UCM630X extensions, the configurations of the voicemail can be globally set up
and managed under Web GUICall FeaturesVoicemail.
P a g e | 265
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 77: Voicemail Settings
Configure the maximum number of seconds for the voicemail greeting. The
Max Greeting Time (s)
default setting is 60 seconds.
If enabled, the caller can press 0 to exit the voicemail application and connect
Dial ‘0’ For Operator
to the configured operator’s extension.
Operator Type Configure the operator type; either an extension or a ring group.
Select the operator extension, which will be dialed when users press 0 to exit
Operator Extension
voicemail application. The operator extension can also be used in IVR.
Max Messages Per Configure the maximum number of messages per folder in users’ voicemail. The
Folder valid range 10 to 1000. The default setting is 50.
Select the maximum duration of the voicemail message. The message will not
be recorded if the duration exceeds the max message time. The default setting
is 15 minutes. The available options are:
1 minute
Max Message Time 2 minutes
5 minutes
15 minutes
30 minutes
Unlimited
Configure the minimum duration (in seconds) of a voicemail message.
Messages will be automatically deleted if the duration is shorter than the Min
Message Time. The default setting is 3 seconds. The available options are:
No minimum
Min Effective Message 1 second
Time 2 seconds
3 seconds
4 seconds
5 seconds
Note: Silence and noise duration are not counted in message time.
Announce Message If enabled, the caller ID of the user who has left the message will be announced
Caller-ID at the beginning of the voicemail message. The default setting is "No".
Announce Message If enabled, the message duration will be announced at the beginning of the
Duration voicemail message. The default setting is "No".
If enabled, a brief introduction (received time, received from, and etc.) of each
Play Envelope message will be played when accessed from the voicemail application. The
default setting is "Yes".
Play Most Recent First If enabled, it will play the most recent message first.
P a g e | 266
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Allow User Review If enabled, users can review the message following the IVR before sending.
If enabled, external callers routed by DID and reaching VM will be prompted by
the UCM with 2 options:
Forward Voicemail to Enables the forwarding of voicemail to remote extensions on peered SIP trunks.
Peered UCMs The default setting is “Disabled”.
Configures the default voicemail password that will be used when an extension
Voicemail Password is reset.
Format Warning: WAV files take up significantly more storage space than GSM files.
Note: Resetting an extension will reset Voicemail Password, Send Voicemail to Email, and Keep Voicemail after
Emailing values to default. Previous custom voicemail prompts and messages will be deleted.
Access Voicemail
If the voicemail is enabled for UCM630X extensions, the users can dial the voicemail access number (by default
*97) to access their extension’s voicemail. The users will be prompted to enter the voicemail password and then
can enter digits from the phone keypad to navigate in the IVR menu for different options.
Otherwise the user can dial the voicemail access code (by default *98) followed by the extension number and
password in order to access to that specific extension’s voicemail.
P a g e | 267
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
7 - Delete this message
8 - Forward the message to
another user
9 – Save
* - Help
# - Exit
2 – Change folders 0 - New messages
1 - Old messages
2 - Work messages
3 - Family messages
4 - Friend messages
# - Cancel
3 – Advanced options 1 - Send a reply
2 - Call the person who sent
this message
3 - Hear the message envelop
4 - Leave a message
* - Return to the main menu
0 – Mailbox options 1 - Record your unavailable 1 - Accept this recording
message 2 - Listen to it
3 - Re-record your message
2 - Record your busy message 1 - Accept this recording
2 - Listen to it
3 - Re-record your message
3 - Record your name 1 - Accept this recording
2 - Listen to it
3 - Re-record your message
4 - Record temporary greeting 1 - Accept this recording
2 - Listen to it
3 - Re-record your message
5 - Change your password
* - Return to the main menu
Leaving Voicemail
If an extension has voicemail enabled under basic settings “Extension/Trunk Extensions Basic Settings”
P a g e | 268
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
and after a ring timeout or user not available, the caller will be automatically redirected to the voicemail in order
to leave a message on which case they can press # in order to submit the message.
In case if the caller is calling from an internal extension, they will be directly forwarded to the extension’s
voicemail box. But if the caller is calling from outside the system and the incoming call is routed by DID to the
destination extension, then the caller will be prompted with the choice to either press1 to access voicemail
management or press 2 to leave a message for the called extension. This feature could be useful for remote
voicemail administration.
The UCM630X can be configured to send the voicemail as attachment to Email. Click on "Voicemail Email
Settings" button to configure the Email attributes and content.
If enabled, voicemail will be sent to the user's email address. Note: SMTP
Send Voicemail to Email
server must be configured to use this option.
Keep Voicemail after Enable this option if you want to keep recording files after the Email is sent.
Emailing The default setting is Enable.
Fill in the "Subject:" and "Message:" content, to be used in the Email when
sending to the user.
The template variables are:
\t: TAB
${VM_NAME}: Recipient's first name and last name
Email Template
${VM_DUR}: The duration of the voicemail message
${VM_MAILBOX}: The recipient's extension
${VM_CALLERID}: The caller ID of the person who has left the message
${VM_MSGNUM}: The number of messages in the mailbox
${VM_DATE}: The date and time when the message is left
P a g e | 269
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 167: Voicemail Email Settings
The UCM630X supports voicemail group and all the extensions added in the group will receive the voicemail to
the group extension. The voicemail group can be configured under Web GUI Call Features Voicemail
Voicemail Group. Click on "Add" to configure the group.
P a g e | 270
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 80: Voicemail Group Settings
Enter the Voicemail Group Extension. The voicemail messages left to this extension
Extension
will be forwarded to all the voicemail group members.
Configure the Name to identify the voicemail group. Letters, digits, _ and - are
Name
allowed.
Voicemail
Configure the voicemail password for the users to check voicemail messages.
Password
Email Address Configure the Email address for the voicemail group extension.
Select available mailboxes from the left list and add them to the right list. The
Member
extensions need to have voicemail enabled to be listed in available mailboxes list.
P a g e | 271
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
RING GROUP
The UCM630X supports ring group feature with different ring strategies applied to the ring group members. This
section describes the ring group configuration on the UCM630X.
Ring group settings can be accessed via Web GUICall FeaturesRing Group.
Click on to edit the ring group. The following table shows the ring group configuration parameters.
Configure ring group name to identify the ring group. Letters, digits, _ and –
Ring Group Name
are allowed.
Extension Configure the ring group extension.
Select available users from the left side to the ring group member list on the
Members
right side. Click on to arrange the order.
Select available remote users from the left side to the ring group member list
LDAP Phonebook on the right side. Click on to arrange the order. Note: LDAP Sync must
be enabled first.
Select the ring strategy. The default setting is “Ring in order”.
P a g e | 272
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ringing.
Ring in order.
Ring the members with the order configured in ring group list. If the first
member does not answer the call, it will stop ringing the first member and
start ringing the second member.
Select the “Music On Hold” Class of this Ring Group, “Music On Hold” can be
Music On Hold
managed from the “Music On Hold” panel on the left.
This option is to set a custom prompt for a ring group to announce to caller.
Click on ‘Prompt’, it will direct the users to upload the customized voice
prompts.
Custom Prompt
Note: Users can also refer to the page PBX SettingsVoice
PromptCustom Prompt, where they could record new prompt or upload
prompt files.
Configure the number of seconds to ring each member. If set to 0, it will keep
ringing. The default setting is 60 seconds.
Ring Timeout on Each
Member Note:
The actual ring timeout might be overridden by users if the phone has ring
timeout settings as well.
If enabled, calls on this ring group will be automatically recorded. The default
Auto Record setting is No. The recording files can be accessed from Web
GUICDRRecording Files.
This allows the UCM to work with endpoint-configured call forwarding settings
to redirect calls to ring group. For example, if a member wants to receive calls
to the ring group on his mobile phone, he will have to set his endpoint’s call
forwarding settings to his mobile number. By default, it is disabled.
If the forwarded call goes through a VoIP trunk, and the outbound route
for it is PIN-protected and requires authentication, the other ring group
members will no longer receive the call after it is forwarded.
P a g e | 273
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If the forwarded call hits voicemail, the other ring group members will no
longer receive the call.
If enabled, the UCM will replace the caller display name with the Ring Group
Replace Display Name name the caller know whether the call is incoming from a direct extension or a
Ring Group.
Skip Busy Agent If enabled, skip busy agents regardless of call waiting settings.
If enabled, users could select extension, voicemail, ring group, IVR, call queue,
voicemail group as the destination if the call to the ring group has no answer.
Enable Destination
Secret and Email address are required if voicemail is selected as the
destination.
The call would be routed to this destination if no one in this ring group answers
the call.
Default Destination Note: Users can now set the voicemail of ring groups as routing destinations
and IVR key press event destinations and to do so ring group must have their
Default Destination set to Voicemail with Ring Group Extensions.
P a g e | 274
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 170: Ring Group Configuration
Remote extensions from the peer trunk of a remote UCM630X can be included in the ring group with local
extension. An example of Ring Group with peer extensions is presented in the following:
1. Creating SIP Peer Trunk between both UCM630X _A and UCM630X _B. SIP Trunk can be found under
Web GUIExtension/TrunkVoIP Trunks. Also, please configure their Inbound/Outbound routes
accordingly.
2. Click edit button in the menu , and check if Sync LDAP Enable is selected, this option will allow
UCM630X_A update remote LDAP server automatically from peer UCM630X _B. In addition, Sync LDAP
Password must match for UCM630X _A and UCM630X _B to sync LDAP contact automatically. Port number
P a g e | 275
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
can be anything between 0~65535, and use the outbound rule created in step 1 for the LDAP Outbound
Rule option.
3. In case if LDAP server does not sync automatically, user can manually sync LDAP server. Under VoIP
Trunks page, click sync button shown in the following figure to manually sync LDAP contacts from peer
UCM630X.
4. Under Ring Groups setting page, click “Add”. Ring Groups can be found under Web GUICall
FeaturesRing Groups.
5. If LDAP server is synced correctly, Available LDAP Numbers box will display available remote extensions
that can be included in the current ring group. Please also make sure the extensions in the peer UCM630X
can be included into that UCM630X’s LDAP contact.
P a g e | 276
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 173: Ring Group Remote Extension
P a g e | 277
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PAGING AND INTERCOM GROUP
Paging and Intercom Group can be used to make an announcement over the speaker on a group of phones.
Targeted phones will answer immediately using speaker. The UCM630X paging and intercom can be used via
feature code to a single extension or a paging/intercom group. This section describes the configuration of
paging/intercom group under Web GUICall FeaturesPaging/Intercom.
Click on "Paging/Intercom Group Settings" to edit Alert-Info Header. This header will be included in the SIP
INVITE message sent to the callee in paging/intercom call.
P a g e | 278
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 82: Multicast Paging Configuration Parameters
Specify the maximum call duration in seconds. The default value 0 means no
Maximum Call Duration
limit.
Select which extensions are allowed to use the paging/intercom feature for this
Multicast IP Address
paging group.
P a g e | 279
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure 2-way Intercom
If enabled, the UCM will replace the caller display name with Paging/Intercom
Replace Display Name
name.
Specify the maximum call duration in seconds. The default value 0 means no
Maximum Call Duration
limit.
P a g e | 280
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
This option is to set a custom prompt for a paging/intercom group to announce
to caller. Click on ‘Prompt’, it will direct the users to upload the customized voice
Custom Prompt prompts.
Note: Users can also refer to the page PBX SettingsVoice PromptCustom
Prompt, where they could record new prompt or upload prompt files.
Select available users from the left side to the paging/intercom group member
Members
list on the right.
Paging/Intercom Select which extensions are allowed to use the paging/intercom feature for this
Whitelist paging group.
P a g e | 281
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 84: 1-way Paging Configuration Parameters
P a g e | 282
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure Announcement Paging
P a g e | 283
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Time Configure Announcement Paging Time.
Configure Announcement Paging transmission method.
Transmission Method Unicast: Depending on members selection
Multicast: Depending on Multicast IP address and Port
Select available users from the left side to the paging/intercom group member
Members
list on the right.
The UCM630X has pre-configured paging/intercom feature code. By default, the Paging Prefix is *81 and the
Intercom Prefix is *80. To edit page/intercom feature code, click on "Feature Codes" in the "Paging/Intercom
Group Settings" dialog. Or users could go to Web GUICall FeaturesFeature Codes directly.
Users can schedule paging/intercom calls by using the Schedule Paging/Intercom page. To schedule, click the
Add button on the new page and configure the caller, the group to use, and the time to call out.
P a g e | 284
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 86: Schedule Paging / Intercom Settings
Paging/Intercom Group Select the paging / intercom group from the list of the available groups.
Start Time Configure the start time of the scheduled paging / intercom call.
Select the type for the scheduled paging / intercom call. The available types are:
Type
Single time or Daily basis. Default is “Single”.
Action Status Display the action status of the scheduled paging / intercom call.
P a g e | 285
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CALL QUEUE
The UCM630X supports call queue by using static agents or dynamic agents. Call Queue system can accept
more calls than the available agents. Incoming calls will be held until next representative is available in the
system. This section describes the configuration of call queue under Web GUICall FeaturesCall Queue.
Call queue settings can be accessed via Web GUICall FeaturesCall Queue.
UCM630X supports custom prompt feature in call queue. This custom prompt will active after the caller waits for
a period of time in the Queue. Then caller could choose to leave a message/ transfer to default extension or
keep waiting in the queue.
To configure this feature, please go to UCM Web GUICall FeaturesCall QueueCreate New Queue/Edit
QueueQueue Optionsset Enable Destination to Enter Destination with Voice Prompt. Users could configure
the wait time with Voice Prompt Cycle.
Click on to edit the call queue. The call queue configuration parameters are listed in the table below.
Basic Settings
Extension Configure the call queue extension number.
Name Configure the call queue name to identify the call queue.
Select the strategy for the call queue.
Strategy
Ring All
P a g e | 286
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Ring all available Agents simultaneously until one answers.
Linear
Ring agents in the specified order.
Least Recent
Ring the agent who has been called the least recently.
Fewest Calls
Ring the agent with the fewest completed calls.
Random
Ring a random agent.
Round Robin
Ring the agents in Round Robin scheduling with memory.
The default setting is "Ring All".
Select the Music On Hold class for the call queue.
Music On Hold Note: Music On Hold classes can be managed from Web GUIPBX
SettingsMusic On Hold.
Configure the maximum number of calls to be queued at once. This number does
not include calls that have been connected with agents. It only includes calls not
Max Queue Length connected yet. The default setting is 0, which means unlimited. When the
maximum value is reached, the caller will be treated with busy tone followed by
the next calling rule after attempting to enter the queue.
Configure the number of seconds before a new call can ring the queue after the
Wrapup Time last call on the agent is completed. If set to 0, there will be no delay between calls
to the queue. The default setting is 10 seconds.
Retry Time Configure the number of seconds to wait before ringing the next agent.
Configure the number of seconds an agent will ring before the call goes to the
Ring Time
next agent. The default setting is 30 seconds.
If enabled, the calls on the call queue will be automatically recorded. The
Auto Record recording files can be accessed in Queue Recordings under Web GUICall
FeaturesCall Queue.
Configure the timeout after which users will be disconnected from the call queue.
Max Wait Time The default setting is "60". 0 means unlimited.
Note: It is recommended to configure "Wait Time" longer than the "Wrapup Time".
If enabled, users can upload an audio file that will be played as an Initial tone
Welcome Prompt
when dialing the queue number.
Once Max Wait Time has been configured, select to which destination send the
Destination
calls that have timed out. The default is to “Hang up” the call.
P a g e | 287
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the voice prompt cycle (in seconds) of the call queue. Once all agents
Destination Prompt
are busy and the voice prompt will be played, and you can press the appropriate
Cycle
key to transfer to failover destination.
Custom Prompt When playing a custom prompt, press 1 to transfer to failover destination.
Select failover destination to send callers after pressing 1 upon hearing the
Destination
custom prompt.
Advanced Settings
- Virtual Queue
- Caller Refer to Call Center Settings and Enhancements section for detailed
Announcement information about these features.
- Queue Chairman
Enable Position If enabled, the system will inform callers waiting in the queue of their positions in
Announcement line.
If enabled, the estimated wait time for the call to get answered will periodically be
Enable Wait Time
announced to the caller. Note: Wait time will not be announced if less than one
Announcement
minute.
Announcement
The interval at which caller positions and estimated wait times will be announced.
Interval
Enables agent login/logout feature for static agents (supported only on GXP21XX
Enable Agent Login
phones with firmware higher than 1.0.9.18).
Configure whether the callers will be disconnected from the queue or not if the
queue has no agent anymore. The default setting is "Strict".
Yes
Callers will be disconnected from the queue if all agents are paused or invalid.
Leave When Empty No
Never disconnect the callers from the queue when the queue is empty.
Strict
Callers will be disconnected from the queue if all agents are paused, invalid
or unavailable.
Configure whether the callers can dial into a call queue if the queue has no agent.
The default setting is "No".
Yes
Dial in Empty Queue
Callers can always dial into a call queue.
No
Callers cannot dial into a queue if all agents are paused or invalid.
P a g e | 288
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Strict
Callers cannot dial into a queue if the agents are paused, invalid or
unavailable.
Choose the destination where the call will be directed when the queue is empty
or when all the agents are not logged in, here are the destinations that can be
configured:
Play Sound.
Extension.
Failover Destination Voicemail.
Queues.
Ring Group.
Voicemail Group.
IVR.
External Number.
Enable Agent Login Enabling agent login will cause the dynamic agents to be unavailable.
Queue Chairman The queue chairman can log into his web portal to operate the queue.
If enabled, the UCM630X will report (to the agent) the duration of time of the call
Report Hold Time
before the caller is connected to the agent. The default setting is "No".
If enabled, the UCM will replace the caller display name with the Call Queue name
Replace Display Name
so that the caller knows the call is incoming from a Call Queue.
Enable feature codes option for call queue. For example, *83 is used for “Agent
Enable Feature Codes
Pause”
Autofill Configure to enable autofill.
Dynamic Login If enabled, the configured PIN number is required for dynamic agent to log in. The
Password default setting is disabled.
When present in an INVITE request, the Alert-info header field specifies an
Alert-Info
alternative ring tone to the UAS.
Agents
Go to “Agents” Tab and Select the available users to be the static agents in the
call queue. Choose from the available users on the left to the static agents list on
Static Agents
the right. Click on to choose. And use UP and Down arrow to select the
order of the agent within the call queue.
To guarantee a high level of audio quality with the call queue feature, UCMs will limit the number of static agents
allowed to be assigned depending on the UCM model used. If the user attempts to configure the number of static
agents to be more than the maximum allowed number, a warning message will appear.
P a g e | 289
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The following table lists the maximum number of static agents for each UCM model:
UCM6301 10
UCM6302 60
UCM6304 100
UCM6308 120
Click on "Global Queue Settings" to configure Agent Login Extension Postfix and Agent Logout Extension Postfix.
Once configured, users could log in the call queue as dynamic agent.
For example, if the call queue extension is 6500, Agent Login Extension Postfix is * and Agent Logout Extension
Postfix is **, users could dial 6500* to login to the call queue as dynamic agent and dial 6500** to logout from
the call queue. Dynamic agent does not need to be listed as static agent and can log in/log out at any time.
Call queue feature code "Agent Pause" and "Agent Unpause" can be configured under Web GUICall
FeaturesFeature Codes. The default feature code is *83 for "Agent Pause" and *84 for "Agent Unpause".
Note: When dialing the “Agent Pause” feature code, users can specify the reason for it. The following
reasons are available: (1) Lunch, (2) Hourly Break, (3) Backoffice, (4) Email, and (5) Wrap.
Queue recordings are shown on the Call Queue page under “Queue Recordings” Tab. Click on to
download the recording file in .wav format; click on to delete the recording file. To delete multiple
P a g e | 290
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
recording files by one click, select several recording files to be deleted and click on “Delete Selected
Recording Files” or click on “Delete All Recording Files” to delete all recording files.
UCM supports light weight call center features including virtual queue and position announcement, allowing the
callers to know their position on the call queue and giving them the option to either stay on the line waiting for
their turn or activate a callback which will be initiated by the UCM one an agent is free.
To configure call center features, press on an existing call queue and go under the advanced settings tab.
Following parameters are available:
Enable Virtual Queue Enable virtual queue to activate call center features.
Configure the time in (s) after which the virtual queue will take effect and the menu
Virtual Queue Period
will be presented to the caller to choose an option. Default is 20s.
Offered to caller after timeout: After the virtual queue period passes, the caller
will enter the virtual call queue and be presented with a menu to choose an option,
the choices are summarized below:
Press * to set current number as callback number.
Press 0 to set a callback number different than current caller number.
Press # to keep waiting on the call queue.
Virtual Queue Mode
Triggered on user request: In this mode, the callers can activate the virtual
queue by pressing 2, then they will be presented with the menu to choose an
option as below:
Press * to set current number as callback number.
Press 0 to set a callback number different than current caller number.
Press # to keep waiting on the call queue.
Virtual Queue
System will add this prefix to dialed numbers when calling back users.
Outbound Prefix
When this option is enabled and after a caller registers a call back request on the
virtual queue. While all the agents are busy, the UCM will call an agent once
Enable Virtual Queue
he/she is idle again, this timeout is used for how long the UCM continues calling
Timeout
the agent and if the agent doesn’t answer the call then the callback request will
timeout and expire.
Write Timeout Configure the virtual queue callback timeout period in seconds.
Enable Virtual Queue Enable the announcement of the caller’s position periodically.
Position Note: Queue position will now be announced to the caller upon entering the
Announcement queue.
P a g e | 291
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Position
Configure the period of time in (s) during which the UCM will announce the caller’s
Announcement
position in the call queue.
Interval
Enable Virtual Queue
When enabled the UCM will announce the estimated queue wait time to callers if
Wait Time
the estimated wait time is longer than 1 minute.
Announcement
Queue Chairman Select the extension to act as chairman of the queue (monitoring).
Virtual Queue
Click on “Upload Audio File” to upload the VQ welcome prompt.
Welcome Prompt
When enabled, statics agents can conveniently log in and out of a queue by
configuring a programmable key on their phones as a shortcut.
Notes:
This feature is currently available only for GXP21xx phones on firmware
1.0.9.18 or greater.
After enabling the feature, users need to set the option on GXP21XX phone
Enable Agent Login
under “AccountSIP SettingsAdvanced FeaturesSpecial Feature”
to “UCM Call Center”. A softkey labeled “UCM-CC” will appear on the
bottom of the phone’s screen.
When this option is enabled, dynamic agent login will be no longer
supported.
In case of concurrent registrations, changing agent status on one phone
(login/logout) will be reflected on all phones.
The waiting callers are connecting with available members in a parallel fashion until there are no more available
members or no more waiting callers.
For example, in a call queue with linear method, if there are two available agents, when two callers call in the
queue at the same time, UCM will assign the two callers to each of the two available agents at the same time,
rather than assigning the second caller to second available agent after the first agent answers the call from the
first caller.
Queue Statistics
Along with call center features, users can also gather detailed call queue statistics allowing them to make better
changes/decision to manage better the call distribution and handling based on time, agent, and queue.
To access call queue statistics, go to Web GUICall FeaturesCall Queue and click on “Call Queue Statistics”,
the following page will be displayed:
P a g e | 292
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 183: Call Queue Statistics
By selecting a time interval, administrators can get detailed statistics for agent(s) such as total calls, answered
calls etc, as well as for the queue(s) such as ABANDONED CALLS also a detailed information for the queue’s
call log by clicking on OptionsInformation button and the below window will pop up:
P a g e | 293
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
User can download statistics on CSV format by clicking on the “Download”, also the statistics can be cleared
using “Reset Statistics” button.
The statistics can be automatically sent to a specific email address on a preconfigured Period, this can be done
by clicking on “Automatic Download”, and user will be directed to below page where he can configure the
download period (Day/Week/Month) and the Email where the statistics will be sent (Email settings should be
configured correctly):
Significantly more information is now available UCM’s queue statistics page. In addition to the information
presented in previous firmware, users can now view a call log that displays calls to all agents and queues, a
dynamic agent login/logout record, and a pause log. Statistics reports for these new pages can be obtained by
pressing the Download button in the top left corner of the Call Queue Statistics page. The reports are in .CSV
format and will be packaged into a single tar.gz file upon download.
Agent Details is a call log that shows every call to each individual agent from all queues. The following
information is available:
P a g e | 294
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 186: Agent details
Login Record is a report that shows the timestamps of dynamic agent logins and logouts and calculates the
amount of time the dynamic agents were logged in. Dynamic agents are extensions that log in and out either via
agent login/logout codes (configured in Global Queue Settings page) or by using the GXP21xx call queue
softkey. A new record will be created only when an agent logs out. The following information is available:
Pause Log is a report that shows the times of agent pauses and unpauses and calculates the amount of time
that agents are paused. If an agent is part of several queues, an entry will be created for each queue. An entry
will only be created after an agent unpauses. The following information is available:
P a g e | 295
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 188: Pause Log
Switchboard
Switchboard is a Web GUI tool for call queue monitoring and management, admin can access to it from the
menu Call FeaturesCall Queue then press “Switchboard”.
Page above summarizes the available queues statistics and if one of the queues is clicked the user will be
directed to page below:
P a g e | 296
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 190: Call Queue Switchboard
The table below gives a brief description for the main menus:
This menu shows the current waiting calls along with the caller id and the option
Waiting
to hang-up call by pressing on the button.
Shows the current established calls along with the caller id and the callee (agent)
Proceeding
as well as the option to hang-up, transfer, add conference or barge-in the call.
Displays the list of agents in the queue and the extension status (idle, ringing, in
use or unavailable) along with some basic call statistics and agent’s mode (static
or dynamic).
Agents
Note: the dashboard will show the number of calls (answered and abandoned) of
each agent. For dynamic agents, it will count the number of calls starting from the
last login time.
There are three different privilege levels for Call Queue management from the switchboard: Super Admin, Queue
Chairman, and Queue Agent.
P a g e | 297
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Super Admin - Default admin of the UCM. Call queue privileges include being able to view and edit all
queue agents, monitor, and execute actions for incoming and ongoing calls for each extension in
Switchboard, and generate Call Queue reports to track performance.
Queue Chairman - User appointed by Super Admin to monitor and manage an assigned queue extension
via Switchboard. The Queue Chairman can log into the UCM user portal with his extension number and
assigned user password. To access the Switchboard, click on “Value-added Features” in the side menu and
click on “Call Queue”. In the image below, User 1001 is the Queue Chairman appointed to manage Queue
Extension 6500 and can see all the agents of the queue in the Switchboard.
Queue Agent - User appointed by Super Admin to be a member of a queue extension. A queue agent can
log into the UCM user portal with his extension number and assigned user password. To access the
Switchboard, click on “Value-added Features” in the side menu and click on “Call Queue”. However, a queue
agent can view and manage only his own calls and statistics, but not other agents’ in the queue extension.
In the image below, User 1000 is a queue agent and can see only his own information in the Switchboard.
P a g e | 298
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 192: Queue Agent
As explained before, under this section users can configure the feature codes for Dynamic agent login and logout, and
also can now customize the keys for virtual queue options like shown below.
P a g e | 299
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 91: Global Queue Settings
Configure the code to dial after the queue extension to log into the queue (i.e.
Agent Login Code
queue extension + suffix).
Suffix
If no suffix is configured, dynamic agents will not be able to log in
Configure the code to dial after the queue extension to log out of the queue (i.e.
Agent Logout Code
queue extension + suffix).
Suffix
If no suffix is configured, dynamic agents will not be able to log out.
Custom Callback
Press these feature key configured to set a custom callback number.
Number
P a g e | 300
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PICKUP GROUPS
The UCM630X supports pickup group feature which allows users to pick up incoming calls for other extensions
if they are in the same pickup group, by dialing "Pickup Extension" feature code (by default *8).
Select extensions from the list on the left side to the right side.
When picking up the call for the pickup group member, the user only needs to dial the pickup feature code. It is
not necessary to add the extension number after the pickup feature code. The pickup feature code is configurable
under Web GUICall FeaturesFeature Codes.
The default feature code for call pickup extension is *8, otherwise if the person intending to pick up the call knows
the ringing extension they can use ** followed by the extension number in order to perform the call pickup
operation. The following figure shows where you can customize these features codes
P a g e | 301
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 195: Edit Pickup Feature Code
P a g e | 302
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
MUSIC ON HOLD
Music On Hold settings can be accessed via Web GUIPBX SettingsMusic On Hold. In this page, users
could configure music on hold class and upload music files. The "default" Music On Hold class already has 5
audio files defined for users to use.
Click on "Create New MOH Class" to add a new Music On Hold class.
Click on to configure the MOH class sort method to be "Alpha" or "Random" for the sound files.
Click on next to the selected Music On Hold class to delete this Music On Hold class.
P a g e | 303
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Click on to disable it from the selected Music On Hold Class.
Select the sound files and click on to delete all selected Music On Hold files.
The UCM630X allows Users to select the Music On Hold file from WebGUI to play it. The UCM630X will initiate
a call to the selected extension and play this Music On Hold file once the call is answered.
Users could also record their own Music On Hold to override an existing custom prompt, this can be done by
following those steps:
1. Click on .
2. A message of confirmation will pop up, as shown below.
P a g e | 304
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 198: Information Prompt
3. Click .
5. Answer the call and start to record your new music on hold.
6. Hangup the call and refresh Music On Hold page then you can listen to the new recorded file.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Notes:
Once the MOH file is deleted, there are two ways to recover the music files.
Users could download the MOH file from this link:
http://downloads.asterisk.org/pub/telephony/sounds/releases/asterisk-moh-opsound-wav-2.03.tar.gz
After downloading and unzip the pack, users could then upload the music files to UCM.
Factory reset could also recover the MOH file on the UCM.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 305
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
BUSY CAMP-ON
The UCM630X supports busy camp-on/call completion feature that allows the PBX to camp on a called party
and inform the caller as soon as the called party becomes available given the previous attempted call has failed.
The configuration and instructions on how to use busy camp-on/call completion feature can be found in the
following guide:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/ucm6xxx_busy_camp_on_guide.pdf
P a g e | 306
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PRESENCE
UCM does support SIP presence feature which allows users to advertise their current availability status and
willingness to receive calls, this way other users can use their phones in order to monitor the presence status of
each user and decide whether to call them or not based on their advertised availability.
This feature is different than BLF which is used to monitor the dialog status for each extension (Ringing, Idle or
Busy). Instead the SIP presence module gives more options for users to choose which state they want to put
themselves in.
In order to configure the presence status of an extension from the web GUI, users can access the menu of
configuration using one of the two following methods:
From admin account, go under the menu Extension/TrunkExtensions and choose the desired extension
to edit then navigate to the “Features” tab.
OR
From the User Portal, go under the menu Basic InformationExtensions and navigate to the Features tab
to have the following options.
Select which status to set from the presence status selection drop list, six options are available and below is a
brief description of these states:
P a g e | 307
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 92: SIP Presence Status
The contact has limited conversation flexibility and can only be reached
Chat
via chat.
Another option to set the presence status and which is more practical is using the feature code from the user’s
phone, one the user dials the feature code (default is *48), a prompt will be played to select which status they
want to put themselves in, by pressing the corresponding key.
The feature code can be enabled and customized from the Web GUICall FeaturesFeature Codes.
When a user does change his/her SIP presence status by making a call using presence feature code, the UCM
will create a corresponding CDR entry showing the call as Action type = PRSENCE_STATUS.
P a g e | 308
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 202: Presence Status CDR
P a g e | 309
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
FOLLOW ME
Follow Me is a feature on the UCM630X that allows users to direct calls to other phone numbers and have them
ring all at once or one after the other. Calls can be directed to users’ home phone, office phone, mobile and etc.
The calls will get to the user no matter where they are. Follow Me option can be found under extension settings
page Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions.
3. Click on to add local extensions or external numbers to be called after ringing the extension
4. Once created, it will be displayed on the follow me list. And you can click on to delete the Follow Me.
P a g e | 310
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The following table shows the Follow Me configuration parameters:
If external number is added in the Follow Me, please make sure this option is
Skip Trunk Auth enabled or the “Skip Trunk Auth” option of the extension is enabled, otherwise
the external Follow Me number cannot be reached.
Music On Hold Class Configure the Music On Hold class that the caller would hear while tracking users
By default, it is enabled, and user will be asked to press 1 to accept the call or
Confirm When to press 2 to reject the call after answering a Follow Me call.
Answering If it is disabled, the Follow Me call will be established once after the user
answers.
When enabled, the call will be routed to the default destination if no one in the
Enable Destination
Follow Me extensions answers the call.
Configure the destination if no one in the Follow Me extensions answers the call.
The available options are:
Extension
Voicemail
Default Destination Queues
Ring Group
Voicemail Group
IVR
External Number
The added numbers are listed here. Click on to arrange the order. Click
Follow Me Numbers
on to delete the number. Click on to add new numbers.
Add a new Follow Me number which could be a ‘Local Extension’ or ‘External
New Follow Me
Number’. The selected dial plan should have permissions to dial the defined
Number
external number.
Select the order in which the Follow Me destinations will be dialed to reach the
Dialing Order
user: ring all at once or ring one after the other.
Click on “Follow Me Options” under Web GUIExtension/TrunkExtension page to enable or disable the
options listed in the following table.
P a g e | 311
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 94: Follow Me Options
Playback Incoming If enabled, the PBX will playback the incoming status message before starting
Status Message the Follow Me steps.
Record the Caller’s If enabled, the PBX will record the caller’s name from the phone so it can be
Name announced to the callee in each step.
Playback Unreachable If enabled, the PBX will playback the unreachable status message to the caller
Status Message if the callee cannot be reached.
P a g e | 312
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SPEED DIAL
The UCM630X supports Speed Dial feature that allows users to call a certain destination by pressing one or four
digits on the keypad. This creates a system-wide speed dial access for all the extensions on the UCM630X.
To enable Speed Dial, on the UCM630X Web GUI, go to page Web GUICall FeaturesSpeed Dial.
User should first click on . Then decide from one digit up to four digits combination used for Speed
Dial and select a dial destination from “Default Destination”. The supported destinations include extension,
voicemail, conference room, voicemail group, IVR, ring group, call queue, page group, DISA, Dial by Name and
external number.
P a g e | 313
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
DISA
In many situations, the user will find the need to access his own IP PBX resources, but he is not physically near
one of his extensions. However, he does have access to his own cell phone. In this case, we can use what is
commonly known as DISA (Direct Inward System Access). Under this scenario, the user will be able to call from
the outside, whether it is using his cell phone, pay phone, regular PSTN, etc. After calling into UCM630X, the
user can then dial out via the SIP trunk or PSTN trunk connected to UCM630X as it is an internal extension.
The UCM630X supports DISA to be used in IVR or inbound route. Before using it, create new DISA under Web
GUICall FeaturesDISA.
The following table details the parameters to set and configure DISA feature on UCM630X PBX.
P a g e | 314
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 95: DISA Settings
Configure the password (digit only) required for the user to enter before using DISA
to dial out.
Password
Note:
The password must be at least 4 digits.
Configure the maximum amount of time the UCM630X will wait before hanging up
Response Timeout if the user dials an incomplete or invalid number.
The default setting is 10 seconds.
Configure the maximum amount of time permitted between digits when the user is
Digit Timeout
typing the extension. The default setting is 5 seconds.
If enabled, during an active call, users can enter the UCM630X Hangup feature
Allow Hangup code (by default it is *0) to disconnect the call or hang up directly. A new dial tone
will be heard shortly for the user to make a new call. The default setting is "No".
Replace Display
If enabled, the UCM will replace the caller display name with the DISA name.
Name
Once successfully created, users can configure the inbound route destination as "DISA" or IVR key event as
"DISA". When dialing into DISA, users will be prompted with password first. After entering the correct password,
a second dial tone will be heard for the users to dial out.
P a g e | 315
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
EMERGENCY
UCM supports configuration and management of numbers to be called in emergency situation, thus bypassing
the regular outbound call routing process and allowing users in critical situation to dial out for emergency help
with the possibility to have redundant trunks as point of exit in case one of the lines is down.
UCM6xxx series are also now in full compliance with Kari’s Law and Ray Baum’s Act, for more information,
please refer to the following links:
https://www.fcc.gov/mlts-911-requirements
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/UCM_Emergency_Calls_Guide.pdf
In addition, Emergency calls can be automatically recorded by toggling on the new Auto Record and recordings
can be viewed in the new Emergency Recordings tab on the same page. Additionally, users can have these
recordings be sent to the configured email address(es).
Email alerts are also supported after enabling the notification for the event under “Maintenance System
Events”
3. Configure the required fields “Name, Emergency Number and Trunk(s) to be used to reach the number”.
P a g e | 316
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 207: Emergency Number Configuration
P a g e | 317
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The table below gives more description of the configuration Parameters when creating emergency numbers.
Select the emergency level of the number. Level "3" means the most
Emergency Level
urgent.
If this option is not enabled, when the lines of trunks which the coming
emergency call routes by are completely occupied, the line-grabbing
Disable Hunt on Busy function will automatically cut off a line from all busy lines so that the
coming emergency call can seize it for dialing out. This option is not
enabled by default.
Members Notified Select the members who will be notified when an emergency call occurs.
Specify the number of digits that will be Stripped from the beginning of the
Strip
dialed number before the call is placed via the selected trunk.
Specify the digits to be Prepended before the call is placed via the trunk.
Prepend
Those digits will be prepended after the dialing number is stripped.
Send Recording File When enabled recording files will be sent to the configured email address.
Email Address The email address to where the recording files will be sent.
P a g e | 318
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 208: 911 Emergency Sample
P a g e | 319
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CALLBACK
Callback is designed for users who often use their mobile phones to make long distance or international calls
which may have high service charges. The callback feature provides an economic solution for reduce the cost
from this.
In this way, the calls are placed and connected through trunks on the UCM630X instead of to the mobile phone
directly. Therefore, the user will not be charged on mobile phone services for long distance or international calls.
To configure callback on the UCM630X, go to Web GUICall FeaturesCallback page and click on
Name Configure a name to identify the Callback. (Enter at least two characters)
Configure the pattern of the callers allowed to use this callback. The caller who
places the inbound call needs to have the CallerID match this pattern so that the
CallerID Pattern
caller can get callback after hanging up the call.
Note: If leaving as blank, all numbers are allowed to use this callback.
Configure the prepend digits to be added at before dialing the outside number.
Outbound Prepend The number with prepended digits will be used to match the outbound route. ‘-’
is the connection character which will be ignored.
Delay Before Callback Configure the number of seconds to be delayed before calling back the user.
Configure the destination which the callback will direct the caller to. Two
destinations are available:
Destination IVR
DISA
The caller can then enter the desired number to dial out via UCM630X trunk.
P a g e | 320
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
BLF AND EVENT LIST
BLF
The UCM630X supports BLF monitoring for extensions, ring group, call queue, conference room and parking
lot. For example, on the user's phone, configure the parking lot number 701 as the BLF monitored number. When
there is a parked call on 701, the LED for this BLF key will light up in red, meaning a call is parked against this
parking lot. Pressing this BLF key can pick up the call from this parking lot.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
On the Grandstream GXP series phones, the MPK supports "Call Park" mode, which can be used to park the
call by configuring the MPK number as call park feature code (e.g., 700). MPK "Call Park" mode can also be
used to monitor and pickup parked call if the MPK number is configured as parking lot (e.g., 701).
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Event List
Besides BLF, users can also configure the phones to monitor event list. In this way, both local extensions on the
same UCM630X and remote extensions on the VOIP trunk can be monitored. The event list setting is under Web
GUICall FeaturesEvent List.
Click on "Add" to add a new event list.
Sort selected extensions manually in the Eventlist
Click on to edit the event list configuration.
Configure the name of this event list (for example, office_event_list). Please note
URI the URI name cannot be the same as the extension name on the UCM630X.
The valid characters are letters, digits, _ and -.
Select the available extensions/Extension Groups listed on the local UCM630X
Local Extensions
to be monitored in the event list.
If LDAP sync is enabled between the UCM630X and the peer UCM630X, the
Remote Extensions remote extensions will be listed under "Available Extensions". If not, manually
enter the remote extensions under "Special Extensions" field.
Manually enter the remote extensions in the peer/register trunk to be monitored
Special Extensions
in the event list. Valid format: 5000,5001,9000
P a g e | 321
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 209: Create New Event List
Remote extension monitoring works on the UCM630X via event list BLF, among Peer SIP trunks or Register SIP
trunks (register to each other). Therefore, please properly configure SIP trunks on the UCM630X first before
using remote BLF feature. Please note the SIP end points need support event list BLF in order to monitor remote
extensions.
When an event list is created on the UCM630X and remote extensions are added to the list, the UCM630X will
send out SIP SUBSCRIBE to the remote UCM630X to obtain the remote extension status. When the SIP end
points register and subscribe to the local UCM630X event list, it can obtain the remote extension status from this
event list. Once successfully configured, the event list page will show the status of total extension and
P a g e | 322
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
subscribers for each event list. Users can also select the event URI to check the monitored extension's status
and the subscribers' details.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Notes:
To configure LDAP sync, please go to UCM630X Web GUIExtension/TrunkVoIP Trunk. You will see
"Sync LDAP Enable" option. Once enabled, please configure password information for the remote peer
UCM630X to connect to the local UCM630X. Additional information such as port number, LDAP outbound
rule, LDAP Dialed Prefix will also be required. Both the local UCM630X and remote UCM630X need enable
LDAP sync option with the same password for successful connection and synchronization.
(Theoretically) Remote BLF monitoring will work when the remote PBX being monitored is non-UCM630X
PBX. However, it might not work the other way around depending on whether the non-UCM630X PBX
supports event list BLF or remote monitoring feature.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 323
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
DIAL BY NAME
Dial by Name is a feature on the PBX that allows caller to search a person by first or last name via his/her
phone's keypad. The administrator can define the Dial by Name directory including the desired extensions in the
directory and the searching type by "first name" or "last name". After dialing in, the PBX IVR/Auto Attendant will
guide the caller to spell the digits to find the person in the Dial by Name directory. This feature allows
customers/clients to use the guided automatic system to contact the enterprise employees without having to
know the extension number, which brings convenience and improves business image for the enterprise.
The administrators can create the dial by name group under Web GUICall FeaturesDial By Name.
P a g e | 324
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 211: Configure Extension First Name and Last Name
1. Name
2. Extension
Configure the direct dial extension for the Dial By Name group.
3. Custom Prompt
This option sets a custom prompt for directory to announce to a caller. The file can be uploaded from the
page "Custom Prompt". Click "Upload Audio File" to add additional record.
Select available extensions from the left side to the right side as the directory for the Dial By Name group.
Only the selected extensions here can be reached by the Dial By Name IVR when dialing into this group.
The extensions here must have a valid first name and last name configured under Web
GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions in order to be searchable in Dial By Name directory through IVR. By
specifying the extensions here, the administrators can make sure unscreened calls will not reach the
company employee if he/she does not want to receive them directly.
Configure “Prompt Wait Time” for Dial By Name feature. During Dial By Name call, the caller will need to
input the first letters of First/Last name before this wait time is reached. Otherwise, timeout will occur, and
the call might hang up. The timeout range is between 3 and 60 seconds.
6. Query Type
Specify the query type. This defines how the caller will need to enter to search the directory.
By First Name: enter the first 3 digits of the first name to search the directory.
By Last Name: enter the first 3 digits of the last name to search the directory.
P a g e | 325
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
7. Select Type
Specify the select type on the searching result. The IVR will confirm the name/number for the party the caller
would like to reach before dialing out.
By Order: After the caller enters the digits, the IVR will announce the first matching party's name and number.
The caller can confirm and dial out if it is the destination party, or press * to listen to the next matching result
if it is not the desired party to call.
By Menu: After the caller enters the digits, the IVR will announce 8 matching results. The caller can press
number 1 to 8 to select and call or press 9 for results in next page.
The Dial by Name group can be used as the destination for inbound route and key pressing event for IVR. The
group name defined here will show up in the destination list when configuring IVR and inbound route. If Dial by
Name is set as a key pressing event for IVR, user could use ‘*’ to exit from Dial by Name, then re-enter IVR and
start a new event. The following example shows how to use this option.
P a g e | 326
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 213: Dial By Name Group In Inbound Rule
Please refer to [Username Prompt Customization] for User Name Prompt Customization.
P a g e | 327
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ACTIVE CALLS AND MONITOR
The active calls on the UCM630X are displayed in Web GUISystem StatusActive Calls page. Users can
monitor the status, hang up the call as well as barge in the active calls in real time manner.
To view the status of active calls, navigate to Web GUISystem StatusActive Calls. The following figure
shows extension 1004 is calling 1000. 1000 is ringing.
The following figure shows the call between 1000 and 5555 is established.
P a g e | 328
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The gray color of the active call means the connection of call time is less than half an hour. It means this call is
normal.
The orange color of the active call means the connection of call time is greater than half an hour but less than
one hour. It means this call is a bit long.
Figure 217: Call Connection between half an hour and one hour
The red color of the active call means the connection of call time is more than one hour. It means this call could
be abnormal.
P a g e | 329
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 218: Call Connection more than one hour
To hang up an active call, click on icon in the active call dialog. Users can also click on
to hang up all active calls.
Call Monitor
During an active call, click on icon and the monitor dialog will pop up.
1. Enter an available extension for “Monitor’s Extension” which will be used to monitor the active call.
P a g e | 330
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
2. “Monitored Extension” must be one of the parties in the active call to be monitored.
Listen
In “Listen” mode, the extension monitoring the call can hear both parties in the active call but the audio
of the user on this extension will not be heard by either party in the monitored active call.
Whisper
In “Whisper” mode, the extension monitoring the call can hear both parties in the active call. The user
on this extension can only talk to the selected monitored extension and he/she will not be heard by the
other party in the active call. This can be usually used to supervise calls.
Barge
In “Barge” mode, the extension monitoring the call can talk to both parties in the active call. The call will
be established similar to three-way conference.
4. Enable or disable “Require Confirmation” option. If enabled, the confirmation of the invited monitor’s
extension is required before the active call can be monitored. This option can be used to avoid adding
participant who has auto-answer configured, or call forwarded to voicemail.
5. Click on “Add”. An INVITE will be sent to the monitor’s extension. The monitor can answer the call and start
monitoring. If “Require Confirmation” is enabled, the user will be asked to confirm to monitor the call.
Another way to monitor active calls is to dial the corresponding feature codes from an extension. Please refer to
[Table 99: UCM630X Feature Codes] and [Call Recording] section for instructions.
P a g e | 331
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CALL FEATURES
The UCM630X supports call recording, transfer, call forward, call park and other call features via feature code.
This section lists all the feature codes in the UCM630X and describes how to use the call features.
Feature Codes
Feature Maps
Default code: #1
Enter the code during active call. After hearing "Transfer", you
will hear dial tone. Enter the number to transfer to. Then the
user will be disconnected, and transfer is completed.
Blind Transfer Options:
Disable
Allow Caller: Enable the feature code on caller side only.
Allow Callee: Enable the feature code on callee side only.
Allow Both: Enable the feature code on both caller and callee.
Default code: *2
Enter the code during active call. After hearing "Transfer", you
will hear the dial tone. Enter the number to transfer to and the
user will be connected to this number. Hang up the call to
complete the attended transfer. In case of the called party does
not answer, users could press *0 to cancel the call and retrieve
Attended Transfer
the first call leg.
Options:
Disable
Allow Caller: Enable the feature code on caller side only.
Allow Callee: Enable the feature code on callee side only.
Allow Both: Enable the feature code on both caller and callee.
Default code: *44 (Disabled by default).
Seamless Transfer allows user to perform blind transfer using
UCM feature code without having music on hold presented
during the transfer process, it minimizes the interruption during
Seamless Transfer
transfer, making the process smooth and simple.
During an active call use the feature code (*44 by default)
followed by the number you want to transfer to in order to
perform the seamless transfer.
P a g e | 332
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Default code: *0
Enter the code during active call. It will disconnect the call.
Options:
Disconnect Disable
Allow Caller: Enable the feature code on caller side only.
Allow Callee: Enable the feature code on callee side only.
Allow Both: Enable the feature code on both caller and callee.
Default code: *3
Enter the code followed by # or SEND to start recording the
audio call and the UCM630X will mix the streams natively on
the fly as the call is in progress.
Start/Stop Call Recording Options:
Disable
Allow Caller: Enable the feature code on caller side only.
Allow Callee: Enable the feature code on callee side only.
Allow Both: Enable the feature code on both caller and callee.
Set the maximum interval (ms) between digits for feature code
Feature Code Digits Timeout
activation
DND/Call Forward
P a g e | 333
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Call Forward Busy Deactivate Default Code: *91
P a g e | 334
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Default Code: *41
Blacklist Remove To remove a number from current blacklist for inbound route,
dial *41 and follow the voice prompt to remove the number.
Default Code: **
Call Pickup on Ringing To pick up a call for any extension xxxx, enter the code followed
by the extension number xxxx.
Default Code: *8
This code is for the pickup group, which can be assigned for
each extension on the extension configuration page.
Pickup Extension
If there is an incoming call to an extension, the other extensions
within the same pickup group can dial *8 directly to pick up the
call.
Default Code: *
This code is for the user to directly dial or transfer to an
extension's voicemail.
Direct Dial Voicemail Prefix For example, directly dial *5000 will have to call go into the
extension 5000's voicemail. If the user would like to transfer the
call to the extension 5000's voicemail, enter *5000 as the
transfer target number.
Enable Spy Check this box to enable spy feature codes. Disabled by default.
P a g e | 335
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Default Code: *54 (“Enable Spy” needs to be checked)
This is the feature code to listen in on a call to monitor
Listen Spy
performance. Monitor’s line will be muted, and neither party will
hear from the monitor’s extension.
Default Code: *55 (“Enable Spy” needs to be checked)
This is the feature code to speak to one side of the call (for
Whisper Spy
example, whisper to employees to help them handle a call).
Only one side will be able to hear from the monitor’s extension.
Default Code: *56 (“Enable Spy” needs to be checked)
Barge Spy This is the feature code to join in on the call to assist both
parties.
Default Code: *36
Wakeup Service Dial this code to access UCM wakeup service, you can add,
update, activate or deactivate wakeup service.
Default Code: *35
PMS Wakeup Service Dial this code to access UCM PMS wakeup service, you can
add, update, activate or deactivate PMS wakeup service.
Default Code: *37
PMS Remote Wakeup Service Allows the user to add, update, activate, and deactivate PMS
wakeup service for other extensions.
Default Code: *23
Use this code with maid code to update PMS room status.
Update PMS Room Status
Choose the status to set after hearing the prompt, for example:
for maid 001 dial *23001 and then 1 after hearing the prompt.
Dial this code to set the presence status of the extension.
Possible options are:
1:"unavailable"
2:"available"
Presence Status
3:"away"
4:"chat”
5:"dnd”
6:"userdef"
The UCM630X also allows user to one click enable / disable specific feature code as shown below:
P a g e | 336
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 220: Enable/Disable Feature codes
Parking Lot
User can create parking lots and their related slots under Web GUI Call Features Parking Lot. In the
Parking Lot page, users can create lots of their own. This allows different groups within an organization to have
their own parking lots instead of sharing one large parking lot with others. While creating a new parking lot, users
can assign it a range that they think is appropriate for the group that will use the parking lot.
P a g e | 337
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 222: New Parking Lot
P a g e | 338
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
This option appears once Forward to Destination on Timeout is
Timeout Destination enabled. Upon park timeout, the call will be routed to the configured
destination.
Adds an Alert-Info header to parking lot callbacks after the Parking
Parking Lot Timeout Alert-Info
Timeout has been reached.
Call Park
The UCM630X provides call park and call pickup features via feature code.
Park a Call
There are two feature codes that can be used to park the call.
To retrieve the parked call, simply dial the parking lot number and the call will be established. If a parked call is
not retrieved after the timeout, the original extension who parks the call will be called back.
Monitor Call Park CID Name Information (GXP21xx, GRP261x Phones Only)
The UCM630X allows users to record audio during the call. If "Auto Record" is turned on for an extension, ring
group, call queue or trunk, the call will be automatically recorded when there is established call with it. Otherwise,
please follow the instructions below to manually record the call.
P a g e | 339
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
1. Make sure the feature code for "Start/Stop Call Recording" is configured and enabled.
2. After establishing the call, enter the "Start/Stop Call Recording" feature code (by default it is *3) followed by
# or SEND to start recording.
3. To stop the recording, enter the "Start/Stop Call Recording" feature code (by default it is *3) followed by # or
SEND again. Or the recording will be stopped once the call hangs up.
4. The recording file can be retrieved under Web GUICDR. Click on to show and play the recording or
The above recorded call's recording files are also listed under the UCM630X Web GUICDRRecording
Files.
Enable Spy
If “Enable Spy” option is enabled, feature codes for Listen Spy, Whisper Spy and Barge Spy are available for
users to dial from any extension to perform the corresponding actions.
Assume a call is on-going between extension A and extension B, user could dial the feature code from extension
C to listen on their call (*54 by default), whisper to one side (*55 by default), or barge into the call (*56 by default).
Then the user will be asked to enter the number to call, which should be either side of the active call, extension
A or B in this example.
P a g e | 340
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Caution:
“Enable Spy” allows any user to listen to any call by feature codes. This may result in the leakage of user privacy.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Shared Call Appearance (SCA) functionality has been added to the UCM. With SCA, users can assign multiple
devices to one extension, configure endpoints to monitor that extension, make actions on behalf of that extension
such as viewing call status and placing and receiving calls, and even barging into existing calls. To configure the
SCA functionality, please follow the steps below:
1. Users can enable SCA by navigating to the Extensions page, editing the desired extension, and enabling
the option SCA.
Note: With SCA enabled, the Concurrent Registrations field can only have a value of 1.
2. After enabling the option, navigate to Call FeaturesSCA. The newly enabled SCA extension will be listed.
Click the “+” button under the Options column to add a number that will share the main extension’s call
appearance, which will be called private numbers.
P a g e | 341
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 227: SCA Number Configuration
4. Once the private number has been created, users must now register a device to it. To properly register a
device to the private number, use the configured private number as the SIP User ID. Auth ID and Password
will be the same as the main extensions. Once registration is complete, SCA is now configured.
P a g e | 342
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 229: SCA Options
5. Next, configure the VPK or MPK to Shared for both the main extension and the private number. SCA is
now configured for both endpoint devices.
Allow Origination from This Enable this option will allow calling from this private number. By
Number default, it is enabled.
Allow Termination to This Enable this option will allows calls to this private number. By default,
Number it is enabled.
The following table describes the options available when editing the SCA number:
P a g e | 343
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 102: Editing the SCA Number
Multiple Call Arrangement Allows simultaneous calls in an SCA group. By default, it is disabled.
Allow Bridging between Allows location bridging for SCA group. Must be enabled when
Locations using the Barge-In feature. By default, it is disabled.
Configures the notification in the bridge when another party join.
None: No notification sound.
Barge-In only: Notification sound will play when another
Bridge Warning Tone party join.
Barge-In and Repeat: Notification sound will play when
another party joins and repeat every 30 seconds.
By default, it is set to “Barge-In Only”.
P a g e | 344
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ANNOUNCEMENT
The Announcement feature (not to be confused with Announcement Paging and Announcement Center) is a
feature that allows users to set an unskippable audio file to play to callers before routing them to a configured
destination. Announcements can be configured as a destination in the Inbound Routes page.
3. Configure the required fields Name, Prompt, Default Destination to be used for the announcement.
The table below gives more description of the configuration parameters when creating Announcement.
Default Destination Select the destination where to play the audio file.
P a g e | 345
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PBX SETTINGS
This section describes internal options that have not been mentioned in previous sections yet. The settings in
this section can be applied globally to the UCM630X, including general configurations, jitter buffer, RTP settings,
ports config and STUN monitor. The options can be accessed via Web GUIPBX SettingsGeneral Settings.
General Preferences
Configure the global CallerID used for all outbound calls when no other CallerID
Global Outbound CID is defined with higher priority. If no CallerID is defined for extension or trunk, the
global outbound CID will be used as CallerID.
Configure the global CallerID Name used for all outbound calls. If configured,
Global Outbound CID
all outbound calls will have the CallerID Name set to this name. If not, the
Name
extension's CallerID Name will be used.
Configure the number of seconds to ring an extension before the call goes to
the user's voicemail box. The default setting is 60.
Ring Timeout
Note: This is the global value used for each extension if "Ring Timeout" field is
left empty on the extension configuration page.
The amount of seconds before the maximum call duration is reached to play
Warning Time (s)
the warning tone to the caller.
Warning Repeat Interval The amount of seconds that must pass after the first warning tone before
(s) another warning tone is played.
Reroutes failed outbound calls that receive a 486 response through the failover
Enable 486 to Failover
trunk to retry the call. If disabled, calls that receive a 486 response will be
Trunk
terminated.
If enabled, users will hear voice prompt before recording is started or stopped.
Record Prompt For example, before recording, the UCM630X will play voice prompt "The call
will be recorded". The default setting is "No".
P a g e | 346
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
International Call Prefix When this configuration is empty, International Call Prefix can be empty or +.
Conference Voice
Voice quality of audio and video conferences
Quality
Extension Preferences
If enabled, strong password will be enforced for the password created on the
UCM630X. The default setting is “No”.
2. Password for extension registration, Web GUI admin login, LDAP and
LDAP sync requires alphanumeric characters containing at least two
categories of the following, with a minimum length of 4 characters.
Numeric digits
Lowercase alphabet characters
Uppercase alphabet characters
Special characters
Enable Random If enabled, random password will be generated when the extension is created.
Password The default setting is "Yes". It is recommended to enable it for security purpose.
Enable Auto E-mail To If enabled, UCM630X will send Email notification to user automatically after
User editing extension settings or adding a new extension.
P a g e | 347
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If set to "Yes", users could disable the extension range pre-
configured/configured on the UCM630X. The default setting is "No".
Disable Extension
Range
Note: It is recommended to keep the system assignment to avoid inappropriate
usage and unnecessary issues.
Extension Ranges Extension Segment" should be a subset of the "Pick Extensions" range
here. This feature is for the GXP series phones that support selecting
extension to be provisioned via phone's LCD.
P a g e | 348
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PBX Settings/RTP Settings
RTP Settings
RTP Start Configure the RTP port starting number. The default setting is 10000.
RTP End Configure the RTP port ending address. The default setting is 20000.
Valid format:
[(hostname | IP-address) [':' port]
The default port number is 3478 if not specified.
BFCP UDP Start Configure BFCP UDP port starting number. The default setting is 50000.
BFCP UDP End Configure BFCP UDP port ending number. The default setting is 52999.
BFCP TCP Start Configure BFCP TCP port starting number. The default setting is 53000.
BFCP TCP End Configure BFCP TCP port ending number. The default setting is 55999.
Configure TURN server address. TURN is an enhanced version of the STUN
TURN Server
protocol and is dedicated to the processing of symmetric NAT problems.
TURN Server Name Configure turn server account name
TURN Server Password Configure turn server account password.
Connection Protocol Protocol used to connect to the TURN server.
P a g e | 349
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Payload
The UCM630X payload type for audio codecs and video codes can be configured here.
Configure payload type for ADPCM (G.726, 32kbps, AAL2 codeword packing).
AAL2-G.726
The default setting is 112.
DTMF Configured payload type for DTMF. The default setting is 101.
G.721 Compatible Configure to enable/disable G.721 compatible. The default setting is Yes.
Configure the payload type for G.726 if "G.721 Compatible" is disabled. The
G.726
default setting is 111.
iLBC Configure the payload type for iLBC. The default setting is 97.
OPUS Configure the payload type for OPUS. The default setting is 123.
Audio FEC Payload
Configure the Audio FEC Payload Type. The default setting is 127
Type
Audio RED Payload
Configure the Audio RED Payload Type. Default setting is 122
Type
H.264 Configure the payload type for H.264. The default setting is 99.
H.265 Configure the payload type for H.264. The default setting is 114.
H.263P Configure the payload type for H.263+. The default setting is 100 103.
VP8 Configure the payload type for VP8. The default setting is 108.
Main Video FEC Configure the Main Video FEC
RTP FECC Configure the RTP FECC
RTX Configure the RTX
G.722.1 G.722.1:Low-complexity coder, 24kbps.
G.722.1C G.722.1C:Low-complexity coder, 48kbps.
In the UCM630X Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice PromptCustom Prompt page, click on “Record” and
follow the steps below to record new IVR prompt.
P a g e | 350
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 231: Record New Custom Prompt
2. Select the format (GSM or WAV) for the IVR prompt file to be recorded.
3. Select the extension to receive the call from the UCM630X to record the IVR prompt.
4. Click the “Record” button. A request will be sent to the UCM630X. The UCM630X will then call the extension
for recording the IVR prompt from the phone.
5. Pick up the call from the extension and start the recording following the voice prompt.
6. The recorded file will be listed in the IVR Prompt web page. Users could select to re-record, play, or delete
the recording.
If the user has a pre-recorded IVR prompt file, click on “Upload” in Web GUIPBX SettingsVoice
PromptCustom Prompt page to upload the file to the UCM630X. The following are required for the IVR
prompt file to be successfully uploaded and used by the UCM630X:
PCM encoded.
16 bits.
8000Hz mono.
In .mp3 or .wav format; or raw/ulaw/alaw/gsm file with .ulaw or .alaw suffix.
File size under 5M.
P a g e | 351
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 232: Upload Custom Prompt
Click on “choose file to upload” to start uploading. Once uploaded, the file will appear in the Custom Prompt web
page.
On the UCM630X, the users can download all custom prompts from UCM Web GUI to local PC. To download all
custom prompt, log in UCM Web GUI and navigate to PBX SettingsVoice PromptCustom Prompt and
click on ”Download All”. The following window will pop up in order to set a name for the downloaded file.
Prompt Tone Settings tab has been added to the UCM to help users choose which prompt will be played by
the UCM during call failure, the following voice message responses have been added and can be set to be
played for 4XX, 5XX, and 6XX call failures:
P a g e | 352
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Default for 404 and 604 status codes: “Your call can’t be completed as dialed. Please check the number
and dial again.”
Default for 5xx status codes: “Server error. Please check your device.”
Default for 403 and 603 status codes: “The call was rejected by the server. Please try again later.”
Default for all other status codes: “All circuits are busy now. Please try again later.”
Additionally, custom voice messages recorded and uploaded in PBX SettingsVoice PromptCustom
Prompt can be used for these failure responses instead of the default messages.
Moreover, users also have the possibility to customize the prompt for typical call failure reasons like (no
permission to allow outbound calls, busy lines, incorrect number dialed …Etc.).
P a g e | 353
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
To customize these prompts user could record and upload their own files under “’PBX Settings Voice Prompt
Custom Prompts” then select each one for specific call failure case under “PBX Settings -> Call Failure
Tone Settings General Call Prompt Tone” page as shown on the following figure:
The UCM630X supports call recordings automatically or manually and the recording files can be saved in
external storage plugged in the UCM630X or on the UCM630X locally. To manage the recording storage, users
can go to UCM630X Web GUIPBX SettingsRecordings Storage page and select whether to store the
recording files in USB Disk, SD card, GDMS or locally on the UCM630X.
P a g e | 354
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If “Enable Auto Change” is selected, the recording files will be automatically saved in the available USB
Disk or SD card plugged into the UCM630X. If both USB Disk and SD card are plugged in, the recording
files will be always saved in the USB Disk.
If “GDMS Cloud Storage” is selected, recording data will no longer be stored locally and if you need to listen
to the recording, download the recording file to the computer side and play it offline.
If “USB Disk” or “SD Card” is selected, the recordings will be stored in the corresponding plugged in external
storage device. Please note the options “USB Disk” and “SD Card” will be displayed only if they are plugged
into the UCM630X.
Once “USB Disk” or “SD Card” is selected, click on “OK”. The user will be prompted to confirm to copy the
local files to the external storage device.
Click on “OK” to continue. The users will be prompted a new dialog to select the categories for the files to be
copied over.
P a g e | 355
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 238: Recording Storage Category
On the UCM630X, recording files are generated and exist in 3 categories: normal call recording files, conference
recording files, and call queue recording files. Therefore, users have the following options when select the
categories to copy the files to the external device:
- Recording Files: Copy the normal recording files to the external device.
- Conference: Copy the conference recording files to the external device.
- Queue: Copy the call queue recording files to the external device.
- All: Copy all recording files to the external device.
PBX Settings/NAS
The UCM supports adding and backing up recordings to a network-attached storage (NAS) server. Following
table describes NAS settings:
Status If configured correctly, the Status field will show “Mounted”, and the newly
P a g e | 356
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
added NAS server will be shown on the Mounted Netdisk List. Additionally, the
NAS will appear as a selectable storage option in the PBX SettingsRecording
Storage page and CDRRecording Files page.
P a g e | 357
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SIP SETTINGS
The UCM630X SIP global settings can be accessed via Web GUIPBX SettingsSIP Settings.
SIP Settings/General
Realm For Digest Configure the host name or domain name for the UCM630X. Realms MUST be
Authentication globally unique according to RFC3261. The default setting is Grandstream.
Bind UDP Port Configure the UDP port used for SIP. The default setting is 5060.
Configure the IPv4 address to bind to. The default setting is 0.0.0.0, which means
Bind IPv4 Address
binding to all addresses.
Configure the IPv6 address to bind to. The default is : "[::]" and it means to bind
Bind IPv6 Address
to all IP addresses.
If enabled, the UCM630X allows unauthorized INVITE coming into the PBX and
the call can be made. The default setting is "No".
Allow Guest Calls Warning:
Please be aware of the potential security risk when enabling "Allow Guest Calls"
as this will allow any user with the UCM630X address to dial into the UCM630X.
If set to "No", all transfers initiated by the endpoint in the UCM630X will be
Allow Transfer
disabled (unless enabled in peers or users). The default setting is "Yes".
When sending MWI NOTIFY requests, this value will be used in the "From:"
MWI From header as the "name" field. If no "From User" is configured, the "user" field of
the URI in the "From:" header will be filled with this value.
Enable Diversion
If disabled, the UCM will not forward the diversion header.
Header
If enabled, collect calls will be blocked.
Note: Collect calls are indicated by the header "P-Asserted-Service-Info: service-
Block Collect Calls
code=Backward Collect Call, P-Asserted-Service-Info: service-code=Collect
Call".
SIP Settings/MISC
P a g e | 358
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
default setting is 0, which means the UCM630X will keep trying until the server
side accepts the registration request.
Video
Max Bit Rate (kb/s) Configure the maximum bit rate (in kb/s) for video calls. The default setting is 384.
Support SIP Video Select to enable video support in SIP calls. The default setting is "Yes".
If enabled, when rejecting an incoming INVITE or REGISTER request, the
UCM630X will always reject with "401 Unauthorized" instead of notifying the
Reject Non-Matching
requester whether there is a matching user or peer for the request. This reduces
INVITE
the ability of an attacker to scan for valid SIP usernames. The default setting is
"No".
SDP Attribute Passthrough
Enable Attribute If enable, and if the service does not know the attribute of FEC/FECC/BFCP, then
Passthrough the attribute will be passthrough.
Early Media
Enable Use Final SDP If enabled, call negotiation will use final response SDP.
Blind Transfer
If enabled, the UCM will call back to the transferrer when blind transfer fails
Allow callback when
(reason of failure includes: busy and no answer).
blind transfer fails
Note: This feature takes effect only on internal calls.
Configure the timeout in (s) for the transferrer waiting for the destination to
Blind transfer timeout
answer. Default is 60s.
Hold
Configure the UCM to forward HOLD requests instead of processing holds
internally. This serves to meet the standards set by some providers that require
Forward HOLD HOLD requests to be passed along from endpoint to endpoint. This option is
Requests disabled by default.
Note: Enabling this option may cause hold retrieval issues and MOH to not be
heard.
P a g e | 359
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SIP Settings/TCP and TLS
Configure to allow incoming TCP connections with the UCM630X. The default
TCP Enable
setting is "No".
Configure the IP address for TCP server to bind to. "0.0.0.0" means binding to all
TCP Bind IPv4
interfaces. The port number is optional, and the default port number is 5060. For
Address
example, 192.168.1.1:5062.
Configure the IPv6 address for TCP server to bind to. "[::]" means bind to all
TCP Bind IPv6
interfaces. The port number is optional with the default being 5060. For example,
Address
[2001:0DB8:0000:0000:0000:0000:1428:0000]:5060.
Configure to allow incoming TLS connections with the UCM630X. The default
TLS Enable
setting is "Yes".
Configure the IPv4 address for TLS server to bind to. "0.0.0.0" means binding to
all interfaces. The port number is optional, and the default port number is 5061.
TLS Bind IPv4
For example, 192.168.1.1:5063. Note: The IP address must match the common
Address
name (host name) in the certificate so that the TLS socket will not bind to multiple
IP addresses.
Configure the IPv6 address for TLS server to bind to. "[::]" means bind to all
interfaces. The port number is optional with default being 5061. For example,
TLS Bind IPv6
[2001:0DB8:0000:0000:0000:0000:1428:0000]:5061. Note: The IP address must
Address
match the common name (host name) in the certificate so that the TLS socket will
not bind to multiple IP addresses.
If enabled, the TLS server's certificate will not be verified when acting as a client.
TLS Do Not Verify
The default setting is "Yes".
This is the CA certificate if the TLS server being connected to requires self-signed
certificate, including server's public key. This file will be renamed as "TLS.ca"
TLS Self-Signed CA
automatically.
Note: The size of the uploaded ca file must be under 2MB.
This is the Certificate file (*.pem format only) used for TLS connections. It contains
private key for client and signed certificate for the server. This file will be renamed
TLS Cert
as "TLS.pem" automatically.
Note: The size of the uploaded certificate file must be under 2MB.
This file must be named with the CA subject name hash value. It contains CA's
TLS CA Cert (Certificate Authority) public key, which is used to verify the accessed servers.
Note: The size of the uploaded CA certificate file must be under 2MB.
TLS CA List Display a list of files under the CA Cert directory.
P a g e | 360
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SIP Settings/NAT
Configure a static IP address and port (optional) used in outbound SIP messages
External Host
if the UCM630X is behind NAT. If it is a host name, it will only be looked up once.
If enabled, the SDP connection will use the IP address resolved from the external
Use IP address in SDP
host.
Configure externally mapped UDP port when the PBX is behind a static NAT or
External UDP Port
PAT.
Configure the externally mapped TCP port when the UCM630X is behind a static
External TCP Port
NAT or PAT.
Configures the externally mapped TLS port when UCM630X is behind a static
External TLS Port
NAT or PAT.
Specify a list of network addresses that are considered inside of the NAT
network. Multiple entries are allowed. If not configured, the external IP address
Local Network
will not be set correctly.
Address
A sample configuration could be as follows:
192.168.0.0/16
SIP Settings/TOS
ToS for SIP Configure the Type of Service for SIP packets. The default setting is None.
ToS for RTP Audio Configure the Type of Service for RTP audio packets. The default setting is None.
ToS for RTP Video Configure the Type of Service for RTP video packets. The default setting is None.
Default
Configure the default duration (in seconds) of incoming/outgoing registration.
Incoming/Outgoing
The default setting is 120.
Registration Time
Max
Configure the maximum duration (in seconds) of incoming registration and
Registration/Subscrip
subscription allowed by the UCM630X. The default setting is 3600.
tion Time
Min
Configure the minimum duration (in seconds) of incoming registration and
Registration/Subscrip
subscription allowed by the UCM630X. The default setting is 60.
tion Time
P a g e | 361
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Enable Relaxed DTMF Select to enable relaxed DTMF handling. The default setting is "No".
Select DTMF mode to send DTMF. The default setting is RFC4733. If "Info" is
selected, SIP INFO message will be used. If "Inband" is selected, a-law or u-law
DTMF Mode
are required. When "Auto" is selected, "RFC4733" will be used if offered,
otherwise "Inband" will be used. The default setting is "RFC4733".
During an active call, if there is no RTP activity within the timeout (in seconds),
RTP Timeout the call will be terminated. The default setting is no timeout.
Note: This setting does not apply to calls on hold.
When the call is on hold, if there is no RTP activity within the timeout (in seconds),
RTP Hold Timeout the call will be terminated. This value of RTP Hold Timeout should be larger than
RTP Timeout. The default setting is no timeout.
This feature can be used to avoid abnormal call drop when the remote provider
requires RTP traffic during proceeding.
For example, when the call goes into voicemail and there is no RTP traffic sent
RTP Keep-alive
out from UCM, configuring this option can avoid voicemail drop.
When configured, RTP keep-alive packet will be sent to remote party at the
configured interval. If set to 0, RTP keep-alive is disabled.
100rel Configure the 100rel setting on UCM630X. The default setting is “Yes”.
Configure whether the Remote-Party-ID should be trusted. The default setting is
Trust Remote Party ID
"No".
Configure whether the Remote-Party-ID should be sent or not. The default
Send Remote Party ID
setting is "No".
Configure whether the UCM630X should generate Inband ringing or not. The
default setting is "Never".
Yes: The UCM630X will send 180 Ringing followed by 183 Session
Progress and in-band audio.
Generate In-Band No: The UCM630X will send 180 Ringing if 183 Session Progress has not
Ringing been sent yet. If audio path is established already with 183 then send in-
band ringing.
Never: Whenever ringing occurs, the UCM630X will send 180 Ringing as
long as 200OK has not been set yet. Inband ringing will not be generated
even the end point device is not working properly.
Server User Agent Configure the user agent string for the UCM630X.
P a g e | 362
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
SIP Settings/STIR/SHAKEN
To prevent robocalls, UCM now supports STIR/SHAKE protocols. Related options have been added as a new
tab in the SIP Settings page.
Authentication
Configure the Authentication Number.
Number
Configure the attestation level, which is the level of confidence of the carrier that the
Creditability CID has not been spoofed. The following options are available:
P a g e | 363
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
A (Full attestation) - The carrier is associated with the caller and the
number. There is high confidence that the CID has not been spoofed.
B (Partial attestation) - The carrier is associated with the caller but not
the number. There is uncertainty about whether the CID has been
spoofed or not.
Clicking on the Certificate Settings button will bring up the following window:
Certificate Download
Configure the public key download timeout period, the default value is 2 seconds.
Time (s)
Signature Valid Time Configure the validity period of the digital signature, the default value is 15
(s) seconds.
P a g e | 364
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the Private key.
Note: The uploaded file must be less than 2MB in file size, only supports the .key
Private Key
format and must be ECC type. This file will automatically be renamed to
"private.key".
Configure the Public Key.
Public Key Note: The uploaded file must be less than 2MB in file size, only supports the .crt
format and must be ECC type. This file will automatically be renamed to
"public.crt".
UCM supports transparent call info header in order to integrate GDS door system with GXP21XX/GRP261X
phones, the UCM will forward the call-info header to the phone in order to request the live view from GDS door
system and give the option to open the door via softkey.
P a g e | 365
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
IAX SETTINGS
The UCM630X IAX global settings can be accessed via Web GUIPBX SettingsIAX Settings.
IAX Settings/General
Configure the port number that the IAX2 will be allowed to listen to. The default
Bind Port
setting is 4569.
Bind IPv4 Address Force IAX2 to bind to a specific address instead of all addresses.
Bind IPv6 address Configure the IPv6 address to bind to. "[::]" means to bind to all IP addresses.
IAX1 Compatibility Select to configure IAX1 compatibility. The default setting is "No".
If selected, UDP checksums will be disabled and no checksums will be
No Checksums calculated/checked on systems supporting this feature. The default setting is
"No".
If enabled, the IAX2 will delay the rejection of calls to avoid DOS. The default
Delay Reject
setting is "No".
ADSI Select to enable ADSI phone compatibility. The default setting is "No".
Specify which Music On Hold class this channel would like to listen to when being
Music On Hold put on hold. This music class is only effective if this channel has no music class
Interpret configured and the bridged channel putting the call on hold has no "Music On
Hold Suggest" setting.
Music On Hold Specify which Music On Hold class to suggest to the bridged channel when
Suggest putting the call on hold.
Bandwidth Configure the bandwidth for IAX settings. The default setting is "Low".
IAX Settings/Registration
P a g e | 366
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If enabled and no ACK is received for new messages after the specified wait time,
Auto Kill
the connection will be terminated.
Authentication
If enabled, authentication traffic in debugging will not show. The default is "No".
Debugging
Trunk Frequency Configure the frequency of trunk frames (in milliseconds). The default is 20.
Trunk Time Stamps If enabled, time stamps will be attached to trunk frames. The default is "No".
IAX Settings/Security
Max Call Numbers Configure the maximum number of calls allowed for a single IP address.
Max Call Numbers Configure to limit the number of calls for a give IP address of IP range.
P a g e | 367
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
INTERFACE SETTINGS
Analog Hardware
The analog hardware (FXS port and FXO port) on the UCM630X will be listed in this page. Click on to edit
signaling preference for FXS port or configure ACIM settings for FXO port.
Select "Loop Start" or "Kewl Start" for each FXS port. And then click on "Update" to save the change.
For FXO port, users could manually enter the ACIM settings by selecting the value from dropdown list for each
port. Or users could click on "Detect" and choose the detection algorithm, two algorithms exist (ERL, Pr) for the
UCM630X to automatically detect the ACIM value. The detecting value will be automatically filled into the
settings.
P a g e | 368
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 119: PBX Interface Settings
Select country to set the default tones for dial tone, busy tone, ring tone and
Tone Region etc. to be sent from the FXS port. The default setting is "United States of
America (USA)".
Advanced Settings
Select country to set the On-Hook Speed, Ringer Impedance, Ringer
Threshold, Current Limiting, TIP/RING voltage adjustment, Minimum
FXO Opermode Operational Loop Current, and AC Impedance as predefined for your country's
analog line characteristics. The default setting is "United States of America
(USA)".
Select country to set the On-Hook Speed, Ringer Impedance, Ringer
Threshold, Current Limiting, TIP/RING voltage adjustment, Minimum
FXS Opermode Operational Loop Current, and AC Impedance as predefined for your country's
analog line characteristics. The default setting is "United States of America
(USA)".
Configure to enable or disable override Two-Wire Impedance Synthesis
(TISS). The default setting is No.
FXS TISS Override
If enabled, users can select the impedance value for Two-Wire Impedance
Synthesis (TISS) override. The default setting is 600Ω.
Select the codec to be used for analog lines. North American users should
choose PCMU. All other countries, unless already known, should be assumed
PCMA Override to be PCMA. The default setting is PCMU.
Note:
This option requires system reboot to take effect.
Configure to increase the ringing speed to 25HZ. This option can be used with
Fast Ringer
"Low Power" option. The default setting is "Normal".
Configure the peak voltage up to 50V during "Fast Ringer" operation. This
Low Power
option is used with "Fast Ringer". The default setting is "Normal".
If set to "Full Wave", false ring detection will be prevented for lines where Caller
Ring Detect ID is sent before the first ring and proceeded by a polarity reversal, as in UK.
The default setting is "Standard".
P a g e | 369
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Configure the type of Message Waiting Indicator on FXS lines. The default
setting is "FSK".
FXS MWI Mode
FSK: Frequency Shift Key Indicator
NEON: Light Neon Bulb Indicator.
FXO Frequency Allows users to adjust the tolerance of the FXO ringing frequency. 63Hz is
Tolerance considered the standard value and is selected by default.
DAHDI Settings
When users encounter issues such as audio delay in outbound calls using the analog trunk, they can adjust
DAHDI settings on the UCM to attempt to lessen or resolve the issues.
- “Half”: Data will be read/written from buffer when half of the buffer is occupied with data.
- “Immediate”: Read/write from buffer whenever there is data occupying the buffer.
- “Full”: Data will be read/written from buffer when buffer is fully occupied with data.
Normally, DAHDI settings should be kept default and should be adjusted only when users encounter analog
trunk/Fax-related issues.
P a g e | 370
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
UCM RemoteConnect
An integrated & important part of Grandstream’s GDMS cloud-based device management service which runs on
Amazon AWS with 99.999% reliability, the UCM RemoteConnect cloud service supports hassle-free Work-From-
Home audio/video communications & collaborations using WebRTC-based license-free “Grandstream Wave”
soft phones for desktop/Web/mobile devices (plus GUV series of USB headsets/Webcams), zero-touch out-of-
box automated NAT firewall traversal for remote users & devices, IT-friendly remote management of UCM and
attached endpoint devices, and more.
The RemoteConnect can be configured under Value-added FeaturesRemoteConnect After purchasing the
RemoteConnect package.
On GDMS platform, sign in and go to DevicePBX Device page, click on “Add Device” to add your UCM6300
device to GDMS system, once done an open beta plan will be assigned to the UCM.
P a g e | 371
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 246: UCM RemoteConnect - Effective Plan
Note
After the UCM is added on GDMS, automated NAT traversal, SIP extension sync-up and basic statistics
features are available without manual configuration required.
Plan Settings
After UCM is added into GDMS, all SIP extensions on the UCM will be synced up to GDMS automatically for
users to allocate and manage SIP extension for their end devices. Also, the media NAT Traversal service, alert
event sync configuration items are checked by default, the CDR data cloud storage in GDMS should be manually
checked according to user needs.
P a g e | 372
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 247: UCM RemoteConnect Plan Settings
Custom logo
Custom logo feature allows users to select a local image file as the new logo. The pictures are in different formats
and sizes according to the location of the logo. They are 64*64px (only ico format is supported), 256*256px,
80*80px, which applies for "UCM Login", "Reset Password", "Email Template", "Wave/Login", "Browser Tab
interface preview”.
P a g e | 373
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Statistics
After using UCM RemoteConnect, all remote calls will be logged and concurrent remote calls will be displayed
on the UCM. The concurrent remote calls can be viewed under UCM web GUIValue-Added FeaturesUCM
RemoteConnectStatistics page.
For more information, please visit http://ucmrc.gdms.cloud/intro.html and read our UCM63XX RemoteConnect
guides
P a g e | 374
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
API CONFIGURATION
The UCM630X supports third party billing interface API for external billing software to access CDR and call
recordings on the PBX. The API uses HTTPS to request the CDR data and call recording data matching given
parameters as configured on the third-party application.
Before accessing the API, the administrators need enable API and configure the access/authentication
information on the UCM630X first under Value-added FeaturesAPI Configuration. The API configuration
parameters are listed in the table below.
The new API supports now new queries listed below which will accomplish certain requests and get data about
different modules on UCM630X.
Queries Supported
getSystemStatus
getSystemGeneralStatus
listAccount
getSIPAccount
updateSIPAccount
P a g e | 375
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
listVoIPTrunk
addSIPTrunk
getSIPTrunk
updateSIPTrunk
deleteSIPTrunk
listOutboundRoute
addOutboundRoute
getOutboundRoute
updateOutboundRoute
deleteOutboundRoute
listInboundRoute
addInboundRoute
getInboundRoute
updateInboundRoute
deleteInboundRoute
playPromptByOrg
listBridgedChannels
listUnBridgedChannels
Hangup
callbarge
listQueue
getQueue
updateQueue
addQueue
deleteQueue
loginLogoffQueueAgent
pauseUnpauseQueueAgent
listPaginggroup
addPaginggroup
getPaginggroup
updatePaginggroup
P a g e | 376
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
deletePaginggroup
MulticastPaging
MulticastPagingHangup
listIVR
addIVR
getIVR
updateIVR
deleteIVR
cdrapi
recapi
pmsapi
queueapi
getPinSets
addPinSets
updatePinSets
deletePinSets
Customers now can use the “Upload Prompts User Configuration” to upload/replace voice prompt files as an
alternative method to the manual upload method on UCM PBX Settings Voice Prompt Custom Prompt.
P a g e | 377
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
An HTTP/HTTPS request is sent to the UCM to upload/replace a voice prompt file, the request should include
authentication details to the UCM and the name of the file to be uploaded. Then the UCM will contact an FTP
server that should be hosted on the same IP address of the HTTP/HTTPS requester and download the prompt
file from the FTP server.
The steps and conditions to upload the voice prompt via API are listed below:
1. Configure the prompt User under value-added Features API Configuration Upload Prompts
User Configuration. By default, the username and password for voice prompt user are “Username:
uploader; Password: uploader123”.
https://192.168.124.89:8089/cgi?action=uploadprompt&username=uploader&password=9191a6394c2
1b3aabd779213c7179462&filename=test.mp3
If UCM's HTTP server is set to HTTP, the example of the request sent to the UCM is:
http://192.168.124.89:8089/cgi?action=uploadprompt&username=uploader&password=9191a6394c21
b3aabd779213c7179462&filename=test.mp3
Note: If the File name on the HTTP/HTTPS request exists already on the UCM’s Custom voice prompts list the
existing file will be overwritten by the new file downloaded from the FTP server.
For more details on CDR API (Access to Call Detail Records) and REC API (Access to Call Recording Files),
please refer the document in the link here:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/ucm6xxx_cdr_rec_api_guide.pdf
P a g e | 378
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CTI SERVER
UCM does support CTI server capabilities which are designed to be a part of the CTI solution suite provided by
Grandstream, including GXP21XX and GXP17XX enterprise IP phones along with GS Affinity app.
Mainly the UCM will by default listening on port TCP 8888 for the connections from GS affinity application in
order to interact, modify and serve data requests by the application which includes setting call features for the
connected extension as call forward and DND.
Users can change the listening port under the menu page, Web GUIValue-added FeaturesCTI Server as
shown on below screenshot:
More information about GS affinity and CTI Support on Grandstream products series please refer to the following
link: http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/GS_Affinity_Guide.pdf
P a g e | 379
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ASTERISK MANAGER INTERFACE (RESTRICTED ACCESS)
The UCM630X supports Asterisk Manager Interface (AMI) with restricted access. AMI allows a client program to
connect to an Asterisk instance commands or read events over a TCP/IP stream. It is particularly useful when
the system admin tries to track the state of a telephony client inside Asterisk.
User could configure AMI parameters on UCM630X Web GUIValue-added FeaturesAMI. For details on
how to use AMI on UCM630X, please refer to the following AMI guide:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/UCM_series_AMI_guide.pdf
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Warning:
Please do not enable AMI on the UCM630X if it is placed on a public or untrusted network unless you have taken
steps to protect the device from unauthorized access. It is crucial to understand that AMI access can allow AMI
user to originate calls and the data exchanged via AMI is often very sensitive and private for your UCM630X
system. Please be cautious when enabling AMI access on the UCM630X and restrict the permission granted to
the AMI user. By using AMI on UCM630X you agree you understand and acknowledge the risks associated with
this.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
P a g e | 380
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
CRM INTEGRATION
Customer relationship management (CRM) is a term that refers to practices, strategies and technologies that
companies use to manage and analyze customer interactions and data throughout the customer lifecycle, with
the goal of improving business relationships with customers.
The UCM630X support the following CRMs: SugarCRM, vTigerCRM, ZohoCRM, Salesforce CRM and ACT!
CRM, which allows users to look for contact information in the Contacts, Leads and / or Accounts tables, shows
the contact record in CRM page, and saves the call information in the contact’s history.
SugarCRM
Configuration page of the SugarCRM can be accessed via admin login, on the UCM WebGUIValue-added
FeaturesCRM.
1. Select “SugarCRM” from the CRM System Dropdown in order to use SugarCRM.
CRM System Select a CRM system from the dropdown menu, four CRM systems
are available: SugarCRM, vTigerCRM, ZohoCRM (v1&v2),
Salesforce and ACT! CRM.
CRM Server Address Enter the IP address of the CRM server.
Add Unknown Number Add the new number to this module if it cannot be found in the
selected module.
P a g e | 381
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Contact Lookups
Select from the “Available” list of lookups and press to
select where the UCM can perform the lookups on the CRM tables,
Leads, Accounts, and Contacts.
2. Click on and .
3. Logout from admin access.
4. Login to the UCM as user and navigate under “User PortalValue-added FeatureCRM User Settings”.
Click on “Enable CRM” and enter the username/password associated with the CRM account then click on
and . The status will change from “Logged Out” to “Logged In”. User can start then using
SugarCRM features.
VTigerCRM
Configuration page of the vTigerCRM can be accessed via admin login, on the UCM WebGUIValue-added
FeaturesCRM.
P a g e | 382
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 254: vTigerCRM Basic Settings
1. Select “vTigerCRM” from the CRM System Dropdown in order to use vTigerCRM.
CRM System Select a CRM system from the dropdown menu, four CRM systems
are available: SugarCRM, vTigerCRM, ZohoCRM (v1&v2),
Salesforce and ACT! CRM.
CRM Server Address Enter the IP address of the CRM server.
Add Unknown Number Add the new number to this module if it cannot be found in the
selected module.
Contact Lookups
Select from the “Available” list of lookups and press to
select where the UCM can perform the lookups on the CRM tables,
Leads, Organizations, and Contacts.
2. Click on and .
3. Logout from admin access.
4. Login to the UCM as user and navigate under “User PortalValue-added FeatureCRM User Settings”.
Click on “Enable CRM” and enter the username/password associated with the CRM account then click on
P a g e | 383
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
and . The status will change from “Logged Out” to “Logged In”. User can start then using
SugarCRM features.
ZohoCRM
Configuration page of the ZohoCRM can be accessed via admin login, on the UCM WebGUIValue-added
FeaturesCRM.
P a g e | 384
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
1. Select “ZohoCRM” from the CRM System Dropdown in order to use ZohoCRM.
CRM System Select a CRM system from the dropdown menu, four CRM systems
are available: SugarCRM, vTigerCRM, ZohoCRM (v1&v2),
Salesforce and ACT! CRM.
CRM Server Address Enter the IP address of the CRM server.
Add Unknown Number Add the new number to this module if it cannot be found in the
selected module.
Contact Lookups
Select from the “Available” list of lookups and press to
select where the UCM can perform the lookups on the CRM tables,
Leads, Accounts, and Contacts.
2. Click on and .
3. Logout from admin access.
4. Login to the UCM as user and navigate under “User PortalValue-added FeatureCRM User Settings”.
Click on “Enable CRM” and enter the username/password associated with the CRM account then click on
and . The status will change from “Logged Out” to “Logged In”. User can start then using
ZohoCRM features.
Note: ZohoV2CRM is supported as well while the CRM Server Address https://www.zohozpis.com
P a g e | 385
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Salesforce CRM
Configuration page of the Salesforce CRM can be accessed via admin login, on the UCM Web GUIValue-
added FeaturesCRM”.
1. Select “Salesforce” from the CRM System Dropdown in order to use Salesforce CRM.
CRM System Select a CRM system from the dropdown menu, four CRM systems
are available: SugarCRM, vTigerCRM, ZohoCRM (v1&v2),
Salesforce and ACT! CRM.
Add Unknown Number Add the new number to this module if it cannot be found in the
selected module.
Contact Lookups
Select from the “Available” list of lookups and press to
select where the UCM can perform the lookups on the CRM tables,
Leads, Accounts, and Contacts.
2. Click on and .
3. Logout from admin access.
4. Login to the UCM as user and navigate under “User PortalValue-added FeatureCRM User Settings”.
P a g e | 386
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Click on “Enable CRM” and enter the username, password and Security Token associated with the CRM
account then click on and . The status will change from “Logged Out” to “Logged In”.
User can start then using Salesforce CRM features.
ACT! CRM
Configuration page of the ACT! CRM can be accessed via admin login, on the UCM Web GUIValue-added
FeaturesCRM”.
2. Log into the UCM as a regular user and navigate to Value-Added FeaturesCRM User Settings and
check “Enable CRM” option and enter the username and password, which will be the ACT! CRM
P a g e | 387
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
account’s API Key and Developer Key, respectively. To obtain these, please refer to the ACT! CRM API
developer’s guide here: https://mycloud.act.com/act/Help
Note: For more information on the ACT! CRM integration, please refer to the ACT! CRM documentation on our
website.
P a g e | 388
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PMS INTEGRATION
UCM630X supports Hotel Property Management System PMS, including check-in/check-out services, wakeup
calls, room status, Do Not Disturb which provide an ease of management for hotel applications. This feature can
be found on Web GUIValue-added FeaturesPMS.
Note: The PMS integration on UCM is currently supported only with one of the three following solutions.
The PMS module built-in the UCM supports the following features based on each solution:
Check-out ✓ ✓ ✗ ✓
Wake-up Call ✓ ✓ ✗ ✓
Name Change ✓ ✗ ✓ ✗
Update ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓
Set Credit ✓ ✗ ✗ ✗
Room Status ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓
Room Move ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓
Do Not Disturb ✗ ✓ ✓ ✗
Mini Bar ✗ ✓ ✗ ✓
MSG ✗ ✓ ✗ ✗
MWI ✗ ✗ ✓ ✗
Unconditional Call ✗ ✗ ✓ ✗
Forward
PBX
Grandstream UCM6XXX series have integrated HMobile Connect PMSI which supports a large variety of PMS
software providing following hospitality features: Check-in, Check-out, set Room Status, Wake-up call and more.
The following figure illustrates the communication flow between the UCM and PMS software, which is done
P a g e | 389
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
through a middleware system (HMobile Connect) acting as interface between both parties.
PMS Software
PMSI Middleware
(HMobile Connect)
Grandstream UCM
HSC PMS
PBX
Grandstream UCM6XXX series have integrated HSC PMS providing following features:
P a g e | 390
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
name – extension display name / CID name
mwi – MWI state
permission – permission level of the extension
cfwt – call forwarding always number
dnd – DND state
language – display language of the extension in ISO 639-1 format
The UCM should respond with either 200 OK or 404 responses.
5. Added HTTPS support
The following figure illustrates the communication flow between the PBX (Grandstream UCM6xxx Series) and
PMS software (HSC). The communication between both parties is direct with no middleware.
Grandstream UCM
Mitel PMS
PBX
Grandstream UCM6XXX series have integrated Mitel PMS providing following hospitality features: Check-in,
Check-out, set Room Status, Wake-up call and more.
The following figure illustrates the communication flow between the PBX (Grandstream UCM6xxx Series) and
PMS software (Mitel). The communication between both parties is direct with no middleware.
P a g e | 391
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Mitel PMS Software
Grandstream UCM
IDS PMS
Grandstream UCM
PMS API
The PMS API allows users to use their own middleware to work with PMS systems instead of currently supported
integrations.
Additionally, this API allows access to read and modify certain UCM parameters that current supported PMS
integrations cannot. To use this, users must first enable and configure the HTTPS API settings.
For more details, please refer to online HTTPS API, Pmsapi section.
P a g e | 392
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Connecting to PMS
On the UCM WebGUIValue-added FeaturesPMSBasic Settings” set the connection information for the
PMS platform.
Field Description
Users can select the desired PMS module from the drop-down list.
Hmobile.
Mitel.
PMS Module
HSC.
IDS.
PMS API.
Prompt used when answering the wakeup calls it can be customized
Wakeup Prompt
from “PBX SettingsVoice PromptCustom Prompt.
Back Up Voicemail If enabled, this option allows backing up voicemail recordings to external
Recordings storage after check-out.
Note: This option is available only when the PMS Module is set to PMS
API.
In order to use some PMS features please activate the feature code associated under “Call FeaturesFeature
Codes”
P a g e | 393
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
PMS Features
Room Status
User can create Rooms by clicking on ”Add Room”, the following Figure will be displayed then.
Click “Save” to create the new room, the fields above can be configured from the PMS platform, once set the
following screen will be shown:
User can create a batch of rooms as well by clicking on , the following window will pop up:
P a g e | 394
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 268: Add batch rooms
Wake Up Service
In order to create a New Wake up service, user can click on ”Add”, the following window will pop up:
Field Description
Room Number Select the room number where to call with a limitation of 63 characters.
Select Time Set the time of the wakeup call
Action Status Show the status of the call:
Programmed: the call is scheduled for the time set
Cancelled: the call is canceled
Executed: the wakeup call is made
Note: Editing an already executed wakeup service will automatically change
the service’s status to “Programmed”.
P a g e | 395
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Type Single: The call will be made once on the specific time.
Daily: The call will be repeated every day on the specific time
Once the call is made on the time specified, the following figure show the status of the wakeup call.
This call has been executed but has been rejected, that why we can see the “Busy” status.
Mini Bar
In order to create a new mini bar, click on ”Add Mini Bar” under UCM WebGUIValue-added
FeaturesPMSMini Bar, the following window will pop up:
P a g e | 396
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
In order to create a new maid, click on under UCM WebGUIValue-added
FeaturesPMSMaid.
Maid Code Enter the Code to use when the maid wants to use the Mini Bar.
Password Enter the password associated with the maid.
P a g e | 397
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The Minibar page displays as:
P a g e | 398
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
WAKEUP SERVICE
The Wake Up service can be used to schedule a reminder or wake up calls to any valid destination. This service
is available on the UCM630X as a separated module.
2. Wake Up service can be found under Web GUIValue-added FeaturesWakeup Service, click
on ”Add” to create a new wakeup service. The following window will pop up.
3. Fill out the required fields and select the members to add to the wakeup group.
P a g e | 399
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 132: Wakeup Service
Date Select the date or dates when to performs the wakeup call.
A wakeup service entry is created. The UCM will send a wakeup call to every extension in the member list at
the scheduled date and time.
Note: the wakeup service has the following limitation on how many members can be added depending on UCM
model.
UCM6301 50
UCM6302 100
UCM6304 150
UCM6308 200
P a g e | 400
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
4. Click and to apply the changes.
4. Dial “*36” which is the feature code by default to access to the UCM wakeup service to add, update,
activate or deactivate UCM wakeup service.
P a g e | 401
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
ANNOUNCEMENTS CENTER
The UCM630X supports Announcements Center feature which allows users to pre-record and store voice
message into UCM630X with a specified code. The users can also create group with specified extensions. When
the code and the group number are dialed together in the combination of code + group number, the specified
voice message is sent to all group members and only extensions in the group will hear the voice message.
P a g e | 402
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Announcements Center Settings
Configure a name for the newly created Announcements Center to identify this
Name
announcement center.
Enter a code number for the custom prompt. This code will be used in
combination with the group number. For example, if the code is 55, and group
number is 666. The user can dial 55666 to send prompt 55 to all members in
Code group 666.
Note:
The combination number must not conflict with any number in the system such
as extension number or conference number.
This option is to set a custom prompt as an announcement to notify group
Custom Prompt members. The file can be uploaded from page ‘Custom Prompt’. Click ‘Prompt’
to add additional record.
Configure the ring timeout for the group members. The default value is 30
Ring Timeout
seconds.
Auto Answer If set to Yes the Auto answer will be enabled by the members.
Group Settings
Configure a name for the newly created group to identify the group.
Name
Note: Name cannot exceed 64 characters.
Configure the group number. The group number is used in combination with the
code. For example, if group number is 666, and code is 55. The user can dial
55666 to send prompt 55 to all members in group 666.
Number
Note:
The combination number must not conflict with any number in the system such
as extension number or conference number and cannot exceed 64 characters.
Members Select the group members from the available list.
P a g e | 403
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
3. Create a group number which is used with code to send voice message.
4. Select the extensions to be included in the group, who will receive the voice message.
In this example, group “Test” has number 666. Extension 1000, 1001 and 1002 are in this group.
3. Specify the code which will be used with group number to send the voice message to.
4. Select the message that will be used by the code from the Custom Prompt drop down menu. To create a
new Prompt, please click “Prompt” link and follow the instructions in that page.
P a g e | 404
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 278: Announcements Center Code Configuration
Code and Group number are used together to direct specified message to the target group. All extensions in
the group will receive the message. For example, we can send code 55 to group 666 by dialing 55666 from
any extension registered to the UCM630X. All the members in group 666 which are extension 1000, 1001 and
1002 will receive this voice message after they pick up the call.
P a g e | 405
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
STATUS AND REPORTING
PBX Status
The UCM630X monitors the status for Trunks, Extensions, Queues, Conference Rooms, Interfaces and Parking
lot. It presents administrators the real-time status in different sections under Web GUISystem
StatusDashboard.
Trunks
Users could see all the configured trunk status in this section.
P a g e | 406
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 136: Trunk Status
Extensions
Extensions Status can be seen from the same configuration page, users can go under Web
GUIExtension/TrunkExtensions and following page will be displayed listing the extensions and their status
information.
P a g e | 407
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 137: Extension Status
Display extension number (including feature code). The color indicator has the
following definitions.
Green: Free
Status
Blue: Ringing
Yellow: In Use
Grey: Unavailable
Presence Status Display the presence status of the extension.
Extension Display the extension number.
Name First name and last name of the extension.
IP and Port Display the IP and port number of the registered device.
Display Email Notification status for the extension.
Email When notification is waiting for be sent, shows and once sent it will display
Interfaces Status
This section displays interface/port connection status on the UCM630X. The following example shows the
interface status for UCM6304 with USB, WAN port, FXS1, FXS2 and FXO1 connected.
P a g e | 408
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 138: Interface Status Indicators
USB connected.
USB disconnected.
SD Card connected.
SD Card disconnected.
LAN/WAN connected.
LAN/WAN disconnected.
FXS/FXO connected.
FXS/FXO waiting.
FXS/FXO busy.
FXS/FXO disconnected.
System Status
The UCM630X system status can be accessed via Web GUIStatusSystem Status, which displays the
following system information.
General
Under Web GUISystem StatusSystem InformationGeneral, users could check the hardware and
software information for the UCM630X. Please see details in the following table.
P a g e | 409
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 139: System StatusGeneral
Network
Under Web GUISystem StatusSystem InformationNetwork, users could check the network information
for the UCM630X. Please see details in the following table.
P a g e | 410
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Storage Usage
Users could access the storage usage information from Web GUISystem StatusDashboardStorage
Usage. It shows the available and used space for Space Usage and Inode Usage.
Configuration partition
This partition contains PBX system configuration files and service configuration files.
Data partition
Voicemail, recording files, IVR file, Music on Hold files etc.
USB disk
USB disk will display if connected.
SD Card
SD Card will display if connected.
Configuration partition
Data partition
Note:
Inode is the pointer used for file reference in the system. The system usually has limited resources of pointers
P a g e | 411
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 284: System StatusStorage Usage
Resource Usage
When configuring and managing the UCM630X, users could access resource usage information to estimate the
current usage and allocate the resources accordingly. Under Web GUI System Status Dashboard
Resource Usage, the current CPU usage and Memory usage are shown in the pie chart.
P a g e | 412
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 285: System StatusResource Usage
System Events
The UCM630X can monitor important system events, log the alerts, and send Email notifications to the system
administrator.
The system alert events list can be found under Web GUI Maintenance System Events. The following
event and their actions are currently supported on the UCM630X which will have alert and/or Email generated if
occurred:
Table 141: Alert Events
4 System Reboot
5 System Update
6 System Crash
P a g e | 413
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
7 Register SIP failed
8 Register SIP trunk failed
9 Restore Config
14 Fail2ban Blocking
18 HA failure warning
19 Emergency Calls
P a g e | 414
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Note: For users who have purchased a GDMS package, once the option Alert Events Sync is enabled under
RemoteConnect, the triggered events will be pushed to their GDMS platform.
For more information, please refer to:
http://www.grandstream.com/sites/default/files/Resources/UCM63xx_RemoteConnect_User_Guide.pdf
Click on to configure the parameters for each event. See examples below.
1. Disk Usage
Detect Cycle: The UCM630X will perform the internal disk usage detection based on this cycle. Users
can enter the number and then select second(s)/minute(s)/hour(s)/day(s) to configure the cycle.
Alert Threshold: If the detected value exceeds the threshold (in percentage), the UCM630X system will
send the alert.
Note: If the threshold is exceeded, any behavior of operating the disk will be rejected, including stopping file
upload, IM writing, recording and CDR recording.
P a g e | 415
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Detect Cycle: The UCM630X will perform the External disk usage detection based on this cycle. Users
can enter the number and then select second(s)/minute(s)/hour(s)/day(s) to configure the cycle.
Alert Threshold: If the detected value exceeds the threshold (in percentage), the UCM630X system will
send the alert.
3. Memory Usage
Alert Threshold: If the detected value exceeds the threshold (in percentage), the UCM630X system will
send the alert.
4. System Crash
Detect Cycle: The UCM will detect the event at each cycle based on the specified time. Users can
enter the number and then select second(s)/minute(s)/hour(s)/day(s) to configure the cycle.
Click on the switch to turn on/off the alert and Email notification for the event. Users could
also select the checkbox for each event and then click on button "Alert On", "Alert Off", "Email Notification
On", "Email Notification Off" to control the alert and Email notification configuration.
Once the super administrator password is modified, the system will record the password modification event in
the alarm log.
P a g e | 416
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
6. System Reboot
UCM will detect the system restart and will send an alert for it.
7. System Reboot
Once the system is upgraded, the system upgrade event will be recorded in the alarm log.
Configure the sending period of the SIP registration failure alert. The first registration failure alert of the same
IP to the same SIP account will be sent immediately, and then no alerts will be sent for similar failure warnings
in the cycle time. After the cycle time expires, an alert will be sent again to count the number of occurrences of
similar SIP registration failure alerts during the cycle. When set to 0, alerts are always sent immediately.
Figure 292: System EventsAlert Events Lists: Register SIP Trunk Failed
Detect Cycle: The UCM will detect the failure of SIP trunk registration at a set interval. Users can
enter the number and then select second(s)/minute(s)/hour(s)/day(s) to configure the cycle.
P a g e | 417
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
10. Restore Config
Once the system configuration is restored, the configuration restoration event will be recorded in the alert log.
If the system SIP extension call fails within the office, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
If the system SIP trunk outgoing call fails, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
If the system Fail2ban is blocking, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
If System SIP extension registration is lost, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
17. SIP peer trunk status
If the SIP peer trunks status is abnormal, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
If user login is blocked, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
If the system generates an emergency call, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
20. NAS
P a g e | 418
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
If the system network disk is abnormal, the event will be recorded in the alarm log.
If the system performs data synchronization and backup abnormalities, the event will be recorded in the alert
log.
If the remote concurrent call fails, the event will be recorded in the alert log.
If the external disk of the system is Connected/Disconnected, the event will be recorded in the alarm log.
The CPU flow control threshold is defined under System Settings -> General Settings, and the default value
is 90%. When the traffic exceeds the predetermined value, the event will be recorded in the alert log and new
calls will be prohibited.
Alert Log
Under Web GUIMaintenanceSystem EventsAlert Log, system messages from triggered system events
are listed as alert logs. The following screenshot shows system crash alert logs.
User could also filter alert logs by selecting a certain event category, type of alert log, and/or specifying a certain
time period. The matching results will be displayed after clicking on . Alert logs are classified into two
P a g e | 419
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
1. Generate Alert: Generated when alert events happen, for example, alert logs for disk usage exceeding the
alert threshold.
2. Restore to Normal: Generated when alert events being cleared, for example, logs for disk usage dropping
back below the alert threshold.
User could filter out alert logs of “Generate Alert” or “Restore to Normal” by specifying the type according to
need. The following figure shows an example of filtering out alert logs of type of “Restore to Normal”.
Alert Contact
This feature allows the administrator to be notified when one of the Alert events mentioned above happens.
Users could add administrator's Email address under Web GUIMaintenanceSystem EventsAlert
Contact to send the alert notification to an email (Up to 10 Email addresses can be added) or also specify an
HTTP server where to send this alert.
Super Admin Configure the email addresses to send alert notifications to.
Email Up to 10 email addresses can be added.
Admin Email Configure the email addresses to send alert notifications to.
Up to 10 email addresses can be added.
P a g e | 420
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Protocol Protocol used to communicate with the server. HTTP or HTTPS.
Default one is HTTP.
CDR
CDR (Call Detail Record) is a data record generated by the PBX that contains attributes specific to a single
instance of phone call handled by the PBX. It has several data fields to provide detailed description for the call,
such as phone number of the calling party, phone number of the receiving party, start time, call duration, etc.
On the UCM630X, the CDR can be accessed under Web GUICDRCDR. Users could filter the call report by
specifying the date range and criteria, depending on how the users would like to include the logs to the report.
Click on "Filter" button to display the generated report.
P a g e | 421
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 295: CDR Filter
Inbound calls: Inbound calls are calls originated from a non-internal source
(like a VoIP trunk) and sent to an internal extension.
Outbound calls: Outbound calls are calls sent to a non-internal source (like
a VoIP trunk) from an internal extension.
Internal calls: Internal calls are calls from one internal extension to another
extension, which are not sent over a trunk.
External calls: External calls are calls sent from one trunk to another trunk,
which are not sent to any internal extension.
Status Filter with the call status, the available statuses are the following:
Answered
No Answer
Busy
Failed
Source Trunk Select source trunk(s) and the CDR of calls going through inbound the trunk(s) will be
Name filtered out.
Destination Trunk Select destination trunk(s) and the CDR of calls going outbound through the trunk(s)
Name will be filtered out.
Action Type Filter calls using the Action Type, the following actions are available:
P a g e | 422
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Announce
Announcement page
Dial
Announcements
Callback
Call Forward
Conference
DISA
Follow Me
IVR
Page
Parked Call
Queue
Ring Group
Transfer
VM
VMG
Video Conference
VQ_Callback
Wakeup
Emergency Call
Emergency Notify
SCA
Extension Group Specify the Extension Group name to filter with.
Export File Data Select the fields that will be exported, the following fields are available:
Account Code
Session
Premier caller
Action type
Source trunk name
Destination trunk name
Caller number
Caller ID
Caller name
Callee number
Answer by
Context
Start time
P a g e | 423
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Answer time
End time
Call time
Talk time
Source channel
Dest channel
Call status
Dest channel extension
Last app
Last data
AMAFLAGS
UIQUEID
Call type
NAT
Account Code Select the account Code to filter with. If pin group CDR is enabled, the call with pin
group information will be displayed as part of the CDR under Account Code Field.
Start Time Specify the start time to filter the CDR report. Click on the calendar icon on the right
and the calendar will show for users to select the exact date and time.
End Time Specify the end time to filter the CDR report. Click on the calendar icon on the right
and the calendar will show for users to select the exact date and time.
Caller Number Enter the caller number to filter the CDR report. CDR with the matching caller number
will be filtered out.
User could specify a particular caller number or enter a pattern. ‘.’ matches zero or
more characters, only appears in the end. ‘X’ matches any digit from 0 to 9, case-
insensitive, repeatable, only appears in the end.
For example:
3XXX: It will filter out CDR that having caller number with leading digit 3 and of 4 digits’
length.
3.: It will filter out CDR that having caller number with leading digit 3 and of any length.
Caller Name Enter the caller name to filter the CDR report. CDR with the matching caller name will
be filtered out.
Callee Number Enter the callee number to filter the CDR report. CDR with the matching callee number
will be filtered out.
Note: The "Callee Number" filter field supports specifying Pattern (example: 3XXX)
or using Leading digits (example: 3.) as filtering options.
P a g e | 424
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
The call report will display as the following figure shows.
Start Time
Format: 2019-12-11 09:53:03
Action Type
Example:
IVR
DIAL
WAKEUP
Call From
Example format: 5555
Call To
Example format: 1000
Call Time
Format: 0:00:11
Talk Time
Format: 0:00:06
Account Code
Example format:
Grandstream/Test
Status
Answered, Busy, No answer or Failed.
Users could perform the following operations on the call report.
P a g e | 425
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
reverse the order.
Delete All
On the bottom of the page, click on button to remove CDR records that
Note: When deleting CDR, a prompt will now appear asking whether to delete all recording files or not.
Click on to play the recording file; click on to download the recording file in .wav format; click on
to delete the recording file (the call record entry will not be deleted).
P a g e | 426
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Automatic Download CDR Records
User could configure the UCM630X to automatically download the CDR records and send the records to
multiple Email recipients in a specific hour. Click on “Automatic Download Settings” and configure the
parameters in the dialog below.
To receive CDR record automatically from Email, check “Enable” and select a time period “By Day” “By Week”
or “By Month”, select Hour of the day as well for the automatic download period. Make sure you have entered
an Email or multiple email addresses where to receive the CDR records.
Note: users have the option to delete the sent records “Delete Sent Records”
Starting from UCM630X firmware 1.0.10.x, transferred call will no longer be displayed as a separate call entry in
CDR. It will display within call record in the same entry. CDR new features can be found under Web
GUICDRCDR. The user can click on the option icon for a specific call log entry to view details about this
entry, such as premier caller and transferred call information.
P a g e | 427
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 300: Detailed CDR Information
The downloaded CDR (.csv file) has different format from the Web GUI CDR. Here are some descriptions.
If the "Source Channel" contains "DAHDI", this means the call is from FXO/PSTN line.
Context
There are different context values that might show up in the downloaded CDR file. The actual value can vary
case by case. Here are some sample values and their descriptions.
from-internal: internal extension makes outbound calls.
ext-did-XXXXX: inbound calls. It starts with "ext-did", and "XXXXX" content varies case by case, which also
relate to the order when the trunk is created.
ext-local: internal calls between local extensions.
Figure 302: Downloaded CDR File Sample - Source Channel and Dest Channel 1
P a g e | 428
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Sample 2:
Figure 303: Downloaded CDR File Sample - Source Channel and Dest Channel 2
Note: The language of column titles in exported CDR reports and statistics reports will be based on the UCM’s
display language
Users can select the data they want to see in exported CDR reports by first clicking on the Filter button on the
CDR page under CDRCDR and selecting the desired information in the Export File Data field.
P a g e | 429
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 304: CDR Export File data
Cloud Storage for CDR Record which can be displayed under CDR CDR in GDMS Cloud.
Statistics
CDR Statistics is an additional feature on the UCM630X which provides users a visual overview of the call report
across the time frame. Users can filter with different criteria to generate the statistics chart.
P a g e | 430
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 306: CDR Statistics
P a g e | 431
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Recording Files
This page lists all the recording files recorded by "Auto Record" per extension/ring group/call queue/trunk, or via
feature code "Audio Mix Record". If external storage device is plugged in, for example, SD card or USB drive,
the files are stored on the external storage. Otherwise, internal storage will be used on the UCM630X.
Click on “Batch Download Recording Files” in order to download the selected recording files.
Select Either “USB Disk” or “Local” to show recording files stored on external or internal storage, depending
P a g e | 432
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
USER PORTAL
Users could log into their web GUI portal using the extension number and user password. When an extension is
created in the UCM630X, the corresponding user account for the extension is automatically created. The user
portal allows access to a variety of features which include user information, extension configuration and CDR as
well as settings and managing value-added features like Call Queue, Wakeup Service and CRM.
Users also can access their personal data files (call recordings, Voicemail Prompts …).
The login credentials are configured by Super Admin. The following figure shows the dialog of editing the account
information by Super Admin. The Username must be the extension number and it is not configurable, and the
password is set on “User Password” field and it should not be confused with the SIP extension password.
The following screenshot shows an example of login page using extension number 1000 as the username.
P a g e | 433
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 309: User Portal Login
After successful login, the user has the following three configuration tabs:
P a g e | 434
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Basic Information
Under this menu, the user can configure and change his/her personal information including (first name, last
name, password, email address, department…). And they can also set and activate their extension features
(presence status, call forward, DND ….) to be reflected on the UCM.
Also, the user can see from this menu the Call Details Records and search for specific ones along with the
possibility to download the records on CSV format for later usage.
Personal Data
Under this section, the user can access and manage their personal data files which includes (voicemail files, call
recordings …) along with the possibility to set Follow me feature to without requesting the Super admin to set
the feature from admin account.
Value-added Features
On this section, the user has access to manage and use all rich value-added features which includes.
+ If user is a member of call queue, they can check the queue’s activity from the “Call Queue” section.
+ Create and enable Wake Up service.
+ Enable and configure CRM connection to either SugarCRM or Salesforce.
For the configuration parameter information in each page, please refer to [Table 145: User ManagementCreate
New User] for options in User PortalBasic InformationUser Information page; please refer to
[EXTENSIONS] for options in User PortalBasic InformationExtension page; please refer to [CDR] for User
PortalBasic InformationCDR page.
P a g e | 435
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
MAINTENANCE
User Management
User management is on Web GUIMaintenanceUser Management page. User could create multiple
accounts for different administrators to log in the UCM630X Web GUI. Additionally, the system will automatically
create user accounts along with creating new extensions for extension users to login to the Web GUI using their
extension number and password. All existing user accounts for Web GUI login will be displayed on User
Management page as shown in the following figure.
User Information
When logged in as Super Admin, click on ”Add” to create a new account for Web GUI user. The following dialog
will prompt. Configure the parameters as shown in below table.
P a g e | 436
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Table 145: User ManagementCreate New User
Configure a username to identify the user which will be required in Web GUI login.
Username
Letters, digits, and underscore are allowed in the username.
Configure a password for this user which will be required in Web GUI login. English
User Password
input is allowed without space,’ and “.
This is the role of the Web GUI user. Currently only “Admin” is supported when
Privilege
Super Admin creates a new user.
Department
Email Address
First Name
Last Name Enter the necessary information to keep a record for this user.
Home Number
Phone Number
Once created, the Super Admin can edit the users by clicking on or delete the user by clicking on .
Custom Privilege
Super Administrator
- This is the highest privilege. Super Admin can access all pages on UCM630X Web GUI, change
configuration for all options and execute all the operations.
- Super Admin can create, edit, and delete one or more users with “Admin” privilege
- Super Admin can edit and delete one or more users with “Consumer” privilege
- Super Admin can view operation logs generated by all users.
- By default, the user account “admin” is configured with “Super Admin” privilege and it is the only user
with “Super Admin” privilege. The Username and Privilege level cannot be changed or deleted.
- Super Admin could change its own login password on Web GUIMaintenanceLogin Settings page.
P a g e | 437
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
- Super Admin could view operations done by all the users in Web GUIMaintenanceUser
ManagementOperation Log
Administrator
- Users with “Admin” privilege can only be created by “Super Admin” user.
- “Admin” privilege users are not allowed to access the following pages:
MaintenanceUpgrade
MaintenanceCleaner
MaintenanceReset/Reboot
SettingsUser ManagementOperation Log
- “Admin” privilege users cannot create new users for login.
Note: By default, administrator accounts are not allowed to access backup menu, but this can be assigned
to them by editing the option “Maintenance User Management Custom Privilege” then press
to edit the “Admin” account and include backup operation permission for these types of users.
Consumer
- A user account for Web GUI login is created automatically by the system when a new extension is
created.
- The user could log in the Web GUI with the extension number and password to access user information,
extension configuration, CDR of that extension, personal data, and value-added features. For more
details; please refer to User Portal Guide.
- The SuperAdmin user can click on on the “General_User” in order to enable/disable the custom
privilege from deleting their own recording files, changing SIP credentials, and disabling voicemail
service in their user portal account.
P a g e | 438
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 315: General User
Custom Privilege
The Super Admin user can create users with different privileges. 33 items are available for privilege
customization.
- API Configuration
- API Configuration
- Backup
- Callback
- Call Queue
- CDR Recording Files
- CDR Records
- CDR Statistics
- Audio Conference
- Dial By Name
- DISA
- Emergency Calls
- Event List
- Extensions
- Outbound Routes
- Inbound Routes
- Feature Codes
- IVR
- Paging/Intercom
- Parking Lot
- Pickup Groups
P a g e | 439
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
- PMS - Wakeup Service
- Ring Groups
- SCA
- Speed Dial
- System Status
- System Events
- Time Settings
- Video Conference
- Voicemail
- Voice Prompt
- Wakeup Service
- Zero Config
- LDAP Server
- UCM RemoteConnect
- Announcement.
When there are multiple Web GUI users created, concurrent multi-user login is supported on the UCM630X.
Multiple users could edit options and have configurations take effect simultaneously. However, if different users
are editing the same option or making the same operation (by clicking on “Apply Changes”), a prompt will pop
up as shown in the following figure.
P a g e | 440
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 317: Multiple User Operation Error Prompt
Change Password
After logging in the UCM630X Web GUI for the first time, it is highly recommended for users to change the default
password to a more complicated password for security purpose. Follow the steps below to change the Web GUI
access password.
P a g e | 441
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Enter Old Password Enter the Old Password for UCM630X
The Email address is the User Email Address. It is used for receiving
Email Address
password information if the user forgets his password.
Change Username
UCM630X allows user to configure binding email in case login password is lost. UCM630X login credential will
be sent to the designated email address. The feature can be found under Web GUI MaintenanceLogin
SettingsChange Password / Email
Email Address Email Address is used to retrieve password when password is lost
P a g e | 442
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Login Security
After the user logs in the UCM630X Web GUI, the user will be automatically logged out after certain timeout, or
he/she can be banned for a specific period if the login timeout is exceeded. Those values can be specified under
UCM630X web GUIMaintenanceLogin SettingsLogin Security page.
The “User Login Timeout” value is in minute and the default setting is 10 minutes. If the user does not make
any operation on Web GUI within the timeout, the user will be logged out automatically. After that, the Web GUI
will be redirected to the login page and the user will need to enter username and password to log in.
If set to 0, there is no timeout for the Web GUI login session and the user will not be automatically logged out.
“Maximum number of login attempts” can prevent the UCM630X from brutal force decryption, if this number
is exceeded user IP address will be banned from accessing the UCM for a period of time based on user
configuration, the default value is 5.
“User ban period” specify the period of time in minutes an IP will be banned from accessing the UCM if the User
max number of try login is exceeded, the default value is 5.
“Login Banned User List” show the list of IPs’ banned from the UCM.
“Login Whitelist” User can add a list of IPs’ to avoid the above restriction, thus, they can exceed the User max
number of try login.
P a g e | 443
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 321: Login Timeout Settings
Operation Log
Super Admin has the authority to view operation logs on UCM630X Web GUISettingsUser
ManagementOperation Log page. Operation logs list operations done by all the Web GUI users, for example,
Web GUI login, creating trunk, creating outbound rule and etc. There are 7 columns to record the operation
details “Date”, “Username”, “IP Address”, “Results”, “Page Operation”, “Specific Operation” and “Remark”.
P a g e | 444
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 322: Operation Logs
The operation log can be sorted and filtered for easy access. Click on or at the top of each column to
sort. For example, clicking on for "Date" will sort the logs according to newer operation date and time.
Clicking on for "Date" will reverse the order.
The page where the operation is made. For example, login, logout, delete user, create
Page Operation
trunk and etc.
Specific Operation Click on to view the options and values configured by this operation.
User could also filter the operation logs by time condition, IP address and/or username. Configure these
conditions and then click on ”Display Filter”.
P a g e | 445
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 323: Operation Logs Filter
The above figure shows an example that operations made by user “support” on device with IP 192.168.40.173
from 2014-11-01 00:00 to 2014-11-06 15:38 are filtered out and displayed.
To delete operation logs, users can perform filtering first and then click on to delete
the filtered result of operation logs. Or users can click on to delete all operation logs at once.
Upgrading
The UCM630X can be upgraded to a new firmware version locally. And in order to do that, please follow the
below steps:
1. Download the latest UCM630X firmware file from the following link and save it in your PC.
http://www.grandstream.com/support/firmware
2. Log in the Web GUI as administrator in the PC.
3. Go to Web GUIMaintenanceUpgrade, upload the firmware file by clicking on “choose file to upload”
and select the firmware file from your PC. The default firmware file name is UCM630Xfw.bin
P a g e | 446
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
4. Wait until the upgrading process is successful and a window will be popped up in the Web GUI.
5. Click on "OK" to reboot the UCM630X and check the firmware version after it boots up.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Notes:
- Please do not interrupt or power cycle the UCM630X during upgrading process.
- The firmware file name allows the use of the special characters besides the following restricted
characters: # $ ^ & * + ( ) [ ] / ; ‘ | , < > ?
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service providers should maintain their own firmware upgrade servers. For users who do not have
TFTP/HTTP/HTTPS server, some free windows version TFTP servers are available for download from
http://www.solarwinds.com/products/freetools/free_tftp_server.aspx
http://tftpd32.jounin.net
1. Unzip the firmware files and put all of them in the root directory of the TFTP server;
2. Connect the PC running the TFTP server and the UCM630X to the same LAN segment;
3. Launch the TFTP server and go to the File menuConfigureSecurity to change the TFTP server's default
setting from "Receive Only" to "Transmit Only" for the firmware upgrade;
4. Start the TFTP server and configure the TFTP server in the UCM630X web configuration interface;
End users can also choose to download a free HTTP server from http://httpd.apache.org/ or use
Microsoft IIS web server.
P a g e | 447
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Backup
The UCM630X configuration can be backed up locally or via network. The backup file will be used to restore the
configuration on UCM630X when necessary.
Backup/Restore
Users could backup the UCM630X configurations for restore purpose under Web
GUIMaintenanceBackupBackup/Restore.
Click on ”Backup” to create a new backup file. Then the following dialog will show.
2. Choose where to store the backup file: USB Disk, SD Card, Local, NAS or GDMS.
Once the backup is done, the list of the backups will be displayed with date and time in the web page. Users can
download , restore , or delete it from the UCM630X internal storage or the external device.
Click on to upload backup file from the local device to UCM630X. The uploaded backup file will also
be displayed in the web page and can be used to restore the UCM630X.
Note: users can restore backups of models with more FXO ports to models with less FXO ports as long as the
configurations related to the extra FXO ports are removed.
P a g e | 448
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Please make sure the FXO port settings, total number of extensions and total number of conference rooms are
compactable before restoring to another UCM model. Otherwise it will prompt a warning and stop the restore
process as shown below:
The option allows UCM to perform automatically backup on the user specified time.
Regular backup file can only be stored in USB / SD card / SFTP server. User is allowed to set backup time from
0-23 and how frequent the backup will be performed.
P a g e | 449
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 330: Local Backup
Data Sync
Besides local backup, users could backup the voice records/voice mails/CDR in a daily basis to a remote server
via SFTP protocol automatically under Web GUIMaintenanceBackupData Sync.
The client account supports special characters such as @ or “.” Allowing the use email address as SFTP
accounts. It allows users as well to specify the destination directory on SFTP server for backup file. If the directory
does not exist on the destination, UCM630X will create the directory automatically
P a g e | 450
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 331: Data Sync
Enable Data Sync Enable the auto data sync function. The default setting is "No".
Password Enter the Password associate with the Account on the SFTP backup server.
Destination Directory Specify the directory in SFTP server to keep the backup file. Format:
‘xxx/xxx/xxx’, If this directory does not exist, UCM will create this directory
automatically.
Sync Time Enter 0-23 to specify the backup hour of the day.
P a g e | 451
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Before saving the configuration, users could click on . The UCM630X will then try connecting the
server to make sure the server is up and accessible for the UCM630X. Save the changes and all the backup
logs will be listed on the web page. After data sync is configured, users could also manually synchronize all data
To restore the configuration on the UCM630X from a backup file, users could go to Web GUI Maintenance
Backup Backup/Restore.
A list of previous configuration backups is displayed on the web page. Users could click on of the
desired backup file and it will be restored to the UCM630X.
If the backup was stored on GDMS, it will be displayed under Backups GDMS Cloud Storage, that can be
restored by clicking on
If users have other backup files on PC to restore on the UCM630X, click on "Upload Backup File" first and
select it from local PC to upload on the UCM630X. Once the uploading is done, this backup file will be
displayed in the list of previous configuration backups for restore purpose. Click on to restore from the
backup file.
P a g e | 452
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
The uploaded backup file must be a tar file with no special characters like *,!,#,@,&,$,%,^,(,),/,\,space in
the file name.
The uploaded back file size must be under 10MB.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
System Cleanup/Reset
Users could perform reset and reboot under Web GUIMaintenanceSystem Cleanup/ResetReset and
Reboot.
To factory reset the device, click on reset icon, then all the configurations and data will be reset to factory
default.
User can also verify UCM certificate under the same path.
Cleaner
Users could configure to clean the Call Detail Report/Voice Records/Voice Mails etc… manually and
automatically under Web GUIMaintenanceSystem Cleanup/ResetCleaner.
The following screenshot show the settings and parameters to configure the manual cleaner feature on
UCM630X.
P a g e | 453
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 334: Manual Cleaning
Users can either clean all the data on the UCM or specify the modules to clean such as: Recordings, Fax Files,
Voicemail, Music on Hold, Voice Prompts, CDR, ZeroConfig Files, Operation Log, Backups, Coredumps,
Troubleshooting, Queue Statistics Reports, Conference Reports, IM Data.
User can also set an automatic cleaning under CleanerAutomatic Cleaning. The following screenshot show
the settings and parameters to configure the cleaner feature on UCM630X.
P a g e | 454
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 335: Automatic Cleaning
CDR Clean Time Enter 0-23 to specify the hour of the day to clean up CDR.
Cleaning Conditions By Schedule: If the clean interval is 3, cleaning will be performed every 3
days to remove all records that were generated 3 days ago.
P a g e | 455
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Keep Last X Records: If the max number of CDR has been reached, CDR
will be deleted starting with the oldest entry at the configured cleaning
time.(Note: The amount of records displayed on the page of call queue
statistics is not one-to-one with the actual amount of records in the
database.)
Keep Last X Days: Delete all entries older than X days.
Clean Interval Enter 1-30 to specify the day of the month to clean up CDR when By
Schedule is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
Max Entries Set the maximum number of CDR entries to keep when Keep Last X
Records is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
Keep Last X Day Enter the number of days of call log entries to keep when Keep Last X days
is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
Enable Queue Statistics Enable scheduled queue log cleaning. By default, is disabled.
Report Cleaner
Cleaning Conditions By Schedule: If the clean interval is 3, cleaning will be performed every 3
days to remove all records that were generated 3 days ago.
Keep Last X Records: If the max number of Queue Statistics has been
reached, Queue Statistics will be deleted starting with the oldest entry at the
configured cleaning time.(Note: The amount of records displayed on the page
of call queue statistics is not one-to-one with the actual amount of records in
the database.)
Keep Last X Days: Delete all entries older than X days.
Clean Interval Enter how often (in days) to clean queue logs when By Schedule is
selected as Cleaning Conditions. The valid range is 1-30.
Max Entries Set the maximum number of Queue Statistics entries to keep when Keep
Last X Records is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
Keep Last X Day Enter the number of days of call log entries to keep when Keep Last X days
is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
P a g e | 456
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Cleaning Conditions By Schedule: If the clean interval is 3, cleaning will be performed every
3 days to remove all records that were generated 3 days ago.
Keep Last X Records: If the max number of Conference Statistics
Report has been reached, Conference Statistics Report will be deleted
starting with the oldest entry at the configured cleaning time. (Note: The
amount of records displayed on the page of call queue statistics is not
one-to-one with the actual amount of records in the database.)
Keep Last X Days: Delete all entries older than X days.
Clean Interval Enter how often (in days) to clean queue logs when By Schedule is
selected as Cleaning Conditions. The valid range is 1-30.
Max Entries Set the maximum number of Conference Statistics Report entries to keep
when Keep Last X Records is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
Keep Last X Day Enter the number of days of call log entries to keep when Keep Last X days
is selected as Cleaning Conditions.
Clean Files in External If enabled the files in external device (USB/SD card) will be atomically
Device cleaned up as configured.
Choose Cleaner File Select the files for system automatic clean.
Basic Call Recording Files.
Conference Recording Files.
Call Queue Recording Files.
Voicemail Files.
Backup Files.
Clean time Enter the hour of the day to start the cleaning. The valid range is 0-23.
Cleaning Conditions By Schedule: If the clean interval is 3, cleaning will be performed every
3 days to delete all files.
By Threshold: Check at the configured cleaning time every day to see
if the storage threshold has been exceeded and perform cleaning of all
files if it has.
Keep Last X Days: Delete all files older than X days.
File Clean Interval Enter 1-30 to specify the day of the month to clean up the files.
File Clean Threshold Enter the internal storage disk usage threshold (in percent). Once this
threshold is exceeded, the file cleanup will proceed as scheduled. Valid
P a g e | 457
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
range is 0-99.
Keep Last X Days Automatically delete all recordings older than this x days when the threshold
is reached. If not set, all data is cleared
All the cleaner logs will be listed on the bottom of the page.
Users could configure to clean or download the Call Detail Report/Voice Records/Voice Mails automatically under
Web GUIMaintenanceSystem Cleanup/ResetUSB / SD Card Files Cleanup.
System Recovery
In some cases (for example after wrong upgrading procedure where the user doesn’t follow the correct steps to
perform an upgrade) the system may go into some hardware/software issues where the web UI access is lost
P a g e | 458
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
as well as SSH, in this case the only solution would be to perform a full system recovery in order to reset or
update the software version of the device in order to use it again.
2. Remove the power from the unit and keep the network cable connected.
4. Plug back the power supply while maintaining the reset button pressed.
6. Release the reset button, and the system should display on the LCD a message “Recovery Mode” along
with an IP address.
Once at this stage, the administrator can access the recovery mode web portal by typing in either the IP0 address
(typically WAN) or IP1 address (typically LAN) into a browser address bar. The following page should appear:
Make sure to enter the correct admin password, and press login to access the recovery mode page :
P a g e | 459
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 338: Recovery Mode
From here, the user can either upload a firmware file, factory reset or just reboot the device.
Syslog
On the UCM630X, users could dump the syslog information to a remote server under Web
GUIMaintenanceSyslog. Enter the syslog server hostname or IP address and select the module/level for
the syslog information as well as Process Log Level.
The default syslog level for all modules is "error", which is recommended in your UCM630X settings because it
can be helpful to locate the issues when errors happen.
Some typical modules for UCM630X functions are as follows and users can turn on "NOTICE" and "VERBOSE"
levels besides "error" level.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Note:
Syslog is usually for debugging and troubleshooting purpose. Turning on all levels for all syslog modules is not
recommended for daily usage. Too many syslog prints might cause traffic and affect system performance.
The reserved size for Syslog entries on the cache memory of the UCM is 50M, once this sized is reached the
P a g e | 460
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
UCM will clean up 2M of the oldest Syslog entries to allow to save new logs.
---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Network Troubleshooting
On the UCM630X, users could capture traces, ping remote host and traceroute remote host for troubleshooting
purpose under Web GUIMaintenanceNetwork Troubleshooting.
The following sections shows the steps to capture different types of traffic traces for analysis purposes.
Ethernet Capture
The captured trace can be downloaded for analysis. The instructions or result will be displayed in the Web GUI
output result.
P a g e | 461
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 339: Ethernet Capture
P a g e | 462
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Storage to External Device Check this box to activate storage of the capture either on the
USB or SD Card.
Capture Filter Enter the filter to obtain the specific types of traffic, such as (host,
src, dst, net, proto…).
The output result is in .pcap format. Therefore, users could specify the capture filter as used in general network
traffic capture tool (host, src, dst, net, protocol, port, port range) before starting to capture the trace.
Note: Capture files saved on external devices will now have “capture” prepended to file names.
IP Ping
Enter the target host in host name or IP address. Then press "Start" button. The output result will dynamically
display in the window below.
P a g e | 463
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Traceroute
Enter the target host in host name or IP address. Then press "Start" button. The output result will dynamically
display in the window below.
Signaling Troubleshooting
Analog record trace can be used to troubleshoot analog trunk issue, for example, the UCM630X user has caller
ID issue for incoming call from Analog trunk. Users can access analog record trance under Web
GUIMaintenanceSignal Troubleshooting.
1. Select FXO or FXS for "Record Ports". If the issue happens on FXO 1, select FXO port 1 to record the
trace.
2. Click on "Start".
3. Make a call via the analog port that has the issue.
P a g e | 464
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
5. Click on "Download" to download the analog record trace.
Users can directly set a PSTN number on the “External Extension” text box to troubleshoot issues related to
the analog trunk easily, the following steps shows how to use this feature:
3. Press “Start” button. The call will be initiated to the external number.
The trace will be available for analysis to download after output result shows “Done! Click on Download to
download the captured packets”.
P a g e | 465
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Figure 343: A Key Dial-up FXO
Note: When using a Key Dial-up FXO feature the outbound trunk for the analog trunk need to have internal
permission. As well as it should be the trunk with the highest outbound route priority.
After capturing the trace, users can download it for basic analysis. Or you can contact Grandstream
Technical support in the following link for further assistance if the issue is not resolved.
http://www.grandstream.com/index.php/support
Service Check
Enable Service Check to periodically check UCM630X. Check Cycle is configurable in seconds and the default
setting is 60 sec. Check Times is the maximum number of failed checks before restart the UCM630X. The default
setting is 3. If there is no response from UCM630X after 3 attempts (default) to check, current status will be
stored and the internal service in UCM630X will be restarted.
P a g e | 466
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
Network Status
In UCM630X Web GUISystem StatusNetwork Status, the users can view active Internet connections. This
information can be used to troubleshoot connection issue between UCM630X and other services.
P a g e | 467
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4
EXPERIENCING THE UCM630X SERIES IP PBX
Please visit our website: http://www.grandstream.com to receive the most up- to-date updates on firmware
releases, additional features, FAQs, documentation and news on new products.
We encourage you to browse our product related documentation, FAQs and User and Developer Forum for
answers to your general questions. If you have purchased our products through a Grandstream Certified
Partner or Reseller, please contact them directly for immediate support.
Our technical support staff is trained and ready to answer all of your questions. Contact a technical support
member or submit a trouble ticket online to receive in-depth support.
Thank you again for purchasing Grandstream UCM630X series IP PBX appliance, it will be sure to bring
convenience and color to both your business and personal life.
P a g e | 468
UCM630X Series User Manual
Version 1.0.5.4